- By
- Contents
- CHAPTER I.
START IN LIFE - CHAPTER II.
SLAVERY AND ESCAPE - CHAPTER III.
WRECKED ON A DESERT ISLAND - CHAPTER IV.
FIRST WEEKS ON THE ISLAND - CHAPTER V.
BUILDS A HOUSE—THE JOURNAL - CHAPTER VI.
ILL AND CONSCIENCE-STRICKEN - CHAPTER VII.
AGRICULTURAL EXPERIENCE - CHAPTER VIII.
SURVEYS HIS POSITION - CHAPTER IX.
A BOAT - CHAPTER X.
TAMES GOATS - CHAPTER XI.
FINDS PRINT OF MAN’S FOOT ON THE SAND - CHAPTER XII.
A CAVE RETREAT - CHAPTER XIII.
WRECK OF A SPANISH SHIP - CHAPTER XIV.
A DREAM REALISED - CHAPTER XV.
FRIDAY’S EDUCATION - CHAPTER XVI.
RESCUE OF PRISONERS FROM CANNIBALS - CHAPTER XVII.
VISIT OF MUTINEERS - CHAPTER XVIII.
THE SHIP RECOVERED - CHAPTER XIX.
RETURN TO ENGLAND - CHAPTER XX.
FIGHT BETWEEN FRIDAY AND A BEAR
www.gutenberg.org
# The
Life and Adventures
of
Robinson Crusoe
By
Daniel Defoe
London
Seeley, Service & Co. Limited
38 Great Russell Street
Contents
CHAPTER I—START IN LIFE
CHAPTER II—SLAVERY AND ESCAPE
CHAPTER III—WRECKED ON A DESERT ISLAND
CHAPTER IV—FIRST WEEKS ON THE ISLAND
CHAPTER V—BUILDS A HOUSE—THE JOURNAL
CHAPTER VI—ILL AND CONSCIENCE-STRICKEN
CHAPTER VII—AGRICULTURAL EXPERIENCE
CHAPTER VIII—SURVEYS HIS POSITION
CHAPTER IX—A BOAT
CHAPTER X—TAMES GOATS
CHAPTER XI—FINDS PRINT OF MAN’S FOOT ON THE SAND
CHAPTER XII—A CAVE RETREAT
CHAPTER XIII—WRECK OF A SPANISH SHIP
CHAPTER XIV—A DREAM REALISED
CHAPTER XV—FRIDAY’S EDUCATION
CHAPTER XVI—RESCUE OF PRISONERS FROM CANNIBALS
CHAPTER XVII—VISIT OF MUTINEERS
CHAPTER XVIII—THE SHIP RECOVERED
CHAPTER XIX—RETURN TO ENGLAND
CHAPTER XX—FIGHT BETWEEN FRIDAY AND A BEAR
CHAPTER I.
START IN LIFE
I was born in the year 1632, in the city of York, of a good family, though not
of that country, my father being a foreigner of Bremen, who settled first at
Hull. He got a good estate by merchandise, and leaving off his trade, lived
afterwards at York, from whence he had married my mother, whose relations were
named Robinson, a very good family in that country, and from whom I was called
Robinson Kreutznaer; but, by the usual corruption of words in England, we are
now called—nay we call ourselves and write our name—Crusoe; and so
my companions always called me.
I had two elder brothers, one of whom was lieutenant-colonel to an English
regiment of foot in Flanders, formerly commanded by the famous Colonel
Lockhart, and was killed at the battle near Dunkirk against the Spaniards. What
became of my second brother I never knew, any more than my father or mother
knew what became of me.
Being the third son of the family and not bred to any trade, my head began to
be filled very early with rambling thoughts. My father, who was very ancient,
had given me a competent share of learning, as far as house-education and a
country free school generally go, and designed me for the law; but I would be
satisfied with nothing but going to sea; and my inclination to this led me so
strongly against the will, nay, the commands of my father, and against all the
entreaties and persuasions of my mother and other friends, that there seemed to
be something fatal in that propensity of nature, tending directly to the life
of misery which was to befall me.
My father, a wise and grave man, gave me serious and excellent counsel against
what he foresaw was my design. He called me one morning into his chamber, where
he was confined by the gout, and expostulated very warmly with me upon this
subject. He asked me what reasons, more than a mere wandering inclination, I
had for leaving father’s house and my native country, where I might be
well introduced, and had a prospect of raising my fortune by application and
industry, with a life of ease and pleasure. He told me it was men of desperate
fortunes on one hand, or of aspiring, superior fortunes on the other, who went
abroad upon adventures, to rise by enterprise, and make themselves famous in
undertakings of a nature out of the common road; that these things were all
either too far above me or too far below me; that mine was the middle state, or
what might be called the upper station of low life, which he had found, by long
experience, was the best state in the world, the most suited to human
happiness, not exposed to the miseries and hardships, the labour and sufferings
of the mechanic part of mankind, and not embarrassed with the pride, luxury,
ambition, and envy of the upper part of mankind. He told me I might judge of
the happiness of this state by this one thing—viz. that this was the
state of life which all other people envied; that kings have frequently
lamented the miserable consequence of being born to great things, and wished
they had been placed in the middle of the two extremes, between the mean and
the great; that the wise man gave his testimony to this, as the standard of
felicity, when he prayed to have neither poverty nor riches.
He bade me observe it, and I should always find that the calamities of life
were shared among the upper and lower part of mankind, but that the middle
station had the fewest disasters, and was not exposed to so many vicissitudes
as the higher or lower part of mankind; nay, they were not subjected to so many
distempers and uneasinesses, either of body or mind, as those were who, by
vicious living, luxury, and extravagances on the one hand, or by hard labour,
want of necessaries, and mean or insufficient diet on the other hand, bring
distemper upon themselves by the natural consequences of their way of living;
that the middle station of life was calculated for all kind of virtue and all
kind of enjoyments; that peace and plenty were the handmaids of a middle
fortune; that temperance, moderation, quietness, health, society, all agreeable
diversions, and all desirable pleasures, were the blessings attending the
middle station of life; that this way men went silently and smoothly through
the world, and comfortably out of it, not embarrassed with the labours of the
hands or of the head, not sold to a life of slavery for daily bread, nor
harassed with perplexed circumstances, which rob the soul of peace and the body
of rest, nor enraged with the passion of envy, or the secret burning lust of
ambition for great things; but, in easy circumstances, sliding gently through
the world, and sensibly tasting the sweets of living, without the bitter;
feeling that they are happy, and learning by every day’s experience to
know it more sensibly.
After this he pressed me earnestly, and in the most affectionate manner, not to
play the young man, nor to precipitate myself into miseries which nature, and
the station of life I was born in, seemed to have provided against; that I was
under no necessity of seeking my bread; that he would do well for me, and
endeavour to enter me fairly into the station of life which he had just been
recommending to me; and that if I was not very easy and happy in the world, it
must be my mere fate or fault that must hinder it; and that he should have
nothing to answer for, having thus discharged his duty in warning me against
measures which he knew would be to my hurt; in a word, that as he would do very
kind things for me if I would stay and settle at home as he directed, so he
would not have so much hand in my misfortunes as to give me any encouragement
to go away; and to close all, he told me I had my elder brother for an example,
to whom he had used the same earnest persuasions to keep him from going into
the Low Country wars, but could not prevail, his young desires prompting him to
run into the army, where he was killed; and though he said he would not cease
to pray for me, yet he would venture to say to me, that if I did take this
foolish step, God would not bless me, and I should have leisure hereafter to
reflect upon having neglected his counsel when there might be none to assist in
my recovery.
I observed in this last part of his discourse, which was truly prophetic,
though I suppose my father did not know it to be so himself—I say, I
observed the tears run down his face very plentifully, especially when he spoke
of my brother who was killed: and that when he spoke of my having leisure to
repent, and none to assist me, he was so moved that he broke off the discourse,
and told me his heart was so full he could say no more to me.
I was sincerely affected with this discourse, and, indeed, who could be
otherwise? and I resolved not to think of going abroad any more, but to settle
at home according to my father’s desire. But alas! a few days wore it all
off; and, in short, to prevent any of my father’s further importunities,
in a few weeks after I resolved to run quite away from him. However, I did not
act quite so hastily as the first heat of my resolution prompted; but I took my
mother at a time when I thought her a little more pleasant than ordinary, and
told her that my thoughts were so entirely bent upon seeing the world that I
should never settle to anything with resolution enough to go through with it,
and my father had better give me his consent than force me to go without it;
that I was now eighteen years old, which was too late to go apprentice to a
trade or clerk to an attorney; that I was sure if I did I should never serve
out my time, but I should certainly run away from my master before my time was
out, and go to sea; and if she would speak to my father to let me go one voyage
abroad, if I came home again, and did not like it, I would go no more; and I
would promise, by a double diligence, to recover the time that I had lost.
This put my mother into a great passion; she told me she knew it would be to no
purpose to speak to my father upon any such subject; that he knew too well what
was my interest to give his consent to anything so much for my hurt; and that
she wondered how I could think of any such thing after the discourse I had had
with my father, and such kind and tender expressions as she knew my father had
used to me; and that, in short, if I would ruin myself, there was no help for
me; but I might depend I should never have their consent to it; that for her
part she would not have so much hand in my destruction; and I should never have
it to say that my mother was willing when my father was not.
Though my mother refused to move it to my father, yet I heard afterwards that
she reported all the discourse to him, and that my father, after showing a
great concern at it, said to her, with a sigh, “That boy might be happy
if he would stay at home; but if he goes abroad, he will be the most miserable
wretch that ever was born: I can give no consent to it.”
It was not till almost a year after this that I broke loose, though, in the
meantime, I continued obstinately deaf to all proposals of settling to
business, and frequently expostulated with my father and mother about their
being so positively determined against what they knew my inclinations prompted
me to. But being one day at Hull, where I went casually, and without any
purpose of making an elopement at that time; but, I say, being there, and one
of my companions being about to sail to London in his father’s ship, and
prompting me to go with them with the common allurement of seafaring men, that
it should cost me nothing for my passage, I consulted neither father nor mother
any more, nor so much as sent them word of it; but leaving them to hear of it
as they might, without asking God’s blessing or my father’s,
without any consideration of circumstances or consequences, and in an ill hour,
God knows, on the 1st of September 1651, I went on board a ship bound for
London. Never any young adventurer’s misfortunes, I believe, began
sooner, or continued longer than mine. The ship was no sooner out of the Humber
than the wind began to blow and the sea to rise in a most frightful manner;
and, as I had never been at sea before, I was most inexpressibly sick in body
and terrified in mind. I began now seriously to reflect upon what I had done,
and how justly I was overtaken by the judgment of Heaven for my wicked leaving
my father’s house, and abandoning my duty. All the good counsels of my
parents, my father’s tears and my mother’s entreaties, came now
fresh into my mind; and my conscience, which was not yet come to the pitch of
hardness to which it has since, reproached me with the contempt of advice, and
the breach of my duty to God and my father.
All this while the storm increased, and the sea went very high, though nothing
like what I have seen many times since; no, nor what I saw a few days after;
but it was enough to affect me then, who was but a young sailor, and had never
known anything of the matter. I expected every wave would have swallowed us up,
and that every time the ship fell down, as I thought it did, in the trough or
hollow of the sea, we should never rise more; in this agony of mind, I made
many vows and resolutions that if it would please God to spare my life in this
one voyage, if ever I got once my foot upon dry land again, I would go directly
home to my father, and never set it into a ship again while I lived; that I
would take his advice, and never run myself into such miseries as these any
more. Now I saw plainly the goodness of his observations about the middle
station of life, how easy, how comfortably he had lived all his days, and never
had been exposed to tempests at sea or troubles on shore; and I resolved that I
would, like a true repenting prodigal, go home to my father.
These wise and sober thoughts continued all the while the storm lasted, and
indeed some time after; but the next day the wind was abated, and the sea
calmer, and I began to be a little inured to it; however, I was very grave for
all that day, being also a little sea-sick still; but towards night the weather
cleared up, the wind was quite over, and a charming fine evening followed; the
sun went down perfectly clear, and rose so the next morning; and having little
or no wind, and a smooth sea, the sun shining upon it, the sight was, as I
thought, the most delightful that ever I saw.
I had slept well in the night, and was now no more sea-sick, but very cheerful,
looking with wonder upon the sea that was so rough and terrible the day before,
and could be so calm and so pleasant in so little a time after. And now, lest
my good resolutions should continue, my companion, who had enticed me away,
comes to me; “Well, Bob,” says he, clapping me upon the shoulder,
“how do you do after it? I warrant you were frighted, wer’n’t
you, last night, when it blew but a capful of wind?” “A capful
d’you call it?” said I; “’twas a terrible storm.”
“A storm, you fool you,” replies he; “do you call that a
storm? why, it was nothing at all; give us but a good ship and sea-room, and we
think nothing of such a squall of wind as that; but you’re but a
fresh-water sailor, Bob. Come, let us make a bowl of punch, and we’ll
forget all that; d’ye see what charming weather ’tis now?” To
make short this sad part of my story, we went the way of all sailors; the punch
was made and I was made half drunk with it: and in that one night’s
wickedness I drowned all my repentance, all my reflections upon my past
conduct, all my resolutions for the future. In a word, as the sea was returned
to its smoothness of surface and settled calmness by the abatement of that
storm, so the hurry of my thoughts being over, my fears and apprehensions of
being swallowed up by the sea being forgotten, and the current of my former
desires returned, I entirely forgot the vows and promises that I made in my
distress. I found, indeed, some intervals of reflection; and the serious
thoughts did, as it were, endeavour to return again sometimes; but I shook them
off, and roused myself from them as it were from a distemper, and applying
myself to drinking and company, soon mastered the return of those
fits—for so I called them; and I had in five or six days got as complete
a victory over conscience as any young fellow that resolved not to be troubled
with it could desire. But I was to have another trial for it still; and
Providence, as in such cases generally it does, resolved to leave me entirely
without excuse; for if I would not take this for a deliverance, the next was to
be such a one as the worst and most hardened wretch among us would confess both
the danger and the mercy of.
The sixth day of our being at sea we came into Yarmouth Roads; the wind having
been contrary and the weather calm, we had made but little way since the storm.
Here we were obliged to come to an anchor, and here we lay, the wind continuing
contrary—viz. at south-west—for seven or eight days, during which
time a great many ships from Newcastle came into the same Roads, as the common
harbour where the ships might wait for a wind for the river.
We had not, however, rid here so long but we should have tided it up the river,
but that the wind blew too fresh, and after we had lain four or five days, blew
very hard. However, the Roads being reckoned as good as a harbour, the
anchorage good, and our ground-tackle very strong, our men were unconcerned,
and not in the least apprehensive of danger, but spent the time in rest and
mirth, after the manner of the sea; but the eighth day, in the morning, the
wind increased, and we had all hands at work to strike our topmasts, and make
everything snug and close, that the ship might ride as easy as possible. By
noon the sea went very high indeed, and our ship rode forecastle in, shipped
several seas, and we thought once or twice our anchor had come home; upon which
our master ordered out the sheet-anchor, so that we rode with two anchors
ahead, and the cables veered out to the bitter end.
By this time it blew a terrible storm indeed; and now I began to see terror and
amazement in the faces even of the seamen themselves. The master, though
vigilant in the business of preserving the ship, yet as he went in and out of
his cabin by me, I could hear him softly to himself say, several times,
“Lord be merciful to us! we shall be all lost! we shall be all
undone!” and the like. During these first hurries I was stupid, lying
still in my cabin, which was in the steerage, and cannot describe my temper: I
could ill resume the first penitence which I had so apparently trampled upon
and hardened myself against: I thought the bitterness of death had been past,
and that this would be nothing like the first; but when the master himself came
by me, as I said just now, and said we should be all lost, I was dreadfully
frighted. I got up out of my cabin and looked out; but such a dismal sight I
never saw: the sea ran mountains high, and broke upon us every three or four
minutes; when I could look about, I could see nothing but distress round us;
two ships that rode near us, we found, had cut their masts by the board, being
deep laden; and our men cried out that a ship which rode about a mile ahead of
us was foundered. Two more ships, being driven from their anchors, were run out
of the Roads to sea, at all adventures, and that with not a mast standing. The
light ships fared the best, as not so much labouring in the sea; but two or
three of them drove, and came close by us, running away with only their
spritsail out before the wind.
Towards evening the mate and boatswain begged the master of our ship to let
them cut away the fore-mast, which he was very unwilling to do; but the
boatswain protesting to him that if he did not the ship would founder, he
consented; and when they had cut away the fore-mast, the main-mast stood so
loose, and shook the ship so much, they were obliged to cut that away also, and
make a clear deck.
Any one may judge what a condition I must be in at all this, who was but a
young sailor, and who had been in such a fright before at but a little. But if
I can express at this distance the thoughts I had about me at that time, I was
in tenfold more horror of mind upon account of my former convictions, and the
having returned from them to the resolutions I had wickedly taken at first,
than I was at death itself; and these, added to the terror of the storm, put me
into such a condition that I can by no words describe it. But the worst was not
come yet; the storm continued with such fury that the seamen themselves
acknowledged they had never seen a worse. We had a good ship, but she was deep
laden, and wallowed in the sea, so that the seamen every now and then cried out
she would founder. It was my advantage in one respect, that I did not know what
they meant by till I inquired. However, the storm was so violent
that I saw, what is not often seen, the master, the boatswain, and some others
more sensible than the rest, at their prayers, and expecting every moment when
the ship would go to the bottom. In the middle of the night, and under all the
rest of our distresses, one of the men that had been down to see cried out we
had sprung a leak; another said there was four feet water in the hold. Then all
hands were called to the pump. At that word, my heart, as I thought, died
within me: and I fell backwards upon the side of my bed where I sat, into the
cabin. However, the men roused me, and told me that I, that was able to do
nothing before, was as well able to pump as another; at which I stirred up and
went to the pump, and worked very heartily. While this was doing the master,
seeing some light colliers, who, not able to ride out the storm were obliged to
slip and run away to sea, and would come near us, ordered to fire a gun as a
signal of distress. I, who knew nothing what they meant, thought the ship had
broken, or some dreadful thing happened. In a word, I was so surprised that I
fell down in a swoon. As this was a time when everybody had his own life to
think of, nobody minded me, or what was become of me; but another man stepped
up to the pump, and thrusting me aside with his foot, let me lie, thinking I
had been dead; and it was a great while before I came to myself.
We worked on; but the water increasing in the hold, it was apparent that the
ship would founder; and though the storm began to abate a little, yet it was
not possible she could swim till we might run into any port; so the master
continued firing guns for help; and a light ship, who had rid it out just ahead
of us, ventured a boat out to help us. It was with the utmost hazard the boat
came near us; but it was impossible for us to get on board, or for the boat to
lie near the ship’s side, till at last the men rowing very heartily, and
venturing their lives to save ours, our men cast them a rope over the stern
with a buoy to it, and then veered it out a great length, which they, after
much labour and hazard, took hold of, and we hauled them close under our stern,
and got all into their boat. It was to no purpose for them or us, after we were
in the boat, to think of reaching their own ship; so all agreed to let her
drive, and only to pull her in towards shore as much as we could; and our
master promised them, that if the boat was staved upon shore, he would make it
good to their master: so partly rowing and partly driving, our boat went away
to the northward, sloping towards the shore almost as far as Winterton Ness.
We were not much more than a quarter of an hour out of our ship till we saw her
sink, and then I understood for the first time what was meant by a ship
foundering in the sea. I must acknowledge I had hardly eyes to look up when the
seamen told me she was sinking; for from the moment that they rather put me
into the boat than that I might be said to go in, my heart was, as it were,
dead within me, partly with fright, partly with horror of mind, and the
thoughts of what was yet before me.
While we were in this condition—the men yet labouring at the oar to bring
the boat near the shore—we could see (when, our boat mounting the waves,
we were able to see the shore) a great many people running along the strand to
assist us when we should come near; but we made but slow way towards the shore;
nor were we able to reach the shore till, being past the lighthouse at
Winterton, the shore falls off to the westward towards Cromer, and so the land
broke off a little the violence of the wind. Here we got in, and though not
without much difficulty, got all safe on shore, and walked afterwards on foot
to Yarmouth, where, as unfortunate men, we were used with great humanity, as
well by the magistrates of the town, who assigned us good quarters, as by
particular merchants and owners of ships, and had money given us sufficient to
carry us either to London or back to Hull as we thought fit.
Had I now had the sense to have gone back to Hull, and have gone home, I had
been happy, and my father, as in our blessed Saviour’s parable, had even
killed the fatted calf for me; for hearing the ship I went away in was cast
away in Yarmouth Roads, it was a great while before he had any assurances that
I was not drowned.
But my ill fate pushed me on now with an obstinacy that nothing could resist;
and though I had several times loud calls from my reason and my more composed
judgment to go home, yet I had no power to do it. I know not what to call this,
nor will I urge that it is a secret overruling decree, that hurries us on to be
the instruments of our own destruction, even though it be before us, and that
we rush upon it with our eyes open. Certainly, nothing but some such decreed
unavoidable misery, which it was impossible for me to escape, could have pushed
me forward against the calm reasonings and persuasions of my most retired
thoughts, and against two such visible instructions as I had met with in my
first attempt.
My comrade, who had helped to harden me before, and who was the master’s
son, was now less forward than I. The first time he spoke to me after we were
at Yarmouth, which was not till two or three days, for we were separated in the
town to several quarters; I say, the first time he saw me, it appeared his tone
was altered; and, looking very melancholy, and shaking his head, he asked me
how I did, and telling his father who I was, and how I had come this voyage
only for a trial, in order to go further abroad, his father, turning to me with
a very grave and concerned tone “Young man,” says he, “you
ought never to go to sea any more; you ought to take this for a plain and
visible token that you are not to be a seafaring man.” “Why,
sir,” said I, “will you go to sea no more?” “That is
another case,” said he; “it is my calling, and therefore my duty;
but as you made this voyage on trial, you see what a taste Heaven has given you
of what you are to expect if you persist. Perhaps this has all befallen us on
your account, like Jonah in the ship of Tarshish. Pray,” continues he,
“what are you; and on what account did you go to sea?” Upon that I
told him some of my story; at the end of which he burst out into a strange kind
of passion: “What had I done,” says he, “that such an unhappy
wretch should come into my ship? I would not set my foot in the same ship with
thee again for a thousand pounds.” This indeed was, as I said, an
excursion of his spirits, which were yet agitated by the sense of his loss, and
was farther than he could have authority to go. However, he afterwards talked
very gravely to me, exhorting me to go back to my father, and not tempt
Providence to my ruin, telling me I might see a visible hand of Heaven against
me. “And, young man,” said he, “depend upon it, if you do not
go back, wherever you go, you will meet with nothing but disasters and
disappointments, till your father’s words are fulfilled upon you.”
We parted soon after; for I made him little answer, and I saw him no more;
which way he went I knew not. As for me, having some money in my pocket, I
travelled to London by land; and there, as well as on the road, had many
struggles with myself what course of life I should take, and whether I should
go home or to sea.
As to going home, shame opposed the best motions that offered to my thoughts,
and it immediately occurred to me how I should be laughed at among the
neighbours, and should be ashamed to see, not my father and mother only, but
even everybody else; from whence I have since often observed, how incongruous
and irrational the common temper of mankind is, especially of youth, to that
reason which ought to guide them in such cases—viz. that they are not
ashamed to sin, and yet are ashamed to repent; not ashamed of the action for
which they ought justly to be esteemed fools, but are ashamed of the returning,
which only can make them be esteemed wise men.
In this state of life, however, I remained some time, uncertain what measures
to take, and what course of life to lead. An irresistible reluctance continued
to going home; and as I stayed away a while, the remembrance of the distress I
had been in wore off, and as that abated, the little motion I had in my desires
to return wore off with it, till at last I quite laid aside the thoughts of it,
and looked out for a voyage.
CHAPTER II.
SLAVERY AND ESCAPE
That evil influence which carried me first away from my father’s
house—which hurried me into the wild and indigested notion of raising my
fortune, and that impressed those conceits so forcibly upon me as to make me
deaf to all good advice, and to the entreaties and even the commands of my
father—I say, the same influence, whatever it was, presented the most
unfortunate of all enterprises to my view; and I went on board a vessel bound
to the coast of Africa; or, as our sailors vulgarly called it, a voyage to
Guinea.
It was my great misfortune that in all these adventures I did not ship myself
as a sailor; when, though I might indeed have worked a little harder than
ordinary, yet at the same time I should have learnt the duty and office of a
fore-mast man, and in time might have qualified myself for a mate or
lieutenant, if not for a master. But as it was always my fate to choose for the
worse, so I did here; for having money in my pocket and good clothes upon my
back, I would always go on board in the habit of a gentleman; and so I neither
had any business in the ship, nor learned to do any.
It was my lot first of all to fall into pretty good company in London, which
does not always happen to such loose and misguided young fellows as I then was;
the devil generally not omitting to lay some snare for them very early; but it
was not so with me. I first got acquainted with the master of a ship who had
been on the coast of Guinea; and who, having had very good success there, was
resolved to go again. This captain taking a fancy to my conversation, which was
not at all disagreeable at that time, hearing me say I had a mind to see the
world, told me if I would go the voyage with him I should be at no expense; I
should be his messmate and his companion; and if I could carry anything with
me, I should have all the advantage of it that the trade would admit; and
perhaps I might meet with some encouragement.
I embraced the offer; and entering into a strict friendship with this captain,
who was an honest, plain-dealing man, I went the voyage with him, and carried a
small adventure with me, which, by the disinterested honesty of my friend the
captain, I increased very considerably; for I carried about £40 in such
toys and trifles as the captain directed me to buy. These £40 I had
mustered together by the assistance of some of my relations whom I corresponded
with; and who, I believe, got my father, or at least my mother, to contribute
so much as that to my first adventure.
This was the only voyage which I may say was successful in all my adventures,
which I owe to the integrity and honesty of my friend the captain; under whom
also I got a competent knowledge of the mathematics and the rules of
navigation, learned how to keep an account of the ship’s course, take an
observation, and, in short, to understand some things that were needful to be
understood by a sailor; for, as he took delight to instruct me, I took delight
to learn; and, in a word, this voyage made me both a sailor and a merchant; for
I brought home five pounds nine ounces of gold-dust for my adventure, which
yielded me in London, at my return, almost £300; and this filled me with
those aspiring thoughts which have since so completed my ruin.
Yet even in this voyage I had my misfortunes too; particularly, that I was
continually sick, being thrown into a violent calenture by the excessive heat
of the climate; our principal trading being upon the coast, from latitude of 15
degrees north even to the line itself.
I was now set up for a Guinea trader; and my friend, to my great misfortune,
dying soon after his arrival, I resolved to go the same voyage again, and I
embarked in the same vessel with one who was his mate in the former voyage, and
had now got the command of the ship. This was the unhappiest voyage that ever
man made; for though I did not carry quite £100 of my new-gained wealth,
so that I had £200 left, which I had lodged with my friend’s widow,
who was very just to me, yet I fell into terrible misfortunes. The first was
this: our ship making her course towards the Canary Islands, or rather between
those islands and the African shore, was surprised in the grey of the morning
by a Turkish rover of Sallee, who gave chase to us with all the sail she could
make. We crowded also as much canvas as our yards would spread, or our masts
carry, to get clear; but finding the pirate gained upon us, and would certainly
come up with us in a few hours, we prepared to fight; our ship having twelve
guns, and the rogue eighteen. About three in the afternoon he came up with us,
and bringing to, by mistake, just athwart our quarter, instead of athwart our
stern, as he intended, we brought eight of our guns to bear on that side, and
poured in a broadside upon him, which made him sheer off again, after returning
our fire, and pouring in also his small shot from near two hundred men which he
had on board. However, we had not a man touched, all our men keeping close. He
prepared to attack us again, and we to defend ourselves. But laying us on board
the next time upon our other quarter, he entered sixty men upon our decks, who
immediately fell to cutting and hacking the sails and rigging. We plied them
with small shot, half-pikes, powder-chests, and such like, and cleared our deck
of them twice. However, to cut short this melancholy part of our story, our
ship being disabled, and three of our men killed, and eight wounded, we were
obliged to yield, and were carried all prisoners into Sallee, a port belonging
to the Moors.
The usage I had there was not so dreadful as at first I apprehended; nor was I
carried up the country to the emperor’s court, as the rest of our men
were, but was kept by the captain of the rover as his proper prize, and made
his slave, being young and nimble, and fit for his business. At this surprising
change of my circumstances, from a merchant to a miserable slave, I was
perfectly overwhelmed; and now I looked back upon my father’s prophetic
discourse to me, that I should be miserable and have none to relieve me, which
I thought was now so effectually brought to pass that I could not be worse; for
now the hand of Heaven had overtaken me, and I was undone without redemption;
but, alas! this was but a taste of the misery I was to go through, as will
appear in the sequel of this story.
As my new patron, or master, had taken me home to his house, so I was in hopes
that he would take me with him when he went to sea again, believing that it
would some time or other be his fate to be taken by a Spanish or Portugal
man-of-war; and that then I should be set at liberty. But this hope of mine was
soon taken away; for when he went to sea, he left me on shore to look after his
little garden, and do the common drudgery of slaves about his house; and when
he came home again from his cruise, he ordered me to lie in the cabin to look
after the ship.
Here I meditated nothing but my escape, and what method I might take to effect
it, but found no way that had the least probability in it; nothing presented to
make the supposition of it rational; for I had nobody to communicate it to that
would embark with me—no fellow-slave, no Englishman, Irishman, or
Scotchman there but myself; so that for two years, though I often pleased
myself with the imagination, yet I never had the least encouraging prospect of
putting it in practice.
After about two years, an odd circumstance presented itself, which put the old
thought of making some attempt for my liberty again in my head. My patron lying
at home longer than usual without fitting out his ship, which, as I heard, was
for want of money, he used constantly, once or twice a week, sometimes oftener
if the weather was fair, to take the ship’s pinnace and go out into the
road a-fishing; and as he always took me and young Maresco with him to row the
boat, we made him very merry, and I proved very dexterous in catching fish;
insomuch that sometimes he would send me with a Moor, one of his kinsmen, and
the youth—the Maresco, as they called him—to catch a dish of fish
for him.
It happened one time, that going a-fishing in a calm morning, a fog rose so
thick that, though we were not half a league from the shore, we lost sight of
it; and rowing we knew not whither or which way, we laboured all day, and all
the next night; and when the morning came we found we had pulled off to sea
instead of pulling in for the shore; and that we were at least two leagues from
the shore. However, we got well in again, though with a great deal of labour
and some danger; for the wind began to blow pretty fresh in the morning; but we
were all very hungry.
But our patron, warned by this disaster, resolved to take more care of himself
for the future; and having lying by him the longboat of our English ship that
he had taken, he resolved he would not go a-fishing any more without a compass
and some provision; so he ordered the carpenter of his ship, who also was an
English slave, to build a little state-room, or cabin, in the middle of the
long-boat, like that of a barge, with a place to stand behind it to steer, and
haul home the main-sheet; the room before for a hand or two to stand and work
the sails. She sailed with what we call a shoulder-of-mutton sail; and the boom
jibed over the top of the cabin, which lay very snug and low, and had in it
room for him to lie, with a slave or two, and a table to eat on, with some
small lockers to put in some bottles of such liquor as he thought fit to drink;
and his bread, rice, and coffee.
We went frequently out with this boat a-fishing; and as I was most dexterous to
catch fish for him, he never went without me. It happened that he had appointed
to go out in this boat, either for pleasure or for fish, with two or three
Moors of some distinction in that place, and for whom he had provided
extraordinarily, and had, therefore, sent on board the boat overnight a larger
store of provisions than ordinary; and had ordered me to get ready three fusees
with powder and shot, which were on board his ship, for that they designed some
sport of fowling as well as fishing.
I got all things ready as he had directed, and waited the next morning with the
boat washed clean, her ancient and pendants out, and everything to accommodate
his guests; when by-and-by my patron came on board alone, and told me his
guests had put off going from some business that fell out, and ordered me, with
the man and boy, as usual, to go out with the boat and catch them some fish,
for that his friends were to sup at his house, and commanded that as soon as I
got some fish I should bring it home to his house; all which I prepared to do.
This moment my former notions of deliverance darted into my thoughts, for now I
found I was likely to have a little ship at my command; and my master being
gone, I prepared to furnish myself, not for fishing business, but for a voyage;
though I knew not, neither did I so much as consider, whither I should
steer—anywhere to get out of that place was my desire.
My first contrivance was to make a pretence to speak to this Moor, to get
something for our subsistence on board; for I told him we must not presume to
eat of our patron’s bread. He said that was true; so he brought a large
basket of rusk or biscuit, and three jars of fresh water, into the boat. I knew
where my patron’s case of bottles stood, which it was evident, by the
make, were taken out of some English prize, and I conveyed them into the boat
while the Moor was on shore, as if they had been there before for our master. I
conveyed also a great lump of beeswax into the boat, which weighed about half a
hundred-weight, with a parcel of twine or thread, a hatchet, a saw, and a
hammer, all of which were of great use to us afterwards, especially the wax, to
make candles. Another trick I tried upon him, which he innocently came into
also: his name was Ismael, which they call Muley, or Moely; so I called to
him—“Moely,” said I, “our patron’s guns are on
board the boat; can you not get a little powder and shot? It may be we may kill
some alcamies (a fowl like our curlews) for ourselves, for I know he keeps the
gunner’s stores in the ship.” “Yes,” says he,
“I’ll bring some;” and accordingly he brought a great leather
pouch, which held a pound and a half of powder, or rather more; and another
with shot, that had five or six pounds, with some bullets, and put all into the
boat. At the same time I had found some powder of my master’s in the
great cabin, with which I filled one of the large bottles in the case, which
was almost empty, pouring what was in it into another; and thus furnished with
everything needful, we sailed out of the port to fish. The castle, which is at
the entrance of the port, knew who we were, and took no notice of us; and we
were not above a mile out of the port before we hauled in our sail and set us
down to fish. The wind blew from the N.N.E., which was contrary to my desire,
for had it blown southerly I had been sure to have made the coast of Spain, and
at least reached to the bay of Cadiz; but my resolutions were, blow which way
it would, I would be gone from that horrid place where I was, and leave the
rest to fate.
After we had fished some time and caught nothing—for when I had fish on
my hook I would not pull them up, that he might not see them—I said to
the Moor, “This will not do; our master will not be thus served; we must
stand farther off.” He, thinking no harm, agreed, and being in the head
of the boat, set the sails; and, as I had the helm, I ran the boat out near a
league farther, and then brought her to, as if I would fish; when, giving the
boy the helm, I stepped forward to where the Moor was, and making as if I
stooped for something behind him, I took him by surprise with my arm under his
waist, and tossed him clear overboard into the sea. He rose immediately, for he
swam like a cork, and called to me, begged to be taken in, told me he would go
all over the world with me. He swam so strong after the boat that he would have
reached me very quickly, there being but little wind; upon which I stepped into
the cabin, and fetching one of the fowling-pieces, I presented it at him, and
told him I had done him no hurt, and if he would be quiet I would do him none.
“But,” said I, “you swim well enough to reach to the shore,
and the sea is calm; make the best of your way to shore, and I will do you no
harm; but if you come near the boat I’ll shoot you through the head, for
I am resolved to have my liberty;” so he turned himself about, and swam
for the shore, and I make no doubt but he reached it with ease, for he was an
excellent swimmer.
I could have been content to have taken this Moor with me, and have drowned the
boy, but there was no venturing to trust him. When he was gone, I turned to the
boy, whom they called Xury, and said to him, “Xury, if you will be
faithful to me, I’ll make you a great man; but if you will not stroke
your face to be true to me”—that is, swear by Mahomet and his
father’s beard—“I must throw you into the sea too.” The
boy smiled in my face, and spoke so innocently that I could not distrust him,
and swore to be faithful to me, and go all over the world with me.
While I was in view of the Moor that was swimming, I stood out directly to sea
with the boat, rather stretching to windward, that they might think me gone
towards the Straits’ mouth (as indeed any one that had been in their wits
must have been supposed to do): for who would have supposed we were sailed on
to the southward, to the truly Barbarian coast, where whole nations of negroes
were sure to surround us with their canoes and destroy us; where we could not
go on shore but we should be devoured by savage beasts, or more merciless
savages of human kind.
But as soon as it grew dusk in the evening, I changed my course, and steered
directly south and by east, bending my course a little towards the east, that I
might keep in with the shore; and having a fair, fresh gale of wind, and a
smooth, quiet sea, I made such sail that I believe by the next day, at three
o’clock in the afternoon, when I first made the land, I could not be less
than one hundred and fifty miles south of Sallee; quite beyond the Emperor of
Morocco’s dominions, or indeed of any other king thereabouts, for we saw
no people.
Yet such was the fright I had taken of the Moors, and the dreadful
apprehensions I had of falling into their hands, that I would not stop, or go
on shore, or come to an anchor; the wind continuing fair till I had sailed in
that manner five days; and then the wind shifting to the southward, I concluded
also that if any of our vessels were in chase of me, they also would now give
over; so I ventured to make to the coast, and came to an anchor in the mouth of
a little river, I knew not what, nor where, neither what latitude, what
country, what nation, or what river. I neither saw, nor desired to see any
people; the principal thing I wanted was fresh water. We came into this creek
in the evening, resolving to swim on shore as soon as it was dark, and discover
the country; but as soon as it was quite dark, we heard such dreadful noises of
the barking, roaring, and howling of wild creatures, of we knew not what kinds,
that the poor boy was ready to die with fear, and begged of me not to go on
shore till day. “Well, Xury,” said I, “then I won’t;
but it may be that we may see men by day, who will be as bad to us as those
lions.” “Then we give them the shoot gun,” says Xury,
laughing, “make them run wey.” Such English Xury spoke by
conversing among us slaves. However, I was glad to see the boy so cheerful, and
I gave him a dram (out of our patron’s case of bottles) to cheer him up.
After all, Xury’s advice was good, and I took it; we dropped our little
anchor, and lay still all night; I say still, for we slept none; for in two or
three hours we saw vast great creatures (we knew not what to call them) of many
sorts, come down to the sea-shore and run into the water, wallowing and washing
themselves for the pleasure of cooling themselves; and they made such hideous
howlings and yellings, that I never indeed heard the like.
Xury was dreadfully frighted, and indeed so was I too; but we were both more
frighted when we heard one of these mighty creatures come swimming towards our
boat; we could not see him, but we might hear him by his blowing to be a
monstrous huge and furious beast. Xury said it was a lion, and it might be so
for aught I know; but poor Xury cried to me to weigh the anchor and row away;
“No,” says I, “Xury; we can slip our cable, with the buoy to
it, and go off to sea; they cannot follow us far.” I had no sooner said
so, but I perceived the creature (whatever it was) within two oars’
length, which something surprised me; however, I immediately stepped to the
cabin door, and taking up my gun, fired at him; upon which he immediately
turned about and swam towards the shore again.
But it is impossible to describe the horrid noises, and hideous cries and
howlings that were raised, as well upon the edge of the shore as higher within
the country, upon the noise or report of the gun, a thing I have some reason to
believe those creatures had never heard before: this convinced me that there
was no going on shore for us in the night on that coast, and how to venture on
shore in the day was another question too; for to have fallen into the hands of
any of the savages had been as bad as to have fallen into the hands of the
lions and tigers; at least we were equally apprehensive of the danger of it.
Be that as it would, we were obliged to go on shore somewhere or other for
water, for we had not a pint left in the boat; when and where to get to it was
the point. Xury said, if I would let him go on shore with one of the jars, he
would find if there was any water, and bring some to me. I asked him why he
would go? why I should not go, and he stay in the boat? The boy answered with
so much affection as made me love him ever after. Says he, “If wild mans
come, they eat me, you go wey.” “Well, Xury,” said I,
“we will both go and if the wild mans come, we will kill them, they shall
eat neither of us.” So I gave Xury a piece of rusk bread to eat, and a
dram out of our patron’s case of bottles which I mentioned before; and we
hauled the boat in as near the shore as we thought was proper, and so waded on
shore, carrying nothing but our arms and two jars for water.
I did not care to go out of sight of the boat, fearing the coming of canoes
with savages down the river; but the boy seeing a low place about a mile up the
country, rambled to it, and by-and-by I saw him come running towards me. I
thought he was pursued by some savage, or frighted with some wild beast, and I
ran forward towards him to help him; but when I came nearer to him I saw
something hanging over his shoulders, which was a creature that he had shot,
like a hare, but different in colour, and longer legs; however, we were very
glad of it, and it was very good meat; but the great joy that poor Xury came
with, was to tell me he had found good water and seen no wild mans.
But we found afterwards that we need not take such pains for water, for a
little higher up the creek where we were we found the water fresh when the tide
was out, which flowed but a little way up; so we filled our jars, and feasted
on the hare he had killed, and prepared to go on our way, having seen no
footsteps of any human creature in that part of the country.
As I had been one voyage to this coast before, I knew very well that the
islands of the Canaries, and the Cape de Verde Islands also, lay not far off
from the coast. But as I had no instruments to take an observation to know what
latitude we were in, and not exactly knowing, or at least remembering, what
latitude they were in, I knew not where to look for them, or when to stand off
to sea towards them; otherwise I might now easily have found some of these
islands. But my hope was, that if I stood along this coast till I came to that
part where the English traded, I should find some of their vessels upon their
usual design of trade, that would relieve and take us in.
By the best of my calculation, that place where I now was must be that country
which, lying between the Emperor of Morocco’s dominions and the negroes,
lies waste and uninhabited, except by wild beasts; the negroes having abandoned
it and gone farther south for fear of the Moors, and the Moors not thinking it
worth inhabiting by reason of its barrenness; and indeed, both forsaking it
because of the prodigious number of tigers, lions, leopards, and other furious
creatures which harbour there; so that the Moors use it for their hunting only,
where they go like an army, two or three thousand men at a time; and indeed for
near a hundred miles together upon this coast we saw nothing but a waste,
uninhabited country by day, and heard nothing but howlings and roaring of wild
beasts by night.
Once or twice in the daytime I thought I saw the Pico of Teneriffe, being the
high top of the Mountain Teneriffe in the Canaries, and had a great mind to
venture out, in hopes of reaching thither; but having tried twice, I was forced
in again by contrary winds, the sea also going too high for my little vessel;
so, I resolved to pursue my first design, and keep along the shore.
Several times I was obliged to land for fresh water, after we had left this
place; and once in particular, being early in morning, we came to an anchor
under a little point of land, which was pretty high; and the tide beginning to
flow, we lay still to go farther in. Xury, whose eyes were more about him than
it seems mine were, calls softly to me, and tells me that we had best go
farther off the shore; “For,” says he, “look, yonder lies a
dreadful monster on the side of that hillock, fast asleep.” I looked
where he pointed, and saw a dreadful monster indeed, for it was a terrible,
great lion that lay on the side of the shore, under the shade of a piece of the
hill that hung as it were a little over him. “Xury,” says I,
“you shall on shore and kill him.” Xury, looked frighted, and said,
“Me kill! he eat me at one mouth!”—one mouthful he meant.
However, I said no more to the boy, but bade him lie still, and I took our
biggest gun, which was almost musket-bore, and loaded it with a good charge of
powder, and with two slugs, and laid it down; then I loaded another gun with
two bullets; and the third (for we had three pieces) I loaded with five smaller
bullets. I took the best aim I could with the first piece to have shot him in
the head, but he lay so with his leg raised a little above his nose, that the
slugs hit his leg about the knee and broke the bone. He started up, growling at
first, but finding his leg broken, fell down again; and then got upon three
legs, and gave the most hideous roar that ever I heard. I was a little
surprised that I had not hit him on the head; however, I took up the second
piece immediately, and though he began to move off, fired again, and shot him
in the head, and had the pleasure to see him drop and make but little noise,
but lie struggling for life. Then Xury took heart, and would have me let him go
on shore. “Well, go,” said I: so the boy jumped into the water and
taking a little gun in one hand, swam to shore with the other hand, and coming
close to the creature, put the muzzle of the piece to his ear, and shot him in
the head again, which despatched him quite.
This was game indeed to us, but this was no food; and I was very sorry to lose
three charges of powder and shot upon a creature that was good for nothing to
us. However, Xury said he would have some of him; so he comes on board, and
asked me to give him the hatchet. “For what, Xury?” said I.
“Me cut off his head,” said he. However, Xury could not cut off his
head, but he cut off a foot, and brought it with him, and it was a monstrous
great one.
I bethought myself, however, that, perhaps the skin of him might, one way or
other, be of some value to us; and I resolved to take off his skin if I could.
So Xury and I went to work with him; but Xury was much the better workman at
it, for I knew very ill how to do it. Indeed, it took us both up the whole day,
but at last we got off the hide of him, and spreading it on the top of our
cabin, the sun effectually dried it in two days’ time, and it afterwards
served me to lie upon.
CHAPTER III.
WRECKED ON A DESERT ISLAND
After this stop, we made on to the southward continually for ten or twelve
days, living very sparingly on our provisions, which began to abate very much,
and going no oftener to the shore than we were obliged to for fresh water. My
design in this was to make the river Gambia or Senegal, that is to say anywhere
about the Cape de Verde, where I was in hopes to meet with some European ship;
and if I did not, I knew not what course I had to take, but to seek for the
islands, or perish there among the negroes. I knew that all the ships from
Europe, which sailed either to the coast of Guinea or to Brazil, or to the East
Indies, made this cape, or those islands; and, in a word, I put the whole of my
fortune upon this single point, either that I must meet with some ship or must
perish.
When I had pursued this resolution about ten days longer, as I have said, I
began to see that the land was inhabited; and in two or three places, as we
sailed by, we saw people stand upon the shore to look at us; we could also
perceive they were quite black and naked. I was once inclined to have gone on
shore to them; but Xury was my better counsellor, and said to me, “No go,
no go.” However, I hauled in nearer the shore that I might talk to them,
and I found they ran along the shore by me a good way. I observed they had no
weapons in their hand, except one, who had a long slender stick, which Xury
said was a lance, and that they could throw them a great way with good aim; so
I kept at a distance, but talked with them by signs as well as I could; and
particularly made signs for something to eat: they beckoned to me to stop my
boat, and they would fetch me some meat. Upon this I lowered the top of my sail
and lay by, and two of them ran up into the country, and in less than
half-an-hour came back, and brought with them two pieces of dried flesh and
some corn, such as is the produce of their country; but we neither knew what
the one or the other was; however, we were willing to accept it, but how to
come at it was our next dispute, for I would not venture on shore to them, and
they were as much afraid of us; but they took a safe way for us all, for they
brought it to the shore and laid it down, and went and stood a great way off
till we fetched it on board, and then came close to us again.
We made signs of thanks to them, for we had nothing to make them amends; but an
opportunity offered that very instant to oblige them wonderfully; for while we
were lying by the shore came two mighty creatures, one pursuing the other (as
we took it) with great fury from the mountains towards the sea; whether it was
the male pursuing the female, or whether they were in sport or in rage, we
could not tell, any more than we could tell whether it was usual or strange,
but I believe it was the latter; because, in the first place, those ravenous
creatures seldom appear but in the night; and, in the second place, we found
the people terribly frighted, especially the women. The man that had the lance
or dart did not fly from them, but the rest did; however, as the two creatures
ran directly into the water, they did not offer to fall upon any of the
negroes, but plunged themselves into the sea, and swam about, as if they had
come for their diversion; at last one of them began to come nearer our boat
than at first I expected; but I lay ready for him, for I had loaded my gun with
all possible expedition, and bade Xury load both the others. As soon as he came
fairly within my reach, I fired, and shot him directly in the head; immediately
he sank down into the water, but rose instantly, and plunged up and down, as if
he were struggling for life, and so indeed he was; he immediately made to the
shore; but between the wound, which was his mortal hurt, and the strangling of
the water, he died just before he reached the shore.
It is impossible to express the astonishment of these poor creatures at the
noise and fire of my gun: some of them were even ready to die for fear, and
fell down as dead with the very terror; but when they saw the creature dead,
and sunk in the water, and that I made signs to them to come to the shore, they
took heart and came, and began to search for the creature. I found him by his
blood staining the water; and by the help of a rope, which I slung round him,
and gave the negroes to haul, they dragged him on shore, and found that it was
a most curious leopard, spotted, and fine to an admirable degree; and the
negroes held up their hands with admiration, to think what it was I had killed
him with.
The other creature, frighted with the flash of fire and the noise of the gun,
swam on shore, and ran up directly to the mountains from whence they came; nor
could I, at that distance, know what it was. I found quickly the negroes wished
to eat the flesh of this creature, so I was willing to have them take it as a
favour from me; which, when I made signs to them that they might take him, they
were very thankful for. Immediately they fell to work with him; and though they
had no knife, yet, with a sharpened piece of wood, they took off his skin as
readily, and much more readily, than we could have done with a knife. They
offered me some of the flesh, which I declined, pointing out that I would give
it them; but made signs for the skin, which they gave me very freely, and
brought me a great deal more of their provisions, which, though I did not
understand, yet I accepted. I then made signs to them for some water, and held
out one of my jars to them, turning it bottom upward, to show that it was
empty, and that I wanted to have it filled. They called immediately to some of
their friends, and there came two women, and brought a great vessel made of
earth, and burnt, as I supposed, in the sun, this they set down to me, as
before, and I sent Xury on shore with my jars, and filled them all three. The
women were as naked as the men.
I was now furnished with roots and corn, such as it was, and water; and leaving
my friendly negroes, I made forward for about eleven days more, without
offering to go near the shore, till I saw the land run out a great length into
the sea, at about the distance of four or five leagues before me; and the sea
being very calm, I kept a large offing to make this point. At length, doubling
the point, at about two leagues from the land, I saw plainly land on the other
side, to seaward; then I concluded, as it was most certain indeed, that this
was the Cape de Verde, and those the islands called, from thence, Cape de Verde
Islands. However, they were at a great distance, and I could not well tell what
I had best to do; for if I should be taken with a fresh of wind, I might
neither reach one or other.
In this dilemma, as I was very pensive, I stepped into the cabin and sat down,
Xury having the helm; when, on a sudden, the boy cried out, “Master,
master, a ship with a sail!” and the foolish boy was frighted out of his
wits, thinking it must needs be some of his master’s ships sent to pursue
us, but I knew we were far enough out of their reach. I jumped out of the
cabin, and immediately saw, not only the ship, but that it was a Portuguese
ship; and, as I thought, was bound to the coast of Guinea, for negroes. But,
when I observed the course she steered, I was soon convinced they were bound
some other way, and did not design to come any nearer to the shore; upon which
I stretched out to sea as much as I could, resolving to speak with them if
possible.
With all the sail I could make, I found I should not be able to come in their
way, but that they would be gone by before I could make any signal to them: but
after I had crowded to the utmost, and began to despair, they, it seems, saw by
the help of their glasses that it was some European boat, which they supposed
must belong to some ship that was lost; so they shortened sail to let me come
up. I was encouraged with this, and as I had my patron’s ancient on
board, I made a waft of it to them, for a signal of distress, and fired a gun,
both which they saw; for they told me they saw the smoke, though they did not
hear the gun. Upon these signals they very kindly brought to, and lay by for
me; and in about three hours; time I came up with them.
They asked me what I was, in Portuguese, and in Spanish, and in French, but I
understood none of them; but at last a Scotch sailor, who was on board, called
to me: and I answered him, and told him I was an Englishman, that I had made my
escape out of slavery from the Moors, at Sallee; they then bade me come on
board, and very kindly took me in, and all my goods.
It was an inexpressible joy to me, which any one will believe, that I was thus
delivered, as I esteemed it, from such a miserable and almost hopeless
condition as I was in; and I immediately offered all I had to the captain of
the ship, as a return for my deliverance; but he generously told me he would
take nothing from me, but that all I had should be delivered safe to me when I
came to the Brazils. “For,” says he, “I have saved your life
on no other terms than I would be glad to be saved myself: and it may, one time
or other, be my lot to be taken up in the same condition. Besides,” said
he, “when I carry you to the Brazils, so great a way from your own
country, if I should take from you what you have, you will be starved there,
and then I only take away that life I have given. No, no,” says he:
“Seignior Inglese” (Mr. Englishman), “I will carry you
thither in charity, and those things will help to buy your subsistence there,
and your passage home again.”
As he was charitable in this proposal, so he was just in the performance to a
tittle; for he ordered the seamen that none should touch anything that I had:
then he took everything into his own possession, and gave me back an exact
inventory of them, that I might have them, even to my three earthen jars.
As to my boat, it was a very good one; and that he saw, and told me he would
buy it of me for his ship’s use; and asked me what I would have for it? I
told him he had been so generous to me in everything that I could not offer to
make any price of the boat, but left it entirely to him: upon which he told me
he would give me a note of hand to pay me eighty pieces of eight for it at
Brazil; and when it came there, if any one offered to give more, he would make
it up. He offered me also sixty pieces of eight more for my boy Xury, which I
was loth to take; not that I was unwilling to let the captain have him, but I
was very loth to sell the poor boy’s liberty, who had assisted me so
faithfully in procuring my own. However, when I let him know my reason, he
owned it to be just, and offered me this medium, that he would give the boy an
obligation to set him free in ten years, if he turned Christian: upon this, and
Xury saying he was willing to go to him, I let the captain have him.
We had a very good voyage to the Brazils, and I arrived in the Bay de Todos los
Santos, or All Saints’ Bay, in about twenty-two days after. And now I was
once more delivered from the most miserable of all conditions of life; and what
to do next with myself I was to consider.
The generous treatment the captain gave me I can never enough remember: he
would take nothing of me for my passage, gave me twenty ducats for the
leopard’s skin, and forty for the lion’s skin, which I had in my
boat, and caused everything I had in the ship to be punctually delivered to me;
and what I was willing to sell he bought of me, such as the case of bottles,
two of my guns, and a piece of the lump of beeswax—for I had made candles
of the rest: in a word, I made about two hundred and twenty pieces of eight of
all my cargo; and with this stock I went on shore in the Brazils.
I had not been long here before I was recommended to the house of a good honest
man like himself, who had an , as they call it (that is, a
plantation and a sugar-house). I lived with him some time, and acquainted
myself by that means with the manner of planting and making of sugar; and
seeing how well the planters lived, and how they got rich suddenly, I resolved,
if I could get a licence to settle there, I would turn planter among them:
resolving in the meantime to find out some way to get my money, which I had
left in London, remitted to me. To this purpose, getting a kind of letter of
naturalisation, I purchased as much land that was uncured as my money would
reach, and formed a plan for my plantation and settlement; such a one as might
be suitable to the stock which I proposed to myself to receive from England.
I had a neighbour, a Portuguese, of Lisbon, but born of English parents, whose
name was Wells, and in much such circumstances as I was. I call him my
neighbour, because his plantation lay next to mine, and we went on very
sociably together. My stock was but low, as well as his; and we rather planted
for food than anything else, for about two years. However, we began to
increase, and our land began to come into order; so that the third year we
planted some tobacco, and made each of us a large piece of ground ready for
planting canes in the year to come. But we both wanted help; and now I found,
more than before, I had done wrong in parting with my boy Xury.
But, alas! for me to do wrong that never did right, was no great wonder. I had
no remedy but to go on: I had got into an employment quite remote to my genius,
and directly contrary to the life I delighted in, and for which I forsook my
father’s house, and broke through all his good advice. Nay, I was coming
into the very middle station, or upper degree of low life, which my father
advised me to before, and which, if I resolved to go on with, I might as well
have stayed at home, and never have fatigued myself in the world as I had done;
and I used often to say to myself, I could have done this as well in England,
among my friends, as have gone five thousand miles off to do it among strangers
and savages, in a wilderness, and at such a distance as never to hear from any
part of the world that had the least knowledge of me.
In this manner I used to look upon my condition with the utmost regret. I had
nobody to converse with, but now and then this neighbour; no work to be done,
but by the labour of my hands; and I used to say, I lived just like a man cast
away upon some desolate island, that had nobody there but himself. But how just
has it been—and how should all men reflect, that when they compare their
present conditions with others that are worse, Heaven may oblige them to make
the exchange, and be convinced of their former felicity by their
experience—I say, how just has it been, that the truly solitary life I
reflected on, in an island of mere desolation, should be my lot, who had so
often unjustly compared it with the life which I then led, in which, had I
continued, I had in all probability been exceeding prosperous and rich.
I was in some degree settled in my measures for carrying on the plantation
before my kind friend, the captain of the ship that took me up at sea, went
back—for the ship remained there, in providing his lading and preparing
for his voyage, nearly three months—when telling him what little stock I
had left behind me in London, he gave me this friendly and sincere
advice:—“Seignior Inglese,” says he (for so he always called
me), “if you will give me letters, and a procuration in form to me, with
orders to the person who has your money in London to send your effects to
Lisbon, to such persons as I shall direct, and in such goods as are proper for
this country, I will bring you the produce of them, God willing, at my return;
but, since human affairs are all subject to changes and disasters, I would have
you give orders but for one hundred pounds sterling, which, you say, is half
your stock, and let the hazard be run for the first; so that, if it come safe,
you may order the rest the same way, and, if it miscarry, you may have the
other half to have recourse to for your supply.”
This was so wholesome advice, and looked so friendly, that I could not but be
convinced it was the best course I could take; so I accordingly prepared
letters to the gentlewoman with whom I had left my money, and a procuration to
the Portuguese captain, as he desired.
I wrote the English captain’s widow a full account of all my
adventures—my slavery, escape, and how I had met with the Portuguese
captain at sea, the humanity of his behaviour, and what condition I was now in,
with all other necessary directions for my supply; and when this honest captain
came to Lisbon, he found means, by some of the English merchants there, to send
over, not the order only, but a full account of my story to a merchant in
London, who represented it effectually to her; whereupon she not only delivered
the money, but out of her own pocket sent the Portugal captain a very handsome
present for his humanity and charity to me.
The merchant in London, vesting this hundred pounds in English goods, such as
the captain had written for, sent them directly to him at Lisbon, and he
brought them all safe to me to the Brazils; among which, without my direction
(for I was too young in my business to think of them), he had taken care to
have all sorts of tools, ironwork, and utensils necessary for my plantation,
and which were of great use to me.
When this cargo arrived I thought my fortune made, for I was surprised with the
joy of it; and my stood steward, the captain, had laid out the five pounds,
which my friend had sent him for a present for himself, to purchase and bring
me over a servant, under bond for six years’ service, and would not
accept of any consideration, except a little tobacco, which I would have him
accept, being of my own produce.
Neither was this all; for my goods being all English manufacture, such as
cloths, stuffs, baize, and things particularly valuable and desirable in the
country, I found means to sell them to a very great advantage; so that I might
say I had more than four times the value of my first cargo, and was now
infinitely beyond my poor neighbour—I mean in the advancement of my
plantation; for the first thing I did, I bought me a negro slave, and an
European servant also—I mean another besides that which the captain
brought me from Lisbon.
But as abused prosperity is oftentimes made the very means of our greatest
adversity, so it was with me. I went on the next year with great success in my
plantation: I raised fifty great rolls of tobacco on my own ground, more than I
had disposed of for necessaries among my neighbours; and these fifty rolls,
being each of above a hundredweight, were well cured, and laid by against the
return of the fleet from Lisbon: and now increasing in business and wealth, my
head began to be full of projects and undertakings beyond my reach; such as
are, indeed, often the ruin of the best heads in business. Had I continued in
the station I was now in, I had room for all the happy things to have yet
befallen me for which my father so earnestly recommended a quiet, retired life,
and of which he had so sensibly described the middle station of life to be full
of; but other things attended me, and I was still to be the wilful agent of all
my own miseries; and particularly, to increase my fault, and double the
reflections upon myself, which in my future sorrows I should have leisure to
make, all these miscarriages were procured by my apparent obstinate adhering to
my foolish inclination of wandering abroad, and pursuing that inclination, in
contradiction to the clearest views of doing myself good in a fair and plain
pursuit of those prospects, and those measures of life, which nature and
Providence concurred to present me with, and to make my duty.
As I had once done thus in my breaking away from my parents, so I could not be
content now, but I must go and leave the happy view I had of being a rich and
thriving man in my new plantation, only to pursue a rash and immoderate desire
of rising faster than the nature of the thing admitted; and thus I cast myself
down again into the deepest gulf of human misery that ever man fell into, or
perhaps could be consistent with life and a state of health in the world.
To come, then, by the just degrees to the particulars of this part of my story.
You may suppose, that having now lived almost four years in the Brazils, and
beginning to thrive and prosper very well upon my plantation, I had not only
learned the language, but had contracted acquaintance and friendship among my
fellow-planters, as well as among the merchants at St. Salvador, which was our
port; and that, in my discourses among them, I had frequently given them an
account of my two voyages to the coast of Guinea: the manner of trading with
the negroes there, and how easy it was to purchase upon the coast for
trifles—such as beads, toys, knives, scissors, hatchets, bits of glass,
and the like—not only gold-dust, Guinea grains, elephants’ teeth,
&c., but negroes, for the service of the Brazils, in great numbers.
They listened always very attentively to my discourses on these heads, but
especially to that part which related to the buying of negroes, which was a
trade at that time, not only not far entered into, but, as far as it was, had
been carried on by assientos, or permission of the kings of Spain and Portugal,
and engrossed in the public stock: so that few negroes were bought, and these
excessively dear.
It happened, being in company with some merchants and planters of my
acquaintance, and talking of those things very earnestly, three of them came to
me next morning, and told me they had been musing very much upon what I had
discoursed with them of the last night, and they came to make a secret proposal
to me; and, after enjoining me to secrecy, they told me that they had a mind to
fit out a ship to go to Guinea; that they had all plantations as well as I, and
were straitened for nothing so much as servants; that as it was a trade that
could not be carried on, because they could not publicly sell the negroes when
they came home, so they desired to make but one voyage, to bring the negroes on
shore privately, and divide them among their own plantations; and, in a word,
the question was whether I would go their supercargo in the ship, to manage the
trading part upon the coast of Guinea; and they offered me that I should have
my equal share of the negroes, without providing any part of the stock.
This was a fair proposal, it must be confessed, had it been made to any one
that had not had a settlement and a plantation of his own to look after, which
was in a fair way of coming to be very considerable, and with a good stock upon
it; but for me, that was thus entered and established, and had nothing to do
but to go on as I had begun, for three or four years more, and to have sent for
the other hundred pounds from England; and who in that time, and with that
little addition, could scarce have failed of being worth three or four thousand
pounds sterling, and that increasing too—for me to think of such a voyage
was the most preposterous thing that ever man in such circumstances could be
guilty of.
But I, that was born to be my own destroyer, could no more resist the offer
than I could restrain my first rambling designs when my father’s good
counsel was lost upon me. In a word, I told them I would go with all my heart,
if they would undertake to look after my plantation in my absence, and would
dispose of it to such as I should direct, if I miscarried. This they all
engaged to do, and entered into writings or covenants to do so; and I made a
formal will, disposing of my plantation and effects in case of my death, making
the captain of the ship that had saved my life, as before, my universal heir,
but obliging him to dispose of my effects as I had directed in my will; one
half of the produce being to himself, and the other to be shipped to England.
In short, I took all possible caution to preserve my effects and to keep up my
plantation. Had I used half as much prudence to have looked into my own
interest, and have made a judgment of what I ought to have done and not to have
done, I had certainly never gone away from so prosperous an undertaking,
leaving all the probable views of a thriving circumstance, and gone upon a
voyage to sea, attended with all its common hazards, to say nothing of the
reasons I had to expect particular misfortunes to myself.
But I was hurried on, and obeyed blindly the dictates of my fancy rather than
my reason; and, accordingly, the ship being fitted out, and the cargo
furnished, and all things done, as by agreement, by my partners in the voyage,
I went on board in an evil hour, the 1st September 1659, being the same day
eight years that I went from my father and mother at Hull, in order to act the
rebel to their authority, and the fool to my own interests.
Our ship was about one hundred and twenty tons burden, carried six guns and
fourteen men, besides the master, his boy, and myself. We had on board no large
cargo of goods, except of such toys as were fit for our trade with the negroes,
such as beads, bits of glass, shells, and other trifles, especially little
looking-glasses, knives, scissors, hatchets, and the like.
The same day I went on board we set sail, standing away to the northward upon
our own coast, with design to stretch over for the African coast when we came
about ten or twelve degrees of northern latitude, which, it seems, was the
manner of course in those days. We had very good weather, only excessively hot,
all the way upon our own coast, till we came to the height of Cape St.
Augustino; from whence, keeping further off at sea, we lost sight of land, and
steered as if we were bound for the isle Fernando de Noronha, holding our
course N.E. by N., and leaving those isles on the east. In this course we
passed the line in about twelve days’ time, and were, by our last
observation, in seven degrees twenty-two minutes northern latitude, when a
violent tornado, or hurricane, took us quite out of our knowledge. It began
from the south-east, came about to the north-west, and then settled in the
north-east; from whence it blew in such a terrible manner, that for twelve days
together we could do nothing but drive, and, scudding away before it, let it
carry us whither fate and the fury of the winds directed; and, during these
twelve days, I need not say that I expected every day to be swallowed up; nor,
indeed, did any in the ship expect to save their lives.
In this distress we had, besides the terror of the storm, one of our men die of
the calenture, and one man and the boy washed overboard. About the twelfth day,
the weather abating a little, the master made an observation as well as he
could, and found that he was in about eleven degrees north latitude, but that
he was twenty-two degrees of longitude difference west from Cape St. Augustino;
so that he found he was upon the coast of Guiana, or the north part of Brazil,
beyond the river Amazon, toward that of the river Orinoco, commonly called the
Great River; and began to consult with me what course he should take, for the
ship was leaky, and very much disabled, and he was going directly back to the
coast of Brazil.
I was positively against that; and looking over the charts of the sea-coast of
America with him, we concluded there was no inhabited country for us to have
recourse to till we came within the circle of the Caribbee Islands, and
therefore resolved to stand away for Barbadoes; which, by keeping off at sea,
to avoid the indraft of the Bay or Gulf of Mexico, we might easily perform, as
we hoped, in about fifteen days’ sail; whereas we could not possibly make
our voyage to the coast of Africa without some assistance both to our ship and
to ourselves.
With this design we changed our course, and steered away N.W. by W., in order
to reach some of our English islands, where I hoped for relief. But our voyage
was otherwise determined; for, being in the latitude of twelve degrees eighteen
minutes, a second storm came upon us, which carried us away with the same
impetuosity westward, and drove us so out of the way of all human commerce,
that, had all our lives been saved as to the sea, we were rather in danger of
being devoured by savages than ever returning to our own country.
In this distress, the wind still blowing very hard, one of our men early in the
morning cried out, “Land!” and we had no sooner run out of the
cabin to look out, in hopes of seeing whereabouts in the world we were, than
the ship struck upon a sand, and in a moment her motion being so stopped, the
sea broke over her in such a manner that we expected we should all have
perished immediately; and we were immediately driven into our close quarters,
to shelter us from the very foam and spray of the sea.
It is not easy for any one who has not been in the like condition to describe
or conceive the consternation of men in such circumstances. We knew nothing
where we were, or upon what land it was we were driven—whether an island
or the main, whether inhabited or not inhabited. As the rage of the wind was
still great, though rather less than at first, we could not so much as hope to
have the ship hold many minutes without breaking into pieces, unless the winds,
by a kind of miracle, should turn immediately about. In a word, we sat looking
upon one another, and expecting death every moment, and every man, accordingly,
preparing for another world; for there was little or nothing more for us to do
in this. That which was our present comfort, and all the comfort we had, was
that, contrary to our expectation, the ship did not break yet, and that the
master said the wind began to abate.
Now, though we thought that the wind did a little abate, yet the ship having
thus struck upon the sand, and sticking too fast for us to expect her getting
off, we were in a dreadful condition indeed, and had nothing to do but to think
of saving our lives as well as we could. We had a boat at our stern just before
the storm, but she was first staved by dashing against the ship’s rudder,
and in the next place she broke away, and either sunk or was driven off to sea;
so there was no hope from her. We had another boat on board, but how to get her
off into the sea was a doubtful thing. However, there was no time to debate,
for we fancied that the ship would break in pieces every minute, and some told
us she was actually broken already.
In this distress the mate of our vessel laid hold of the boat, and with the
help of the rest of the men got her slung over the ship’s side; and
getting all into her, let go, and committed ourselves, being eleven in number,
to God’s mercy and the wild sea; for though the storm was abated
considerably, yet the sea ran dreadfully high upon the shore, and might be well
called , as the Dutch call the sea in a storm.
And now our case was very dismal indeed; for we all saw plainly that the sea
went so high that the boat could not live, and that we should be inevitably
drowned. As to making sail, we had none, nor if we had could we have done
anything with it; so we worked at the oar towards the land, though with heavy
hearts, like men going to execution; for we all knew that when the boat came
near the shore she would be dashed in a thousand pieces by the breach of the
sea. However, we committed our souls to God in the most earnest manner; and the
wind driving us towards the shore, we hastened our destruction with our own
hands, pulling as well as we could towards land.
What the shore was, whether rock or sand, whether steep or shoal, we knew not.
The only hope that could rationally give us the least shadow of expectation
was, if we might find some bay or gulf, or the mouth of some river, where by
great chance we might have run our boat in, or got under the lee of the land,
and perhaps made smooth water. But there was nothing like this appeared; but as
we made nearer and nearer the shore, the land looked more frightful than the
sea.
After we had rowed, or rather driven about a league and a half, as we reckoned
it, a raging wave, mountain-like, came rolling astern of us, and plainly bade
us expect the . It took us with such a fury, that it
overset the boat at once; and separating us as well from the boat as from one
another, gave us no time to say, “O God!” for we were all swallowed
up in a moment.
Nothing can describe the confusion of thought which I felt when I sank into the
water; for though I swam very well, yet I could not deliver myself from the
waves so as to draw breath, till that wave having driven me, or rather carried
me, a vast way on towards the shore, and having spent itself, went back, and
left me upon the land almost dry, but half dead with the water I took in. I had
so much presence of mind, as well as breath left, that seeing myself nearer the
mainland than I expected, I got upon my feet, and endeavoured to make on
towards the land as fast as I could before another wave should return and take
me up again; but I soon found it was impossible to avoid it; for I saw the sea
come after me as high as a great hill, and as furious as an enemy, which I had
no means or strength to contend with: my business was to hold my breath, and
raise myself upon the water if I could; and so, by swimming, to preserve my
breathing, and pilot myself towards the shore, if possible, my greatest concern
now being that the sea, as it would carry me a great way towards the shore when
it came on, might not carry me back again with it when it gave back towards the
sea.
The wave that came upon me again buried me at once twenty or thirty feet deep
in its own body, and I could feel myself carried with a mighty force and
swiftness towards the shore—a very great way; but I held my breath, and
assisted myself to swim still forward with all my might. I was ready to burst
with holding my breath, when, as I felt myself rising up, so, to my immediate
relief, I found my head and hands shoot out above the surface of the water; and
though it was not two seconds of time that I could keep myself so, yet it
relieved me greatly, gave me breath, and new courage. I was covered again with
water a good while, but not so long but I held it out; and finding the water
had spent itself, and began to return, I struck forward against the return of
the waves, and felt ground again with my feet. I stood still a few moments to
recover breath, and till the waters went from me, and then took to my heels and
ran with what strength I had further towards the shore. But neither would this
deliver me from the fury of the sea, which came pouring in after me again; and
twice more I was lifted up by the waves and carried forward as before, the
shore being very flat.
The last time of these two had well-nigh been fatal to me, for the sea having
hurried me along as before, landed me, or rather dashed me, against a piece of
rock, and that with such force, that it left me senseless, and indeed helpless,
as to my own deliverance; for the blow taking my side and breast, beat the
breath as it were quite out of my body; and had it returned again immediately,
I must have been strangled in the water; but I recovered a little before the
return of the waves, and seeing I should be covered again with the water, I
resolved to hold fast by a piece of the rock, and so to hold my breath, if
possible, till the wave went back. Now, as the waves were not so high as at
first, being nearer land, I held my hold till the wave abated, and then fetched
another run, which brought me so near the shore that the next wave, though it
went over me, yet did not so swallow me up as to carry me away; and the next
run I took, I got to the mainland, where, to my great comfort, I clambered up
the cliffs of the shore and sat me down upon the grass, free from danger and
quite out of the reach of the water.
I was now landed and safe on shore, and began to look up and thank God that my
life was saved, in a case wherein there was some minutes before scarce any room
to hope. I believe it is impossible to express, to the life, what the ecstasies
and transports of the soul are, when it is so saved, as I may say, out of the
very grave: and I do not wonder now at the custom, when a malefactor, who has
the halter about his neck, is tied up, and just going to be turned off, and has
a reprieve brought to him—I say, I do not wonder that they bring a
surgeon with it, to let him blood that very moment they tell him of it, that
the surprise may not drive the animal spirits from the heart and overwhelm him.
“For sudden joys, like griefs, confound at first.”
I walked about on the shore lifting up my hands, and my whole being, as I may
say, wrapped up in a contemplation of my deliverance; making a thousand
gestures and motions, which I cannot describe; reflecting upon all my comrades
that were drowned, and that there should not be one soul saved but myself; for,
as for them, I never saw them afterwards, or any sign of them, except three of
their hats, one cap, and two shoes that were not fellows.
I cast my eye to the stranded vessel, when, the breach and froth of the sea
being so big, I could hardly see it, it lay so far of; and considered, Lord!
how was it possible I could get on shore?
After I had solaced my mind with the comfortable part of my condition, I began
to look round me, to see what kind of place I was in, and what was next to be
done; and I soon found my comforts abate, and that, in a word, I had a dreadful
deliverance; for I was wet, had no clothes to shift me, nor anything either to
eat or drink to comfort me; neither did I see any prospect before me but that
of perishing with hunger or being devoured by wild beasts; and that which was
particularly afflicting to me was, that I had no weapon, either to hunt and
kill any creature for my sustenance, or to defend myself against any other
creature that might desire to kill me for theirs. In a word, I had nothing
about me but a knife, a tobacco-pipe, and a little tobacco in a box. This was
all my provisions; and this threw me into such terrible agonies of mind, that
for a while I ran about like a madman. Night coming upon me, I began with a
heavy heart to consider what would be my lot if there were any ravenous beasts
in that country, as at night they always come abroad for their prey.
All the remedy that offered to my thoughts at that time was to get up into a
thick bushy tree like a fir, but thorny, which grew near me, and where I
resolved to sit all night, and consider the next day what death I should die,
for as yet I saw no prospect of life. I walked about a furlong from the shore,
to see if I could find any fresh water to drink, which I did, to my great joy;
and having drank, and put a little tobacco into my mouth to prevent hunger, I
went to the tree, and getting up into it, endeavoured to place myself so that
if I should sleep I might not fall. And having cut me a short stick, like a
truncheon, for my defence, I took up my lodging; and having been excessively
fatigued, I fell fast asleep, and slept as comfortably as, I believe, few could
have done in my condition, and found myself more refreshed with it than, I
think, I ever was on such an occasion.
CHAPTER IV.
FIRST WEEKS ON THE ISLAND
When I waked it was broad day, the weather clear, and the storm abated, so that
the sea did not rage and swell as before. But that which surprised me most was,
that the ship was lifted off in the night from the sand where she lay by the
swelling of the tide, and was driven up almost as far as the rock which I at
first mentioned, where I had been so bruised by the wave dashing me against it.
This being within about a mile from the shore where I was, and the ship seeming
to stand upright still, I wished myself on board, that at least I might save
some necessary things for my use.
When I came down from my apartment in the tree, I looked about me again, and
the first thing I found was the boat, which lay, as the wind and the sea had
tossed her up, upon the land, about two miles on my right hand. I walked as far
as I could upon the shore to have got to her; but found a neck or inlet of
water between me and the boat which was about half a mile broad; so I came back
for the present, being more intent upon getting at the ship, where I hoped to
find something for my present subsistence.
A little after noon I found the sea very calm, and the tide ebbed so far out
that I could come within a quarter of a mile of the ship. And here I found a
fresh renewing of my grief; for I saw evidently that if we had kept on board we
had been all safe—that is to say, we had all got safe on shore, and I had
not been so miserable as to be left entirely destitute of all comfort and
company as I now was. This forced tears to my eyes again; but as there was
little relief in that, I resolved, if possible, to get to the ship; so I pulled
off my clothes—for the weather was hot to extremity—and took the
water. But when I came to the ship my difficulty was still greater to know how
to get on board; for, as she lay aground, and high out of the water, there was
nothing within my reach to lay hold of. I swam round her twice, and the second
time I spied a small piece of rope, which I wondered I did not see at first,
hung down by the fore-chains so low, as that with great difficulty I got hold
of it, and by the help of that rope I got up into the forecastle of the ship.
Here I found that the ship was bulged, and had a great deal of water in her
hold, but that she lay so on the side of a bank of hard sand, or, rather earth,
that her stern lay lifted up upon the bank, and her head low, almost to the
water. By this means all her quarter was free, and all that was in that part
was dry; for you may be sure my first work was to search, and to see what was
spoiled and what was free. And, first, I found that all the ship’s
provisions were dry and untouched by the water, and being very well disposed to
eat, I went to the bread room and filled my pockets with biscuit, and ate it as
I went about other things, for I had no time to lose. I also found some rum in
the great cabin, of which I took a large dram, and which I had, indeed, need
enough of to spirit me for what was before me. Now I wanted nothing but a boat
to furnish myself with many things which I foresaw would be very necessary to
me.
It was in vain to sit still and wish for what was not to be had; and this
extremity roused my application. We had several spare yards, and two or three
large spars of wood, and a spare topmast or two in the ship; I resolved to fall
to work with these, and I flung as many of them overboard as I could manage for
their weight, tying every one with a rope, that they might not drive away. When
this was done I went down the ship’s side, and pulling them to me, I tied
four of them together at both ends as well as I could, in the form of a raft,
and laying two or three short pieces of plank upon them crossways, I found I
could walk upon it very well, but that it was not able to bear any great
weight, the pieces being too light. So I went to work, and with a
carpenter’s saw I cut a spare topmast into three lengths, and added them
to my raft, with a great deal of labour and pains. But the hope of furnishing
myself with necessaries encouraged me to go beyond what I should have been able
to have done upon another occasion.
My raft was now strong enough to bear any reasonable weight. My next care was
what to load it with, and how to preserve what I laid upon it from the surf of
the sea; but I was not long considering this. I first laid all the planks or
boards upon it that I could get, and having considered well what I most wanted,
I got three of the seamen’s chests, which I had broken open, and emptied,
and lowered them down upon my raft; the first of these I filled with
provisions—viz. bread, rice, three Dutch cheeses, five pieces of dried
goat’s flesh (which we lived much upon), and a little remainder of
European corn, which had been laid by for some fowls which we brought to sea
with us, but the fowls were killed. There had been some barley and wheat
together; but, to my great disappointment, I found afterwards that the rats had
eaten or spoiled it all. As for liquors, I found several, cases of bottles
belonging to our skipper, in which were some cordial waters; and, in all, about
five or six gallons of rack. These I stowed by themselves, there being no need
to put them into the chest, nor any room for them. While I was doing this, I
found the tide begin to flow, though very calm; and I had the mortification to
see my coat, shirt, and waistcoat, which I had left on the shore, upon the
sand, swim away. As for my breeches, which were only linen, and open-kneed, I
swam on board in them and my stockings. However, this set me on rummaging for
clothes, of which I found enough, but took no more than I wanted for present
use, for I had others things which my eye was more upon—as, first, tools
to work with on shore. And it was after long searching that I found out the
carpenter’s chest, which was, indeed, a very useful prize to me, and much
more valuable than a shipload of gold would have been at that time. I got it
down to my raft, whole as it was, without losing time to look into it, for I
knew in general what it contained.
My next care was for some ammunition and arms. There were two very good
fowling-pieces in the great cabin, and two pistols. These I secured first, with
some powder-horns and a small bag of shot, and two old rusty swords. I knew
there were three barrels of powder in the ship, but knew not where our gunner
had stowed them; but with much search I found them, two of them dry and good,
the third had taken water. Those two I got to my raft with the arms. And now I
thought myself pretty well freighted, and began to think how I should get to
shore with them, having neither sail, oar, nor rudder; and the least capful of
wind would have overset all my navigation.
I had three encouragements—1st, a smooth, calm sea; 2ndly, the tide
rising, and setting in to the shore; 3rdly, what little wind there was blew me
towards the land. And thus, having found two or three broken oars belonging to
the boat—and, besides the tools which were in the chest, I found two
saws, an axe, and a hammer; with this cargo I put to sea. For a mile or
thereabouts my raft went very well, only that I found it drive a little distant
from the place where I had landed before; by which I perceived that there was
some indraft of the water, and consequently I hoped to find some creek or river
there, which I might make use of as a port to get to land with my cargo.
As I imagined, so it was. There appeared before me a little opening of the
land, and I found a strong current of the tide set into it; so I guided my raft
as well as I could, to keep in the middle of the stream.
But here I had like to have suffered a second shipwreck, which, if I had, I
think verily would have broken my heart; for, knowing nothing of the coast, my
raft ran aground at one end of it upon a shoal, and not being aground at the
other end, it wanted but a little that all my cargo had slipped off towards the
end that was afloat, and to fallen into the water. I did my utmost, by setting
my back against the chests, to keep them in their places, but could not thrust
off the raft with all my strength; neither durst I stir from the posture I was
in; but holding up the chests with all my might, I stood in that manner near
half-an-hour, in which time the rising of the water brought me a little more
upon a level; and a little after, the water still-rising, my raft floated
again, and I thrust her off with the oar I had into the channel, and then
driving up higher, I at length found myself in the mouth of a little river,
with land on both sides, and a strong current of tide running up. I looked on
both sides for a proper place to get to shore, for I was not willing to be
driven too high up the river: hoping in time to see some ships at sea, and
therefore resolved to place myself as near the coast as I could.
At length I spied a little cove on the right shore of the creek, to which with
great pain and difficulty I guided my raft, and at last got so near that,
reaching ground with my oar, I could thrust her directly in. But here I had
like to have dipped all my cargo into the sea again; for that shore lying
pretty steep—that is to say sloping—there was no place to land, but
where one end of my float, if it ran on shore, would lie so high, and the other
sink lower, as before, that it would endanger my cargo again. All that I could
do was to wait till the tide was at the highest, keeping the raft with my oar
like an anchor, to hold the side of it fast to the shore, near a flat piece of
ground, which I expected the water would flow over; and so it did. As soon as I
found water enough—for my raft drew about a foot of water—I thrust
her upon that flat piece of ground, and there fastened or moored her, by
sticking my two broken oars into the ground, one on one side near one end, and
one on the other side near the other end; and thus I lay till the water ebbed
away, and left my raft and all my cargo safe on shore.
My next work was to view the country, and seek a proper place for my
habitation, and where to stow my goods to secure them from whatever might
happen. Where I was, I yet knew not; whether on the continent or on an island;
whether inhabited or not inhabited; whether in danger of wild beasts or not.
There was a hill not above a mile from me, which rose up very steep and high,
and which seemed to overtop some other hills, which lay as in a ridge from it
northward. I took out one of the fowling-pieces, and one of the pistols, and a
horn of powder; and thus armed, I travelled for discovery up to the top of that
hill, where, after I had with great labour and difficulty got to the top, I saw
my fate, to my great affliction—viz. that I was in an island environed
every way with the sea: no land to be seen except some rocks, which lay a great
way off; and two small islands, less than this, which lay about three leagues
to the west.
I found also that the island I was in was barren, and, as I saw good reason to
believe, uninhabited except by wild beasts, of whom, however, I saw none. Yet I
saw abundance of fowls, but knew not their kinds; neither when I killed them
could I tell what was fit for food, and what not. At my coming back, I shot at
a great bird which I saw sitting upon a tree on the side of a great wood. I
believe it was the first gun that had been fired there since the creation of
the world. I had no sooner fired, than from all parts of the wood there arose
an innumerable number of fowls, of many sorts, making a confused screaming and
crying, and every one according to his usual note, but not one of them of any
kind that I knew. As for the creature I killed, I took it to be a kind of hawk,
its colour and beak resembling it, but it had no talons or claws more than
common. Its flesh was carrion, and fit for nothing.
Contented with this discovery, I came back to my raft, and fell to work to
bring my cargo on shore, which took me up the rest of that day. What to do with
myself at night I knew not, nor indeed where to rest, for I was afraid to lie
down on the ground, not knowing but some wild beast might devour me, though, as
I afterwards found, there was really no need for those fears.
However, as well as I could, I barricaded myself round with the chest and
boards that I had brought on shore, and made a kind of hut for that
night’s lodging. As for food, I yet saw not which way to supply myself,
except that I had seen two or three creatures like hares run out of the wood
where I shot the fowl.
I now began to consider that I might yet get a great many things out of the
ship which would be useful to me, and particularly some of the rigging and
sails, and such other things as might come to land; and I resolved to make
another voyage on board the vessel, if possible. And as I knew that the first
storm that blew must necessarily break her all in pieces, I resolved to set all
other things apart till I had got everything out of the ship that I could get.
Then I called a council—that is to say in my thoughts—whether I
should take back the raft; but this appeared impracticable: so I resolved to go
as before, when the tide was down; and I did so, only that I stripped before I
went from my hut, having nothing on but my chequered shirt, a pair of linen
drawers, and a pair of pumps on my feet.
I got on board the ship as before, and prepared a second raft; and, having had
experience of the first, I neither made this so unwieldy, nor loaded it so
hard, but yet I brought away several things very useful to me; as first, in the
carpenters stores I found two or three bags full of nails and spikes, a great
screw-jack, a dozen or two of hatchets, and, above all, that most useful thing
called a grindstone. All these I secured, together with several things
belonging to the gunner, particularly two or three iron crows, and two barrels
of musket bullets, seven muskets, another fowling-piece, with some small
quantity of powder more; a large bagful of small shot, and a great roll of
sheet-lead; but this last was so heavy, I could not hoist it up to get it over
the ship’s side.
Besides these things, I took all the men’s clothes that I could find, and
a spare fore-topsail, a hammock, and some bedding; and with this I loaded my
second raft, and brought them all safe on shore, to my very great comfort.
I was under some apprehension, during my absence from the land, that at least
my provisions might be devoured on shore: but when I came back I found no sign
of any visitor; only there sat a creature like a wild cat upon one of the
chests, which, when I came towards it, ran away a little distance, and then
stood still. She sat very composed and unconcerned, and looked full in my face,
as if she had a mind to be acquainted with me. I presented my gun at her, but,
as she did not understand it, she was perfectly unconcerned at it, nor did she
offer to stir away; upon which I tossed her a bit of biscuit, though by the
way, I was not very free of it, for my store was not great: however, I spared
her a bit, I say, and she went to it, smelled at it, and ate it, and looked (as
if pleased) for more; but I thanked her, and could spare no more: so she
marched off.
Having got my second cargo on shore—though I was fain to open the barrels
of powder, and bring them by parcels, for they were too heavy, being large
casks—I went to work to make me a little tent with the sail and some
poles which I cut for that purpose: and into this tent I brought everything
that I knew would spoil either with rain or sun; and I piled all the empty
chests and casks up in a circle round the tent, to fortify it from any sudden
attempt, either from man or beast.
When I had done this, I blocked up the door of the tent with some boards
within, and an empty chest set up on end without; and spreading one of the beds
upon the ground, laying my two pistols just at my head, and my gun at length by
me, I went to bed for the first time, and slept very quietly all night, for I
was very weary and heavy; for the night before I had slept little, and had
laboured very hard all day to fetch all those things from the ship, and to get
them on shore.
I had the biggest magazine of all kinds now that ever was laid up, I believe,
for one man: but I was not satisfied still, for while the ship sat upright in
that posture, I thought I ought to get everything out of her that I could; so
every day at low water I went on board, and brought away something or other;
but particularly the third time I went I brought away as much of the rigging as
I could, as also all the small ropes and rope-twine I could get, with a piece
of spare canvas, which was to mend the sails upon occasion, and the barrel of
wet gunpowder. In a word, I brought away all the sails, first and last; only
that I was fain to cut them in pieces, and bring as much at a time as I could,
for they were no more useful to be sails, but as mere canvas only.
But that which comforted me more still, was, that last of all, after I had made
five or six such voyages as these, and thought I had nothing more to expect
from the ship that was worth my meddling with—I say, after all this, I
found a great hogshead of bread, three large runlets of rum, or spirits, a box
of sugar, and a barrel of fine flour; this was surprising to me, because I had
given over expecting any more provisions, except what was spoiled by the water.
I soon emptied the hogshead of the bread, and wrapped it up, parcel by parcel,
in pieces of the sails, which I cut out; and, in a word, I got all this safe on
shore also.
The next day I made another voyage, and now, having plundered the ship of what
was portable and fit to hand out, I began with the cables. Cutting the great
cable into pieces, such as I could move, I got two cables and a hawser on
shore, with all the ironwork I could get; and having cut down the
spritsail-yard, and the mizzen-yard, and everything I could, to make a large
raft, I loaded it with all these heavy goods, and came away. But my good luck
began now to leave me; for this raft was so unwieldy, and so overladen, that,
after I had entered the little cove where I had landed the rest of my goods,
not being able to guide it so handily as I did the other, it overset, and threw
me and all my cargo into the water. As for myself, it was no great harm, for I
was near the shore; but as to my cargo, it was a great part of it lost,
especially the iron, which I expected would have been of great use to me;
however, when the tide was out, I got most of the pieces of the cable ashore,
and some of the iron, though with infinite labour; for I was fain to dip for it
into the water, a work which fatigued me very much. After this, I went every
day on board, and brought away what I could get.
I had been now thirteen days on shore, and had been eleven times on board the
ship, in which time I had brought away all that one pair of hands could well be
supposed capable to bring; though I believe verily, had the calm weather held,
I should have brought away the whole ship, piece by piece. But preparing the
twelfth time to go on board, I found the wind began to rise: however, at low
water I went on board, and though I thought I had rummaged the cabin so
effectually that nothing more could be found, yet I discovered a locker with
drawers in it, in one of which I found two or three razors, and one pair of
large scissors, with some ten or a dozen of good knives and forks: in another I
found about thirty-six pounds value in money—some European coin, some
Brazil, some pieces of eight, some gold, and some silver.
I smiled to myself at the sight of this money: “O drug!” said I,
aloud, “what art thou good for? Thou art not worth to me—no, not
the taking off the ground; one of those knives is worth all this heap; I have
no manner of use for thee—e’en remain where thou art, and go to the
bottom as a creature whose life is not worth saving.” However, upon
second thoughts I took it away; and wrapping all this in a piece of canvas, I
began to think of making another raft; but while I was preparing this, I found
the sky overcast, and the wind began to rise, and in a quarter of an hour it
blew a fresh gale from the shore. It presently occurred to me that it was in
vain to pretend to make a raft with the wind offshore; and that it was my
business to be gone before the tide of flood began, otherwise I might not be
able to reach the shore at all. Accordingly, I let myself down into the water,
and swam across the channel, which lay between the ship and the sands, and even
that with difficulty enough, partly with the weight of the things I had about
me, and partly the roughness of the water; for the wind rose very hastily, and
before it was quite high water it blew a storm.
But I had got home to my little tent, where I lay, with all my wealth about me,
very secure. It blew very hard all night, and in the morning, when I looked
out, behold, no more ship was to be seen! I was a little surprised, but
recovered myself with the satisfactory reflection that I had lost no time, nor
abated any diligence, to get everything out of her that could be useful to me;
and that, indeed, there was little left in her that I was able to bring away,
if I had had more time.
I now gave over any more thoughts of the ship, or of anything out of her,
except what might drive on shore from her wreck; as, indeed, divers pieces of
her afterwards did; but those things were of small use to me.
My thoughts were now wholly employed about securing myself against either
savages, if any should appear, or wild beasts, if any were in the island; and I
had many thoughts of the method how to do this, and what kind of dwelling to
make—whether I should make me a cave in the earth, or a tent upon the
earth; and, in short, I resolved upon both; the manner and description of
which, it may not be improper to give an account of.
I soon found the place I was in was not fit for my settlement, because it was
upon a low, moorish ground, near the sea, and I believed it would not be
wholesome, and more particularly because there was no fresh water near it; so I
resolved to find a more healthy and more convenient spot of ground.
I consulted several things in my situation, which I found would be proper for
me: 1st, health and fresh water, I just now mentioned; 2ndly, shelter from the
heat of the sun; 3rdly, security from ravenous creatures, whether man or beast;
4thly, a view to the sea, that if God sent any ship in sight, I might not lose
any advantage for my deliverance, of which I was not willing to banish all my
expectation yet.
In search of a place proper for this, I found a little plain on the side of a
rising hill, whose front towards this little plain was steep as a house-side,
so that nothing could come down upon me from the top. On the one side of the
rock there was a hollow place, worn a little way in, like the entrance or door
of a cave but there was not really any cave or way into the rock at all.
On the flat of the green, just before this hollow place, I resolved to pitch my
tent. This plain was not above a hundred yards broad, and about twice as long,
and lay like a green before my door; and, at the end of it, descended
irregularly every way down into the low ground by the seaside. It was on the
N.N.W. side of the hill; so that it was sheltered from the heat every day, till
it came to a W. and by S. sun, or thereabouts, which, in those countries, is
near the setting.
Before I set up my tent I drew a half-circle before the hollow place, which
took in about ten yards in its semi-diameter from the rock, and twenty yards in
its diameter from its beginning and ending.
In this half-circle I pitched two rows of strong stakes, driving them into the
ground till they stood very firm like piles, the biggest end being out of the
ground above five feet and a half, and sharpened on the top. The two rows did
not stand above six inches from one another.
Then I took the pieces of cable which I had cut in the ship, and laid them in
rows, one upon another, within the circle, between these two rows of stakes, up
to the top, placing other stakes in the inside, leaning against them, about two
feet and a half high, like a spur to a post; and this fence was so strong, that
neither man nor beast could get into it or over it. This cost me a great deal
of time and labour, especially to cut the piles in the woods, bring them to the
place, and drive them into the earth.
The entrance into this place I made to be, not by a door, but by a short ladder
to go over the top; which ladder, when I was in, I lifted over after me; and so
I was completely fenced in and fortified, as I thought, from all the world, and
consequently slept secure in the night, which otherwise I could not have done;
though, as it appeared afterwards, there was no need of all this caution from
the enemies that I apprehended danger from.
Into this fence or fortress, with infinite labour, I carried all my riches, all
my provisions, ammunition, and stores, of which you have the account above; and
I made a large tent, which to preserve me from the rains that in one part of
the year are very violent there, I made double—one smaller tent within,
and one larger tent above it; and covered the uppermost with a large tarpaulin,
which I had saved among the sails.
And now I lay no more for a while in the bed which I had brought on shore, but
in a hammock, which was indeed a very good one, and belonged to the mate of the
ship.
Into this tent I brought all my provisions, and everything that would spoil by
the wet; and having thus enclosed all my goods, I made up the entrance, which
till now I had left open, and so passed and repassed, as I said, by a short
ladder.
When I had done this, I began to work my way into the rock, and bringing all
the earth and stones that I dug down out through my tent, I laid them up within
my fence, in the nature of a terrace, so that it raised the ground within about
a foot and a half; and thus I made me a cave, just behind my tent, which served
me like a cellar to my house.
It cost me much labour and many days before all these things were brought to
perfection; and therefore I must go back to some other things which took up
some of my thoughts. At the same time it happened, after I had laid my scheme
for the setting up my tent, and making the cave, that a storm of rain falling
from a thick, dark cloud, a sudden flash of lightning happened, and after that
a great clap of thunder, as is naturally the effect of it. I was not so much
surprised with the lightning as I was with the thought which darted into my
mind as swift as the lightning itself—Oh, my powder! My very heart sank
within me when I thought that, at one blast, all my powder might be destroyed;
on which, not my defence only, but the providing my food, as I thought,
entirely depended. I was nothing near so anxious about my own danger, though,
had the powder took fire, I should never have known who had hurt me.
Such impression did this make upon me, that after the storm was over I laid
aside all my works, my building and fortifying, and applied myself to make bags
and boxes, to separate the powder, and to keep it a little and a little in a
parcel, in the hope that, whatever might come, it might not all take fire at
once; and to keep it so apart that it should not be possible to make one part
fire another. I finished this work in about a fortnight; and I think my powder,
which in all was about two hundred and forty pounds weight, was divided in not
less than a hundred parcels. As to the barrel that had been wet, I did not
apprehend any danger from that; so I placed it in my new cave, which, in my
fancy, I called my kitchen; and the rest I hid up and down in holes among the
rocks, so that no wet might come to it, marking very carefully where I laid it.
In the interval of time while this was doing, I went out once at least every
day with my gun, as well to divert myself as to see if I could kill anything
fit for food; and, as near as I could, to acquaint myself with what the island
produced. The first time I went out, I presently discovered that there were
goats in the island, which was a great satisfaction to me; but then it was
attended with this misfortune to me—viz. that they were so shy, so
subtle, and so swift of foot, that it was the most difficult thing in the world
to come at them; but I was not discouraged at this, not doubting but I might
now and then shoot one, as it soon happened; for after I had found their haunts
a little, I laid wait in this manner for them: I observed if they saw me in the
valleys, though they were upon the rocks, they would run away, as in a terrible
fright; but if they were feeding in the valleys, and I was upon the rocks, they
took no notice of me; from whence I concluded that, by the position of their
optics, their sight was so directed downward that they did not readily see
objects that were above them; so afterwards I took this method—I always
climbed the rocks first, to get above them, and then had frequently a fair
mark.
The first shot I made among these creatures, I killed a she-goat, which had a
little kid by her, which she gave suck to, which grieved me heartily; for when
the old one fell, the kid stood stock still by her, till I came and took her
up; and not only so, but when I carried the old one with me, upon my shoulders,
the kid followed me quite to my enclosure; upon which I laid down the dam, and
took the kid in my arms, and carried it over my pale, in hopes to have bred it
up tame; but it would not eat; so I was forced to kill it and eat it myself.
These two supplied me with flesh a great while, for I ate sparingly, and saved
my provisions, my bread especially, as much as possibly I could.
Having now fixed my habitation, I found it absolutely necessary to provide a
place to make a fire in, and fuel to burn: and what I did for that, and also
how I enlarged my cave, and what conveniences I made, I shall give a full
account of in its place; but I must now give some little account of myself, and
of my thoughts about living, which, it may well be supposed, were not a few.
I had a dismal prospect of my condition; for as I was not cast away upon that
island without being driven, as is said, by a violent storm, quite out of the
course of our intended voyage, and a great way, viz. some hundreds of leagues,
out of the ordinary course of the trade of mankind, I had great reason to
consider it as a determination of Heaven, that in this desolate place, and in
this desolate manner, I should end my life. The tears would run plentifully
down my face when I made these reflections; and sometimes I would expostulate
with myself why Providence should thus completely ruin His creatures, and
render them so absolutely miserable; so without help, abandoned, so entirely
depressed, that it could hardly be rational to be thankful for such a life.
But something always returned swift upon me to check these thoughts, and to
reprove me; and particularly one day, walking with my gun in my hand by the
seaside, I was very pensive upon the subject of my present condition, when
reason, as it were, expostulated with me the other way, thus: “Well, you
are in a desolate condition, it is true; but, pray remember, where are the rest
of you? Did not you come, eleven of you in the boat? Where are the ten? Why
were they not saved, and you lost? Why were you singled out? Is it better to be
here or there?” And then I pointed to the sea. All evils are to be
considered with the good that is in them, and with what worse attends them.
Then it occurred to me again, how well I was furnished for my subsistence, and
what would have been my case if it had not happened (which was a hundred
thousand to one) that the ship floated from the place where she first struck,
and was driven so near to the shore that I had time to get all these things out
of her; what would have been my case, if I had been forced to have lived in the
condition in which I at first came on shore, without necessaries of life, or
necessaries to supply and procure them? “Particularly,” said I,
aloud (though to myself), “what should I have done without a gun, without
ammunition, without any tools to make anything, or to work with, without
clothes, bedding, a tent, or any manner of covering?” and that now I had
all these to sufficient quantity, and was in a fair way to provide myself in
such a manner as to live without my gun, when my ammunition was spent: so that
I had a tolerable view of subsisting, without any want, as long as I lived; for
I considered from the beginning how I would provide for the accidents that
might happen, and for the time that was to come, even not only after my
ammunition should be spent, but even after my health and strength should decay.
I confess I had not entertained any notion of my ammunition being destroyed at
one blast—I mean my powder being blown up by lightning; and this made the
thoughts of it so surprising to me, when it lightened and thundered, as I
observed just now.
And now being about to enter into a melancholy relation of a scene of silent
life, such, perhaps, as was never heard of in the world before, I shall take it
from its beginning, and continue it in its order. It was by my account the 30th
of September, when, in the manner as above said, I first set foot upon this
horrid island; when the sun, being to us in its autumnal equinox, was almost
over my head; for I reckoned myself, by observation, to be in the latitude of
nine degrees twenty-two minutes north of the line.
After I had been there about ten or twelve days, it came into my thoughts that
I should lose my reckoning of time for want of books, and pen and ink, and
should even forget the Sabbath days; but to prevent this, I cut with my knife
upon a large post, in capital letters—and making it into a great cross, I
set it up on the shore where I first landed—“I came on shore here
on the 30th September 1659.”
Upon the sides of this square post I cut every day a notch with my knife, and
every seventh notch was as long again as the rest, and every first day of the
month as long again as that long one; and thus I kept my calendar, or weekly,
monthly, and yearly reckoning of time.
In the next place, we are to observe that among the many things which I brought
out of the ship, in the several voyages which, as above mentioned, I made to
it, I got several things of less value, but not at all less useful to me, which
I omitted setting down before; as, in particular, pens, ink, and paper, several
parcels in the captain’s, mate’s, gunner’s and
carpenter’s keeping; three or four compasses, some mathematical
instruments, dials, perspectives, charts, and books of navigation, all which I
huddled together, whether I might want them or no; also, I found three very
good Bibles, which came to me in my cargo from England, and which I had packed
up among my things; some Portuguese books also; and among them two or three
Popish prayer-books, and several other books, all which I carefully secured.
And I must not forget that we had in the ship a dog and two cats, of whose
eminent history I may have occasion to say something in its place; for I
carried both the cats with me; and as for the dog, he jumped out of the ship of
himself, and swam on shore to me the day after I went on shore with my first
cargo, and was a trusty servant to me many years; I wanted nothing that he
could fetch me, nor any company that he could make up to me; I only wanted to
have him talk to me, but that would not do. As I observed before, I found pens,
ink, and paper, and I husbanded them to the utmost; and I shall show that while
my ink lasted, I kept things very exact, but after that was gone I could not,
for I could not make any ink by any means that I could devise.
And this put me in mind that I wanted many things notwithstanding all that I
had amassed together; and of these, ink was one; as also a spade, pickaxe, and
shovel, to dig or remove the earth; needles, pins, and thread; as for linen, I
soon learned to want that without much difficulty.
This want of tools made every work I did go on heavily; and it was near a whole
year before I had entirely finished my little pale, or surrounded my
habitation. The piles, or stakes, which were as heavy as I could well lift,
were a long time in cutting and preparing in the woods, and more, by far, in
bringing home; so that I spent sometimes two days in cutting and bringing home
one of those posts, and a third day in driving it into the ground; for which
purpose I got a heavy piece of wood at first, but at last bethought myself of
one of the iron crows; which, however, though I found it, made driving those
posts or piles very laborious and tedious work.
But what need I have been concerned at the tediousness of anything I had to do,
seeing I had time enough to do it in? nor had I any other employment, if that
had been over, at least that I could foresee, except the ranging the island to
seek for food, which I did, more or less, every day.
I now began to consider seriously my condition, and the circumstances I was
reduced to; and I drew up the state of my affairs in writing, not so much to
leave them to any that were to come after me—for I was likely to have but
few heirs—as to deliver my thoughts from daily poring over them, and
afflicting my mind; and as my reason began now to master my despondency, I
began to comfort myself as well as I could, and to set the good against the
evil, that I might have something to distinguish my case from worse; and I
stated very impartially, like debtor and creditor, the comforts I enjoyed
against the miseries I suffered, thus:—
|
.
|
.
| | —- | —- | |
I am cast upon a horrible, desolate island, void of all hope of recovery.
|
But I am alive; and not drowned, as all my ship’s company were.
| |
I am singled out and separated, as it were, from all the world, to be miserable.
|
But I am singled out, too, from all the ship’s crew, to be spared from death; and He that miraculously saved me from death can deliver me from this condition.
| |
I am divided from mankind—a solitaire; one banished from human society.
|
But I am not starved, and perishing on a barren place, affording no sustenance.
| |
I have no clothes to cover me.
|
But I am in a hot climate, where, if I had clothes, I could hardly wear them.
| |
I am without any defence, or means to resist any violence of man or beast.
|
But I am cast on an island where I see no wild beasts to hurt me, as I saw on the coast of Africa; and what if I had been shipwrecked there?
| |
I have no soul to speak to or relieve me.
|
But God wonderfully sent the ship in near enough to the shore, that I have got out as many necessary things as will either supply my wants or enable me to supply myself, even as long as I live.
|
Upon the whole, here was an undoubted testimony that there was scarce any
condition in the world so miserable but there was something negative or
something positive to be thankful for in it; and let this stand as a direction
from the experience of the most miserable of all conditions in this world: that
we may always find in it something to comfort ourselves from, and to set, in
the description of good and evil, on the credit side of the account.
Having now brought my mind a little to relish my condition, and given over
looking out to sea, to see if I could spy a ship—I say, giving over these
things, I began to apply myself to arrange my way of living, and to make things
as easy to me as I could.
I have already described my habitation, which was a tent under the side of a
rock, surrounded with a strong pale of posts and cables: but I might now rather
call it a wall, for I raised a kind of wall up against it of turfs, about two
feet thick on the outside; and after some time (I think it was a year and a
half) I raised rafters from it, leaning to the rock, and thatched or covered it
with boughs of trees, and such things as I could get, to keep out the rain;
which I found at some times of the year very violent.
I have already observed how I brought all my goods into this pale, and into the
cave which I had made behind me. But I must observe, too, that at first this
was a confused heap of goods, which, as they lay in no order, so they took up
all my place; I had no room to turn myself: so I set myself to enlarge my cave,
and work farther into the earth; for it was a loose sandy rock, which yielded
easily to the labour I bestowed on it: and so when I found I was pretty safe as
to beasts of prey, I worked sideways, to the right hand, into the rock; and
then, turning to the right again, worked quite out, and made me a door to come
out on the outside of my pale or fortification. This gave me not only egress
and regress, as it was a back way to my tent and to my storehouse, but gave me
room to store my goods.
And now I began to apply myself to make such necessary things as I found I most
wanted, particularly a chair and a table; for without these I was not able to
enjoy the few comforts I had in the world; I could not write or eat, or do
several things, with so much pleasure without a table: so I went to work. And
here I must needs observe, that as reason is the substance and origin of the
mathematics, so by stating and squaring everything by reason, and by making the
most rational judgment of things, every man may be, in time, master of every
mechanic art. I had never handled a tool in my life; and yet, in time, by
labour, application, and contrivance, I found at last that I wanted nothing but
I could have made it, especially if I had had tools. However, I made abundance
of things, even without tools; and some with no more tools than an adze and a
hatchet, which perhaps were never made that way before, and that with infinite
labour. For example, if I wanted a board, I had no other way but to cut down a
tree, set it on an edge before me, and hew it flat on either side with my axe,
till I brought it to be thin as a plank, and then dub it smooth with my adze.
It is true, by this method I could make but one board out of a whole tree; but
this I had no remedy for but patience, any more than I had for the prodigious
deal of time and labour which it took me up to make a plank or board: but my
time or labour was little worth, and so it was as well employed one way as
another.
However, I made me a table and a chair, as I observed above, in the first
place; and this I did out of the short pieces of boards that I brought on my
raft from the ship. But when I had wrought out some boards as above, I made
large shelves, of the breadth of a foot and a half, one over another all along
one side of my cave, to lay all my tools, nails and ironwork on; and, in a
word, to separate everything at large into their places, that I might come
easily at them. I knocked pieces into the wall of the rock to hang my guns and
all things that would hang up; so that, had my cave been to be seen, it looked
like a general magazine of all necessary things; and had everything so ready at
my hand, that it was a great pleasure to me to see all my goods in such order,
and especially to find my stock of all necessaries so great.
And now it was that I began to keep a journal of every day’s employment;
for, indeed, at first I was in too much hurry, and not only hurry as to labour,
but in too much discomposure of mind; and my journal would have been full of
many dull things; for example, I must have said thus:
“30.—After I had got to shore, and escaped drowning,
instead of being thankful to God for my deliverance, having first vomited, with
the great quantity of salt water which had got into my stomach, and recovering
myself a little, I ran about the shore wringing my hands and beating my head
and face, exclaiming at my misery, and crying out, ‘I was undone,
undone!’ till, tired and faint, I was forced to lie down on the ground to
repose, but durst not sleep for fear of being devoured.”
Some days after this, and after I had been on board the ship, and got all that
I could out of her, yet I could not forbear getting up to the top of a little
mountain and looking out to sea, in hopes of seeing a ship; then fancy at a
vast distance I spied a sail, please myself with the hopes of it, and then
after looking steadily, till I was almost blind, lose it quite, and sit down
and weep like a child, and thus increase my misery by my folly.
But having gotten over these things in some measure, and having settled my
household staff and habitation, made me a table and a chair, and all as
handsome about me as I could, I began to keep my journal; of which I shall here
give you the copy (though in it will be told all these particulars over again)
as long as it lasted; for having no more ink, I was forced to leave it off.
CHAPTER V.
BUILDS A HOUSE—THE JOURNAL
September 30, 1659.—I, poor miserable Robinson Crusoe, being shipwrecked
during a dreadful storm in the offing, came on shore on this dismal,
unfortunate island, which I called “The Island of Despair”; all the
rest of the ship’s company being drowned, and myself almost dead.
All the rest of the day I spent in afflicting myself at the dismal
circumstances I was brought to—viz. I had neither food, house, clothes,
weapon, nor place to fly to; and in despair of any relief, saw nothing but
death before me—either that I should be devoured by wild beasts, murdered
by savages, or starved to death for want of food. At the approach of night I
slept in a tree, for fear of wild creatures; but slept soundly, though it
rained all night.
1.—In the morning I saw, to my great surprise, the ship
had floated with the high tide, and was driven on shore again much nearer the
island; which, as it was some comfort, on one hand—for, seeing her set
upright, and not broken to pieces, I hoped, if the wind abated, I might get on
board, and get some food and necessaries out of her for my relief—so, on
the other hand, it renewed my grief at the loss of my comrades, who, I
imagined, if we had all stayed on board, might have saved the ship, or, at
least, that they would not have been all drowned as they were; and that, had
the men been saved, we might perhaps have built us a boat out of the ruins of
the ship to have carried us to some other part of the world. I spent great part
of this day in perplexing myself on these things; but at length, seeing the
ship almost dry, I went upon the sand as near as I could, and then swam on
board. This day also it continued raining, though with no wind at all.
.—All these days entirely spent
in many several voyages to get all I could out of the ship, which I brought on
shore every tide of flood upon rafts. Much rain also in the days, though with
some intervals of fair weather; but it seems this was the rainy season.
20.—I overset my raft, and all the goods I had got upon it;
but, being in shoal water, and the things being chiefly heavy, I recovered many
of them when the tide was out.
25.—It rained all night and all day, with some gusts of wind;
during which time the ship broke in pieces, the wind blowing a little harder
than before, and was no more to be seen, except the wreck of her, and that only
at low water. I spent this day in covering and securing the goods which I had
saved, that the rain might not spoil them.
26.—I walked about the shore almost all day, to find out a
place to fix my habitation, greatly concerned to secure myself from any attack
in the night, either from wild beasts or men. Towards night, I fixed upon a
proper place, under a rock, and marked out a semicircle for my encampment;
which I resolved to strengthen with a work, wall, or fortification, made of
double piles, lined within with cables, and without with turf.
From the 26th to the 30th I worked very hard in carrying all my goods to my new
habitation, though some part of the time it rained exceedingly hard.
The 31st, in the morning, I went out into the island with my gun, to seek for
some food, and discover the country; when I killed a she-goat, and her kid
followed me home, which I afterwards killed also, because it would not feed.
1.—I set up my tent under a rock, and lay there for the
first night; making it as large as I could, with stakes driven in to swing my
hammock upon.
2.—I set up all my chests and boards, and the pieces of
timber which made my rafts, and with them formed a fence round me, a little
within the place I had marked out for my fortification.
3.—I went out with my gun, and killed two fowls like ducks,
which were very good food. In the afternoon went to work to make me a table.
. 4.—This morning I began to order my times of work, of going
out with my gun, time of sleep, and time of diversion—viz. every morning
I walked out with my gun for two or three hours, if it did not rain; then
employed myself to work till about eleven o’clock; then eat what I had to
live on; and from twelve to two I lay down to sleep, the weather being
excessively hot; and then, in the evening, to work again. The working part of
this day and of the next were wholly employed in making my table, for I was yet
but a very sorry workman, though time and necessity made me a complete natural
mechanic soon after, as I believe they would do any one else.
5.—This day went abroad with my gun and my dog, and killed a
wild cat; her skin pretty soft, but her flesh good for nothing; every creature
that I killed I took of the skins and preserved them. Coming back by the
sea-shore, I saw many sorts of sea-fowls, which I did not understand; but was
surprised, and almost frightened, with two or three seals, which, while I was
gazing at, not well knowing what they were, got into the sea, and escaped me
for that time.
6.—After my morning walk I went to work with my table again,
and finished it, though not to my liking; nor was it long before I learned to
mend it.
7.—Now it began to be settled fair weather. The 7th, 8th,
9th, 10th, and part of the 12th (for the 11th was Sunday) I took wholly up to
make me a chair, and with much ado brought it to a tolerable shape, but never
to please me; and even in the making I pulled it in pieces several times.
.—I soon neglected my keeping Sundays; for, omitting my mark
for them on my post, I forgot which was which.
13.—This day it rained, which refreshed me exceedingly, and
cooled the earth; but it was accompanied with terrible thunder and lightning,
which frightened me dreadfully, for fear of my powder. As soon as it was over,
I resolved to separate my stock of powder into as many little parcels as
possible, that it might not be in danger.
14, 15, 16.—These three days I spent in making little square
chests, or boxes, which might hold about a pound, or two pounds at most, of
powder; and so, putting the powder in, I stowed it in places as secure and
remote from one another as possible. On one of these three days I killed a
large bird that was good to eat, but I knew not what to call it.
17.—This day I began to dig behind my tent into the rock, to
make room for my further conveniency.
.—Three things I wanted exceedingly for this work—viz. a
pickaxe, a shovel, and a wheelbarrow or basket; so I desisted from my work, and
began to consider how to supply that want, and make me some tools. As for the
pickaxe, I made use of the iron crows, which were proper enough, though heavy;
but the next thing was a shovel or spade; this was so absolutely necessary,
that, indeed, I could do nothing effectually without it; but what kind of one
to make I knew not.
18.—The next day, in searching the woods, I found a tree of
that wood, or like it, which in the Brazils they call the iron-tree, for its
exceeding hardness. Of this, with great labour, and almost spoiling my axe, I
cut a piece, and brought it home, too, with difficulty enough, for it was
exceeding heavy. The excessive hardness of the wood, and my having no other
way, made me a long while upon this machine, for I worked it effectually by
little and little into the form of a shovel or spade; the handle exactly shaped
like ours in England, only that the board part having no iron shod upon it at
bottom, it would not last me so long; however, it served well enough for the
uses which I had occasion to put it to; but never was a shovel, I believe, made
after that fashion, or so long in making.
I was still deficient, for I wanted a basket or a wheelbarrow. A basket I could
not make by any means, having no such things as twigs that would bend to make
wicker-ware—at least, none yet found out; and as to a wheelbarrow, I
fancied I could make all but the wheel; but that I had no notion of; neither
did I know how to go about it; besides, I had no possible way to make the iron
gudgeons for the spindle or axis of the wheel to run in; so I gave it over, and
so, for carrying away the earth which I dug out of the cave, I made me a thing
like a hod which the labourers carry mortar in when they serve the bricklayers.
This was not so difficult to me as the making the shovel: and yet this and the
shovel, and the attempt which I made in vain to make a wheelbarrow, took me up
no less than four days—I mean always excepting my morning walk with my
gun, which I seldom failed, and very seldom failed also bringing home something
fit to eat.
23.—My other work having now stood still, because of my
making these tools, when they were finished I went on, and working every day,
as my strength and time allowed, I spent eighteen days entirely in widening and
deepening my cave, that it might hold my goods commodiously.
.—During all this time I worked to make this room or cave
spacious enough to accommodate me as a warehouse or magazine, a kitchen, a
dining-room, and a cellar. As for my lodging, I kept to the tent; except that
sometimes, in the wet season of the year, it rained so hard that I could not
keep myself dry, which caused me afterwards to cover all my place within my
pale with long poles, in the form of rafters, leaning against the rock, and
load them with flags and large leaves of trees, like a thatch.
10.—I began now to think my cave or vault finished, when
on a sudden (it seems I had made it too large) a great quantity of earth fell
down from the top on one side; so much that, in short, it frighted me, and not
without reason, too, for if I had been under it, I had never wanted a
gravedigger. I had now a great deal of work to do over again, for I had the
loose earth to carry out; and, which was of more importance, I had the ceiling
to prop up, so that I might be sure no more would come down.
. 11.—This day I went to work with it accordingly, and got two
shores or posts pitched upright to the top, with two pieces of boards across
over each post; this I finished the next day; and setting more posts up with
boards, in about a week more I had the roof secured, and the posts, standing in
rows, served me for partitions to part off the house.
17.—From this day to the 20th I placed shelves, and knocked
up nails on the posts, to hang everything up that could be hung up; and now I
began to be in some order within doors.
20.—Now I carried everything into the cave, and began to
furnish my house, and set up some pieces of boards like a dresser, to order my
victuals upon; but boards began to be very scarce with me; also, I made me
another table.
24.—Much rain all night and all day. No stirring out.
25.—Rain all day.
26.—No rain, and the earth much cooler than before, and
pleasanter.
27.—Killed a young goat, and lamed another, so that I caught
it and led it home in a string; when I had it at home, I bound and splintered
up its leg, which was broke.
—I took such care of it that it lived, and the leg grew well
and as strong as ever; but, by my nursing it so long, it grew tame, and fed
upon the little green at my door, and would not go away. This was the first
time that I entertained a thought of breeding up some tame creatures, that I
might have food when my powder and shot was all spent.
28, 29, 30.—Great heats and no breeze, so that there was no
stirring abroad except in the evening for food; this time I spent in putting
all my things in order within doors.
1.—Very hot still: but I went abroad early and late with
my gun, and lay still in the middle of the day. This evening, going farther
into the valleys which lay towards the centre of the island, I found there were
plenty of goats, though exceedingly shy, and hard to come at; however, I
resolved to try if I could not bring my dog to hunt them down.
2.—Accordingly, the next day I went out with my dog, and set
him upon the goats, but I was mistaken, for they all faced about upon the dog,
and he knew his danger too well, for he would not come near them.
3.—I began my fence or wall; which, being still jealous of my
being attacked by somebody, I resolved to make very thick and strong.
—This wall being described before, I purposely omit what was
said in the journal; it is sufficient to observe, that I was no less time than
from the 2nd of January to the 14th of April working, finishing, and perfecting
this wall, though it was no more than about twenty-four yards in length, being
a half-circle from one place in the rock to another place, about eight yards
from it, the door of the cave being in the centre behind it.
All this time I worked very hard, the rains hindering me many days, nay,
sometimes weeks together; but I thought I should never be perfectly secure till
this wall was finished; and it is scarce credible what inexpressible labour
everything was done with, especially the bringing piles out of the woods and
driving them into the ground; for I made them much bigger than I needed to have
done.
When this wall was finished, and the outside double fenced, with a turf wall
raised up close to it, I perceived myself that if any people were to come on
shore there, they would not perceive anything like a habitation; and it was
very well I did so, as may be observed hereafter, upon a very remarkable
occasion.
During this time I made my rounds in the woods for game every day when the rain
permitted me, and made frequent discoveries in these walks of something or
other to my advantage; particularly, I found a kind of wild pigeons, which
build, not as wood-pigeons in a tree, but rather as house-pigeons, in the holes
of the rocks; and taking some young ones, I endeavoured to breed them up tame,
and did so; but when they grew older they flew away, which perhaps was at first
for want of feeding them, for I had nothing to give them; however, I frequently
found their nests, and got their young ones, which were very good meat. And
now, in the managing my household affairs, I found myself wanting in many
things, which I thought at first it was impossible for me to make; as, indeed,
with some of them it was: for instance, I could never make a cask to be hooped.
I had a small runlet or two, as I observed before; but I could never arrive at
the capacity of making one by them, though I spent many weeks about it; I could
neither put in the heads, or join the staves so true to one another as to make
them hold water; so I gave that also over. In the next place, I was at a great
loss for candles; so that as soon as ever it was dark, which was generally by
seven o’clock, I was obliged to go to bed. I remembered the lump of
beeswax with which I made candles in my African adventure; but I had none of
that now; the only remedy I had was, that when I had killed a goat I saved the
tallow, and with a little dish made of clay, which I baked in the sun, to which
I added a wick of some oakum, I made me a lamp; and this gave me light, though
not a clear, steady light, like a candle. In the middle of all my labours it
happened that, rummaging my things, I found a little bag which, as I hinted
before, had been filled with corn for the feeding of poultry—not for this
voyage, but before, as I suppose, when the ship came from Lisbon. The little
remainder of corn that had been in the bag was all devoured by the rats, and I
saw nothing in the bag but husks and dust; and being willing to have the bag
for some other use (I think it was to put powder in, when I divided it for fear
of the lightning, or some such use), I shook the husks of corn out of it on one
side of my fortification, under the rock.
It was a little before the great rains just now mentioned that I threw this
stuff away, taking no notice, and not so much as remembering that I had thrown
anything there, when, about a month after, or thereabouts, I saw some few
stalks of something green shooting out of the ground, which I fancied might be
some plant I had not seen; but I was surprised, and perfectly astonished, when,
after a little longer time, I saw about ten or twelve ears come out, which were
perfect green barley, of the same kind as our European—nay, as our
English barley.
It is impossible to express the astonishment and confusion of my thoughts on
this occasion. I had hitherto acted upon no religious foundation at all;
indeed, I had very few notions of religion in my head, nor had entertained any
sense of anything that had befallen me otherwise than as chance, or, as we
lightly say, what pleases God, without so much as inquiring into the end of
Providence in these things, or His order in governing events for the world. But
after I saw barley grow there, in a climate which I knew was not proper for
corn, and especially that I knew not how it came there, it startled me
strangely, and I began to suggest that God had miraculously caused His grain to
grow without any help of seed sown, and that it was so directed purely for my
sustenance on that wild, miserable place.
This touched my heart a little, and brought tears out of my eyes, and I began
to bless myself that such a prodigy of nature should happen upon my account;
and this was the more strange to me, because I saw near it still, all along by
the side of the rock, some other straggling stalks, which proved to be stalks
of rice, and which I knew, because I had seen it grow in Africa when I was
ashore there.
I not only thought these the pure productions of Providence for my support, but
not doubting that there was more in the place, I went all over that part of the
island, where I had been before, peering in every corner, and under every rock,
to see for more of it, but I could not find any. At last it occurred to my
thoughts that I shook a bag of chickens’ meat out in that place; and then
the wonder began to cease; and I must confess my religious thankfulness to
God’s providence began to abate, too, upon the discovering that all this
was nothing but what was common; though I ought to have been as thankful for so
strange and unforeseen a providence as if it had been miraculous; for it was
really the work of Providence to me, that should order or appoint that ten or
twelve grains of corn should remain unspoiled, when the rats had destroyed all
the rest, as if it had been dropped from heaven; as also, that I should throw
it out in that particular place, where, it being in the shade of a high rock,
it sprang up immediately; whereas, if I had thrown it anywhere else at that
time, it had been burnt up and destroyed.
I carefully saved the ears of this corn, you may be sure, in their season,
which was about the end of June; and, laying up every corn, I resolved to sow
them all again, hoping in time to have some quantity sufficient to supply me
with bread. But it was not till the fourth year that I could allow myself the
least grain of this corn to eat, and even then but sparingly, as I shall say
afterwards, in its order; for I lost all that I sowed the first season by not
observing the proper time; for I sowed it just before the dry season, so that
it never came up at all, at least not as it would have done; of which in its
place.
Besides this barley, there were, as above, twenty or thirty stalks of rice,
which I preserved with the same care and for the same use, or to the same
purpose—to make me bread, or rather food; for I found ways to cook it
without baking, though I did that also after some time.
But to return to my Journal.
I worked excessive hard these three or four months to get my wall done; and the
14th of April I closed it up, contriving to go into it, not by a door but over
the wall, by a ladder, that there might be no sign on the outside of my
habitation.
16.—I finished the ladder; so I went up the ladder to the
top, and then pulled it up after me, and let it down in the inside. This was a
complete enclosure to me; for within I had room enough, and nothing could come
at me from without, unless it could first mount my wall.
The very next day after this wall was finished I had almost had all my labour
overthrown at once, and myself killed. The case was thus: As I was busy in the
inside, behind my tent, just at the entrance into my cave, I was terribly
frighted with a most dreadful, surprising thing indeed; for all on a sudden I
found the earth come crumbling down from the roof of my cave, and from the edge
of the hill over my head, and two of the posts I had set up in the cave cracked
in a frightful manner. I was heartily scared; but thought nothing of what was
really the cause, only thinking that the top of my cave was fallen in, as some
of it had done before: and for fear I should be buried in it I ran forward to
my ladder, and not thinking myself safe there neither, I got over my wall for
fear of the pieces of the hill, which I expected might roll down upon me. I had
no sooner stepped down upon the firm ground, than I plainly saw it was a
terrible earthquake, for the ground I stood on shook three times at about eight
minutes’ distance, with three such shocks as would have overturned the
strongest building that could be supposed to have stood on the earth; and a
great piece of the top of a rock which stood about half a mile from me next the
sea fell down with such a terrible noise as I never heard in all my life. I
perceived also the very sea was put into violent motion by it; and I believe
the shocks were stronger under the water than on the island.
I was so much amazed with the thing itself, having never felt the like, nor
discoursed with any one that had, that I was like one dead or stupefied; and
the motion of the earth made my stomach sick, like one that was tossed at sea;
but the noise of the falling of the rock awakened me, as it were, and rousing
me from the stupefied condition I was in, filled me with horror; and I thought
of nothing then but the hill falling upon my tent and all my household goods,
and burying all at once; and this sunk my very soul within me a second time.
After the third shock was over, and I felt no more for some time, I began to
take courage; and yet I had not heart enough to go over my wall again, for fear
of being buried alive, but sat still upon the ground greatly cast down and
disconsolate, not knowing what to do. All this while I had not the least
serious religious thought; nothing but the common “Lord have mercy upon
me!” and when it was over that went away too.
While I sat thus, I found the air overcast and grow cloudy, as if it would
rain. Soon after that the wind arose by little and little, so that in less than
half-an-hour it blew a most dreadful hurricane; the sea was all on a sudden
covered over with foam and froth; the shore was covered with the breach of the
water, the trees were torn up by the roots, and a terrible storm it was. This
held about three hours, and then began to abate; and in two hours more it was
quite calm, and began to rain very hard. All this while I sat upon the ground
very much terrified and dejected; when on a sudden it came into my thoughts,
that these winds and rain being the consequences of the earthquake, the
earthquake itself was spent and over, and I might venture into my cave again.
With this thought my spirits began to revive; and the rain also helping to
persuade me, I went in and sat down in my tent. But the rain was so violent
that my tent was ready to be beaten down with it; and I was forced to go into
my cave, though very much afraid and uneasy, for fear it should fall on my
head. This violent rain forced me to a new work—viz. to cut a hole
through my new fortification, like a sink, to let the water go out, which would
else have flooded my cave. After I had been in my cave for some time, and found
still no more shocks of the earthquake follow, I began to be more composed. And
now, to support my spirits, which indeed wanted it very much, I went to my
little store, and took a small sup of rum; which, however, I did then and
always very sparingly, knowing I could have no more when that was gone. It
continued raining all that night and great part of the next day, so that I
could not stir abroad; but my mind being more composed, I began to think of
what I had best do; concluding that if the island was subject to these
earthquakes, there would be no living for me in a cave, but I must consider of
building a little hut in an open place which I might surround with a wall, as I
had done here, and so make myself secure from wild beasts or men; for I
concluded, if I stayed where I was, I should certainly one time or other be
buried alive.
With these thoughts, I resolved to remove my tent from the place where it
stood, which was just under the hanging precipice of the hill; and which, if it
should be shaken again, would certainly fall upon my tent; and I spent the two
next days, being the 19th and 20th of April, in contriving where and how to
remove my habitation. The fear of being swallowed up alive made me that I never
slept in quiet; and yet the apprehension of lying abroad without any fence was
almost equal to it; but still, when I looked about, and saw how everything was
put in order, how pleasantly concealed I was, and how safe from danger, it made
me very loath to remove. In the meantime, it occurred to me that it would
require a vast deal of time for me to do this, and that I must be contented to
venture where I was, till I had formed a camp for myself, and had secured it so
as to remove to it. So with this resolution I composed myself for a time, and
resolved that I would go to work with all speed to build me a wall with piles
and cables, &c., in a circle, as before, and set my tent up in it when it
was finished; but that I would venture to stay where I was till it was
finished, and fit to remove. This was the 21st.
22.—The next morning I begin to consider of means to put
this resolve into execution; but I was at a great loss about my tools. I had
three large axes, and abundance of hatchets (for we carried the hatchets for
traffic with the Indians); but with much chopping and cutting knotty hard wood,
they were all full of notches, and dull; and though I had a grindstone, I could
not turn it and grind my tools too. This cost me as much thought as a statesman
would have bestowed upon a grand point of politics, or a judge upon the life
and death of a man. At length I contrived a wheel with a string, to turn it
with my foot, that I might have both my hands at liberty. .—I
had never seen any such thing in England, or at least, not to take notice how
it was done, though since I have observed, it is very common there; besides
that, my grindstone was very large and heavy. This machine cost me a full
week’s work to bring it to perfection.
28, 29.—These two whole days I took up in grinding my tools,
my machine for turning my grindstone performing very well.
30.—Having perceived my bread had been low a great while,
now I took a survey of it, and reduced myself to one biscuit cake a day, which
made my heart very heavy.
1.—In the morning, looking towards the sea side, the tide
being low, I saw something lie on the shore bigger than ordinary, and it looked
like a cask; when I came to it, I found a small barrel, and two or three pieces
of the wreck of the ship, which were driven on shore by the late hurricane; and
looking towards the wreck itself, I thought it seemed to lie higher out of the
water than it used to do. I examined the barrel which was driven on shore, and
soon found it was a barrel of gunpowder; but it had taken water, and the powder
was caked as hard as a stone; however, I rolled it farther on shore for the
present, and went on upon the sands, as near as I could to the wreck of the
ship, to look for more.
CHAPTER VI.
ILL AND CONSCIENCE-STRICKEN
When I came down to the ship I found it strangely removed. The forecastle,
which lay before buried in sand, was heaved up at least six feet, and the
stern, which was broke in pieces and parted from the rest by the force of the
sea, soon after I had left rummaging her, was tossed as it were up, and cast on
one side; and the sand was thrown so high on that side next her stern, that
whereas there was a great place of water before, so that I could not come
within a quarter of a mile of the wreck without swimming I could now walk quite
up to her when the tide was out. I was surprised with this at first, but soon
concluded it must be done by the earthquake; and as by this violence the ship
was more broke open than formerly, so many things came daily on shore, which
the sea had loosened, and which the winds and water rolled by degrees to the
land.
This wholly diverted my thoughts from the design of removing my habitation, and
I busied myself mightily, that day especially, in searching whether I could
make any way into the ship; but I found nothing was to be expected of that
kind, for all the inside of the ship was choked up with sand. However, as I had
learned not to despair of anything, I resolved to pull everything to pieces
that I could of the ship, concluding that everything I could get from her would
be of some use or other to me.
3.—I began with my saw, and cut a piece of a beam through,
which I thought held some of the upper part or quarter-deck together, and when
I had cut it through, I cleared away the sand as well as I could from the side
which lay highest; but the tide coming in, I was obliged to give over for that
time.
4.—I went a-fishing, but caught not one fish that I durst eat
of, till I was weary of my sport; when, just going to leave off, I caught a
young dolphin. I had made me a long line of some rope-yarn, but I had no hooks;
yet I frequently caught fish enough, as much as I cared to eat; all which I
dried in the sun, and ate them dry.
5.—Worked on the wreck; cut another beam asunder, and brought
three great fir planks off from the decks, which I tied together, and made to
float on shore when the tide of flood came on.
6.—Worked on the wreck; got several iron bolts out of her and
other pieces of ironwork. Worked very hard, and came home very much tired, and
had thoughts of giving it over.
7.—Went to the wreck again, not with an intent to work, but
found the weight of the wreck had broke itself down, the beams being cut; that
several pieces of the ship seemed to lie loose, and the inside of the hold lay
so open that I could see into it; but it was almost full of water and sand.
8.—Went to the wreck, and carried an iron crow to wrench up
the deck, which lay now quite clear of the water or sand. I wrenched open two
planks, and brought them on shore also with the tide. I left the iron crow in
the wreck for next day.
9.—Went to the wreck, and with the crow made way into the body
of the wreck, and felt several casks, and loosened them with the crow, but
could not break them up. I felt also a roll of English lead, and could stir it,
but it was too heavy to remove.
10–14.—Went every day to the wreck; and got a great many
pieces of timber, and boards, or plank, and two or three hundredweight of iron.
15.—I carried two hatchets, to try if I could not cut a piece
off the roll of lead by placing the edge of one hatchet and driving it with the
other; but as it lay about a foot and a half in the water, I could not make any
blow to drive the hatchet.
16.—It had blown hard in the night, and the wreck appeared
more broken by the force of the water; but I stayed so long in the woods, to
get pigeons for food, that the tide prevented my going to the wreck that day.
17.—I saw some pieces of the wreck blown on shore, at a great
distance, near two miles off me, but resolved to see what they were, and found
it was a piece of the head, but too heavy for me to bring away.
24.—Every day, to this day, I worked on the wreck; and with
hard labour I loosened some things so much with the crow, that the first
flowing tide several casks floated out, and two of the seamen’s chests;
but the wind blowing from the shore, nothing came to land that day but pieces
of timber, and a hogshead, which had some Brazil pork in it; but the salt water
and the sand had spoiled it. I continued this work every day to the 15th of
June, except the time necessary to get food, which I always appointed, during
this part of my employment, to be when the tide was up, that I might be ready
when it was ebbed out; and by this time I had got timber and plank and ironwork
enough to have built a good boat, if I had known how; and also I got, at
several times and in several pieces, near one hundredweight of the sheet lead.
16.—Going down to the seaside, I found a large tortoise or
turtle. This was the first I had seen, which, it seems, was only my misfortune,
not any defect of the place, or scarcity; for had I happened to be on the other
side of the island, I might have had hundreds of them every day, as I found
afterwards; but perhaps had paid dear enough for them.
17.—I spent in cooking the turtle. I found in her three-score
eggs; and her flesh was to me, at that time, the most savoury and pleasant that
ever I tasted in my life, having had no flesh, but of goats and fowls, since I
landed in this horrid place.
18.—Rained all day, and I stayed within. I thought at this
time the rain felt cold, and I was something chilly; which I knew was not usual
in that latitude.
19.—Very ill, and shivering, as if the weather had been cold.
20.—No rest all night; violent pains in my head, and
feverish.
21.—Very ill; frighted almost to death with the apprehensions
of my sad condition—to be sick, and no help. Prayed to God, for the first
time since the storm off Hull, but scarce knew what I said, or why, my thoughts
being all confused.
22.—A little better; but under dreadful apprehensions of
sickness.
23.—Very bad again; cold and shivering, and then a violent
headache.
24.—Much better.
25.—An ague very violent; the fit held me seven hours; cold
fit and hot, with faint sweats after it.
26.—Better; and having no victuals to eat, took my gun, but
found myself very weak. However, I killed a she-goat, and with much difficulty
got it home, and broiled some of it, and ate, I would fain have stewed it, and
made some broth, but had no pot.
27.—The ague again so violent that I lay a-bed all day, and
neither ate nor drank. I was ready to perish for thirst; but so weak, I had not
strength to stand up, or to get myself any water to drink. Prayed to God again,
but was light-headed; and when I was not, I was so ignorant that I knew not
what to say; only I lay and cried, “Lord, look upon me! Lord, pity me!
Lord, have mercy upon me!” I suppose I did nothing else for two or three
hours; till, the fit wearing off, I fell asleep, and did not wake till far in
the night. When I awoke, I found myself much refreshed, but weak, and exceeding
thirsty. However, as I had no water in my habitation, I was forced to lie till
morning, and went to sleep again. In this second sleep I had this terrible
dream: I thought that I was sitting on the ground, on the outside of my wall,
where I sat when the storm blew after the earthquake, and that I saw a man
descend from a great black cloud, in a bright flame of fire, and light upon the
ground. He was all over as bright as a flame, so that I could but just bear to
look towards him; his countenance was most inexpressibly dreadful, impossible
for words to describe. When he stepped upon the ground with his feet, I thought
the earth trembled, just as it had done before in the earthquake, and all the
air looked, to my apprehension, as if it had been filled with flashes of fire.
He was no sooner landed upon the earth, but he moved forward towards me, with a
long spear or weapon in his hand, to kill me; and when he came to a rising
ground, at some distance, he spoke to me—or I heard a voice so terrible
that it is impossible to express the terror of it. All that I can say I
understood was this: “Seeing all these things have not brought thee to
repentance, now thou shalt die;” at which words, I thought he lifted up
the spear that was in his hand to kill me.
No one that shall ever read this account will expect that I should be able to
describe the horrors of my soul at this terrible vision. I mean, that even
while it was a dream, I even dreamed of those horrors. Nor is it any more
possible to describe the impression that remained upon my mind when I awaked,
and found it was but a dream.
I had, alas! no divine knowledge. What I had received by the good instruction
of my father was then worn out by an uninterrupted series, for eight years, of
seafaring wickedness, and a constant conversation with none but such as were,
like myself, wicked and profane to the last degree. I do not remember that I
had, in all that time, one thought that so much as tended either to looking
upwards towards God, or inwards towards a reflection upon my own ways; but a
certain stupidity of soul, without desire of good, or conscience of evil, had
entirely overwhelmed me; and I was all that the most hardened, unthinking,
wicked creature among our common sailors can be supposed to be; not having the
least sense, either of the fear of God in danger, or of thankfulness to God in
deliverance.
In the relating what is already past of my story, this will be the more easily
believed when I shall add, that through all the variety of miseries that had to
this day befallen me, I never had so much as one thought of it being the hand
of God, or that it was a just punishment for my sin—my rebellious
behaviour against my father—or my present sins, which were great—or
so much as a punishment for the general course of my wicked life. When I was on
the desperate expedition on the desert shores of Africa, I never had so much as
one thought of what would become of me, or one wish to God to direct me whither
I should go, or to keep me from the danger which apparently surrounded me, as
well from voracious creatures as cruel savages. But I was merely thoughtless of
a God or a Providence, acted like a mere brute, from the principles of nature,
and by the dictates of common sense only, and, indeed, hardly that. When I was
delivered and taken up at sea by the Portugal captain, well used, and dealt
justly and honourably with, as well as charitably, I had not the least
thankfulness in my thoughts. When, again, I was shipwrecked, ruined, and in
danger of drowning on this island, I was as far from remorse, or looking on it
as a judgment. I only said to myself often, that I was an unfortunate dog, and
born to be always miserable.
It is true, when I got on shore first here, and found all my ship’s crew
drowned and myself spared, I was surprised with a kind of ecstasy, and some
transports of soul, which, had the grace of God assisted, might have come up to
true thankfulness; but it ended where it began, in a mere common flight of joy,
or, as I may say, being glad I was alive, without the least reflection upon the
distinguished goodness of the hand which had preserved me, and had singled me
out to be preserved when all the rest were destroyed, or an inquiry why
Providence had been thus merciful unto me. Even just the same common sort of
joy which seamen generally have, after they are got safe ashore from a
shipwreck, which they drown all in the next bowl of punch, and forget almost as
soon as it is over; and all the rest of my life was like it. Even when I was
afterwards, on due consideration, made sensible of my condition, how I was cast
on this dreadful place, out of the reach of human kind, out of all hope of
relief, or prospect of redemption, as soon as I saw but a prospect of living
and that I should not starve and perish for hunger, all the sense of my
affliction wore off; and I began to be very easy, applied myself to the works
proper for my preservation and supply, and was far enough from being afflicted
at my condition, as a judgment from heaven, or as the hand of God against me:
these were thoughts which very seldom entered my head.
The growing up of the corn, as is hinted in my Journal, had at first some
little influence upon me, and began to affect me with seriousness, as long as I
thought it had something miraculous in it; but as soon as ever that part of the
thought was removed, all the impression that was raised from it wore off also,
as I have noted already. Even the earthquake, though nothing could be more
terrible in its nature, or more immediately directing to the invisible Power
which alone directs such things, yet no sooner was the first fright over, but
the impression it had made went off also. I had no more sense of God or His
judgments—much less of the present affliction of my circumstances being
from His hand—than if I had been in the most prosperous condition of
life. But now, when I began to be sick, and a leisurely view of the miseries of
death came to place itself before me; when my spirits began to sink under the
burden of a strong distemper, and nature was exhausted with the violence of the
fever; conscience, that had slept so long, began to awake, and I began to
reproach myself with my past life, in which I had so evidently, by uncommon
wickedness, provoked the justice of God to lay me under uncommon strokes, and
to deal with me in so vindictive a manner. These reflections oppressed me for
the second or third day of my distemper; and in the violence, as well of the
fever as of the dreadful reproaches of my conscience, extorted some words from
me like praying to God, though I cannot say they were either a prayer attended
with desires or with hopes: it was rather the voice of mere fright and
distress. My thoughts were confused, the convictions great upon my mind, and
the horror of dying in such a miserable condition raised vapours into my head
with the mere apprehensions; and in these hurries of my soul I knew not what my
tongue might express. But it was rather exclamation, such as, “Lord, what
a miserable creature am I! If I should be sick, I shall certainly die for want
of help; and what will become of me!” Then the tears burst out of my
eyes, and I could say no more for a good while. In this interval the good
advice of my father came to my mind, and presently his prediction, which I
mentioned at the beginning of this story—viz. that if I did take this
foolish step, God would not bless me, and I would have leisure hereafter to
reflect upon having neglected his counsel when there might be none to assist in
my recovery. “Now,” said I, aloud, “my dear father’s
words are come to pass; God’s justice has overtaken me, and I have none
to help or hear me. I rejected the voice of Providence, which had mercifully
put me in a posture or station of life wherein I might have been happy and
easy; but I would neither see it myself nor learn to know the blessing of it
from my parents. I left them to mourn over my folly, and now I am left to mourn
under the consequences of it. I abused their help and assistance, who would
have lifted me in the world, and would have made everything easy to me; and now
I have difficulties to struggle with, too great for even nature itself to
support, and no assistance, no help, no comfort, no advice.” Then I cried
out, “Lord, be my help, for I am in great distress.” This was the
first prayer, if I may call it so, that I had made for many years.
But to return to my Journal.
28.—Having been somewhat refreshed with the sleep I had had,
and the fit being entirely off, I got up; and though the fright and terror of
my dream was very great, yet I considered that the fit of the ague would return
again the next day, and now was my time to get something to refresh and support
myself when I should be ill; and the first thing I did, I filled a large square
case-bottle with water, and set it upon my table, in reach of my bed; and to
take off the chill or aguish disposition of the water, I put about a quarter of
a pint of rum into it, and mixed them together. Then I got me a piece of the
goat’s flesh and broiled it on the coals, but could eat very little. I
walked about, but was very weak, and withal very sad and heavy-hearted under a
sense of my miserable condition, dreading, the return of my distemper the next
day. At night I made my supper of three of the turtle’s eggs, which I
roasted in the ashes, and ate, as we call it, in the shell, and this was the
first bit of meat I had ever asked God’s blessing to, that I could
remember, in my whole life. After I had eaten I tried to walk, but found myself
so weak that I could hardly carry a gun, for I never went out without that; so
I went but a little way, and sat down upon the ground, looking out upon the
sea, which was just before me, and very calm and smooth. As I sat here some
such thoughts as these occurred to me: What is this earth and sea, of which I
have seen so much? Whence is it produced? And what am I, and all the other
creatures wild and tame, human and brutal? Whence are we? Sure we are all made
by some secret Power, who formed the earth and sea, the air and sky. And who is
that? Then it followed most naturally, it is God that has made all. Well, but
then it came on strangely, if God has made all these things, He guides and
governs them all, and all things that concern them; for the Power that could
make all things must certainly have power to guide and direct them. If so,
nothing can happen in the great circuit of His works, either without His
knowledge or appointment.
And if nothing happens without His knowledge, He knows that I am here, and am
in this dreadful condition; and if nothing happens without His appointment, He
has appointed all this to befall me. Nothing occurred to my thought to
contradict any of these conclusions, and therefore it rested upon me with the
greater force, that it must needs be that God had appointed all this to befall
me; that I was brought into this miserable circumstance by His direction, He
having the sole power, not of me only, but of everything that happened in the
world. Immediately it followed: Why has God done this to me? What have I done
to be thus used? My conscience presently checked me in that inquiry, as if I
had blasphemed, and methought it spoke to me like a voice: “Wretch! dost
ask what thou hast done? Look back upon a dreadful misspent life,
and ask thyself what thou hast done? Ask, why is it that thou wert
not long ago destroyed? Why wert thou not drowned in Yarmouth Roads; killed in
the fight when the ship was taken by the Sallee man-of-war; devoured by the
wild beasts on the coast of Africa; or drowned , when all the crew
perished but thyself? Dost ask, what have I done?” I was
struck dumb with these reflections, as one astonished, and had not a word to
say—no, not to answer to myself, but rose up pensive and sad, walked back
to my retreat, and went up over my wall, as if I had been going to bed; but my
thoughts were sadly disturbed, and I had no inclination to sleep; so I sat down
in my chair, and lighted my lamp, for it began to be dark. Now, as the
apprehension of the return of my distemper terrified me very much, it occurred
to my thought that the Brazilians take no physic but their tobacco for almost
all distempers, and I had a piece of a roll of tobacco in one of the chests,
which was quite cured, and some also that was green, and not quite cured.
I went, directed by Heaven no doubt; for in this chest I found a cure both for
soul and body. I opened the chest, and found what I looked for, the tobacco;
and as the few books I had saved lay there too, I took out one of the Bibles
which I mentioned before, and which to this time I had not found leisure or
inclination to look into. I say, I took it out, and brought both that and the
tobacco with me to the table. What use to make of the tobacco I knew not, in my
distemper, or whether it was good for it or no: but I tried several experiments
with it, as if I was resolved it should hit one way or other. I first took a
piece of leaf, and chewed it in my mouth, which, indeed, at first almost
stupefied my brain, the tobacco being green and strong, and that I had not been
much used to. Then I took some and steeped it an hour or two in some rum, and
resolved to take a dose of it when I lay down; and lastly, I burnt some upon a
pan of coals, and held my nose close over the smoke of it as long as I could
bear it, as well for the heat as almost for suffocation. In the interval of
this operation I took up the Bible and began to read; but my head was too much
disturbed with the tobacco to bear reading, at least at that time; only, having
opened the book casually, the first words that occurred to me were these,
“Call on Me in the day of trouble, and I will deliver thee, and thou
shalt glorify Me.” These words were very apt to my case, and made some
impression upon my thoughts at the time of reading them, though not so much as
they did afterwards; for, as for being , the word had no sound,
as I may say, to me; the thing was so remote, so impossible in my apprehension
of things, that I began to say, as the children of Israel did when they were
promised flesh to eat, “Can God spread a table in the wilderness?”
so I began to say, “Can God Himself deliver me from this place?”
And as it was not for many years that any hopes appeared, this prevailed very
often upon my thoughts; but, however, the words made a great impression upon
me, and I mused upon them very often. It grew now late, and the tobacco had, as
I said, dozed my head so much that I inclined to sleep; so I left my lamp
burning in the cave, lest I should want anything in the night, and went to bed.
But before I lay down, I did what I never had done in all my life—I
kneeled down, and prayed to God to fulfil the promise to me, that if I called
upon Him in the day of trouble, He would deliver me. After my broken and
imperfect prayer was over, I drank the rum in which I had steeped the tobacco,
which was so strong and rank of the tobacco that I could scarcely get it down;
immediately upon this I went to bed. I found presently it flew up into my head
violently; but I fell into a sound sleep, and waked no more till, by the sun,
it must necessarily be near three o’clock in the afternoon the next
day—nay, to this hour I am partly of opinion that I slept all the next
day and night, and till almost three the day after; for otherwise I know not
how I should lose a day out of my reckoning in the days of the week, as it
appeared some years after I had done; for if I had lost it by crossing and
recrossing the line, I should have lost more than one day; but certainly I lost
a day in my account, and never knew which way. Be that, however, one way or the
other, when I awaked I found myself exceedingly refreshed, and my spirits
lively and cheerful; when I got up I was stronger than I was the day before,
and my stomach better, for I was hungry; and, in short, I had no fit the next
day, but continued much altered for the better. This was the 29th.
The 30th was my well day, of course, and I went abroad with my gun, but did not
care to travel too far. I killed a sea-fowl or two, something like a
brandgoose, and brought them home, but was not very forward to eat them; so I
ate some more of the turtle’s eggs, which were very good. This evening I
renewed the medicine, which I had supposed did me good the day before—the
tobacco steeped in rum; only I did not take so much as before, nor did I chew
any of the leaf, or hold my head over the smoke; however, I was not so well the
next day, which was the first of July, as I hoped I should have been; for I had
a little spice of the cold fit, but it was not much.
2.—I renewed the medicine all the three ways; and dosed
myself with it as at first, and doubled the quantity which I drank.
3.—I missed the fit for good and all, though I did not
recover my full strength for some weeks after. While I was thus gathering
strength, my thoughts ran exceedingly upon this Scripture, “I will
deliver thee”; and the impossibility of my deliverance lay much upon my
mind, in bar of my ever expecting it; but as I was discouraging myself with
such thoughts, it occurred to my mind that I pored so much upon my deliverance
from the main affliction, that I disregarded the deliverance I had received,
and I was as it were made to ask myself such questions as these—viz. Have
I not been delivered, and wonderfully too, from sickness—from the most
distressed condition that could be, and that was so frightful to me? and what
notice had I taken of it? Had I done my part? God had delivered me, but I had
not glorified Him—that is to say, I had not owned and been thankful for
that as a deliverance; and how could I expect greater deliverance? This touched
my heart very much; and immediately I knelt down and gave God thanks aloud for
my recovery from my sickness.
4.—In the morning I took the Bible; and beginning at the New
Testament, I began seriously to read it, and imposed upon myself to read a
while every morning and every night; not tying myself to the number of
chapters, but long as my thoughts should engage me. It was not long after I set
seriously to this work till I found my heart more deeply and sincerely affected
with the wickedness of my past life. The impression of my dream revived; and
the words, “All these things have not brought thee to repentance,”
ran seriously through my thoughts. I was earnestly begging of God to give me
repentance, when it happened providentially, the very day, that, reading the
Scripture, I came to these words: “He is exalted a Prince and a Saviour,
to give repentance and to give remission.” I threw down the book; and
with my heart as well as my hands lifted up to heaven, in a kind of ecstasy of
joy, I cried out aloud, “Jesus, thou son of David! Jesus, thou exalted
Prince and Saviour! give me repentance!” This was the first time I could
say, in the true sense of the words, that I prayed in all my life; for now I
prayed with a sense of my condition, and a true Scripture view of hope, founded
on the encouragement of the Word of God; and from this time, I may say, I began
to hope that God would hear me.
Now I began to construe the words mentioned above, “Call on Me, and I
will deliver thee,” in a different sense from what I had ever done
before; for then I had no notion of anything being called ,
but my being delivered from the captivity I was in; for though I was indeed at
large in the place, yet the island was certainly a prison to me, and that in
the worse sense in the world. But now I learned to take it in another sense:
now I looked back upon my past life with such horror, and my sins appeared so
dreadful, that my soul sought nothing of God but deliverance from the load of
guilt that bore down all my comfort. As for my solitary life, it was nothing. I
did not so much as pray to be delivered from it or think of it; it was all of
no consideration in comparison to this. And I add this part here, to hint to
whoever shall read it, that whenever they come to a true sense of things, they
will find deliverance from sin a much greater blessing than deliverance from
affliction.
But, leaving this part, I return to my Journal.
My condition began now to be, though not less miserable as to my way of living,
yet much easier to my mind: and my thoughts being directed, by a constant
reading the Scripture and praying to God, to things of a higher nature, I had a
great deal of comfort within, which till now I knew nothing of; also, my health
and strength returned, I bestirred myself to furnish myself with everything
that I wanted, and make my way of living as regular as I could.
From the 4th of July to the 14th I was chiefly employed in walking about with
my gun in my hand, a little and a little at a time, as a man that was gathering
up his strength after a fit of sickness; for it is hardly to be imagined how
low I was, and to what weakness I was reduced. The application which I made use
of was perfectly new, and perhaps which had never cured an ague before; neither
can I recommend it to any to practise, by this experiment: and though it did
carry off the fit, yet it rather contributed to weakening me; for I had
frequent convulsions in my nerves and limbs for some time. I learned from it
also this, in particular, that being abroad in the rainy season was the most
pernicious thing to my health that could be, especially in those rains which
came attended with storms and hurricanes of wind; for as the rain which came in
the dry season was almost always accompanied with such storms, so I found that
rain was much more dangerous than the rain which fell in September and October.
CHAPTER VII.
AGRICULTURAL EXPERIENCE
I had now been in this unhappy island above ten months. All possibility of
deliverance from this condition seemed to be entirely taken from me; and I
firmly believe that no human shape had ever set foot upon that place. Having
now secured my habitation, as I thought, fully to my mind, I had a great desire
to make a more perfect discovery of the island, and to see what other
productions I might find, which I yet knew nothing of.
It was on the 15th of July that I began to take a more particular survey of the
island itself. I went up the creek first, where, as I hinted, I brought my
rafts on shore. I found after I came about two miles up, that the tide did not
flow any higher, and that it was no more than a little brook of running water,
very fresh and good; but this being the dry season, there was hardly any water
in some parts of it—at least not enough to run in any stream, so as it
could be perceived. On the banks of this brook I found many pleasant savannahs
or meadows, plain, smooth, and covered with grass; and on the rising parts of
them, next to the higher grounds, where the water, as might be supposed, never
overflowed, I found a great deal of tobacco, green, and growing to a great and
very strong stalk. There were divers other plants, which I had no notion of or
understanding about, that might, perhaps, have virtues of their own, which I
could not find out. I searched for the cassava root, which the Indians, in all
that climate, make their bread of, but I could find none. I saw large plants of
aloes, but did not understand them. I saw several sugar-canes, but wild, and,
for want of cultivation, imperfect. I contented myself with these discoveries
for this time, and came back, musing with myself what course I might take to
know the virtue and goodness of any of the fruits or plants which I should
discover, but could bring it to no conclusion; for, in short, I had made so
little observation while I was in the Brazils, that I knew little of the plants
in the field; at least, very little that might serve to any purpose now in my
distress.
The next day, the sixteenth, I went up the same way again; and after going
something further than I had gone the day before, I found the brook and the
savannahs cease, and the country become more woody than before. In this part I
found different fruits, and particularly I found melons upon the ground, in
great abundance, and grapes upon the trees. The vines had spread, indeed, over
the trees, and the clusters of grapes were just now in their prime, very ripe
and rich. This was a surprising discovery, and I was exceeding glad of them;
but I was warned by my experience to eat sparingly of them; remembering that
when I was ashore in Barbary, the eating of grapes killed several of our
Englishmen, who were slaves there, by throwing them into fluxes and fevers. But
I found an excellent use for these grapes; and that was, to cure or dry them in
the sun, and keep them as dried grapes or raisins are kept, which I thought
would be, as indeed they were, wholesome and agreeable to eat when no grapes
could be had.
I spent all that evening there, and went not back to my habitation; which, by
the way, was the first night, as I might say, I had lain from home. In the
night, I took my first contrivance, and got up in a tree, where I slept well;
and the next morning proceeded upon my discovery; travelling nearly four miles,
as I might judge by the length of the valley, keeping still due north, with a
ridge of hills on the south and north side of me. At the end of this march I
came to an opening where the country seemed to descend to the west; and a
little spring of fresh water, which issued out of the side of the hill by me,
ran the other way, that is, due east; and the country appeared so fresh, so
green, so flourishing, everything being in a constant verdure or flourish of
spring that it looked like a planted garden. I descended a little on the side
of that delicious vale, surveying it with a secret kind of pleasure, though
mixed with my other afflicting thoughts, to think that this was all my own;
that I was king and lord of all this country indefensibly, and had a right of
possession; and if I could convey it, I might have it in inheritance as
completely as any lord of a manor in England. I saw here abundance of cocoa
trees, orange, and lemon, and citron trees; but all wild, and very few bearing
any fruit, at least not then. However, the green limes that I gathered were not
only pleasant to eat, but very wholesome; and I mixed their juice afterwards
with water, which made it very wholesome, and very cool and refreshing. I found
now I had business enough to gather and carry home; and I resolved to lay up a
store as well of grapes as limes and lemons, to furnish myself for the wet
season, which I knew was approaching. In order to do this, I gathered a great
heap of grapes in one place, a lesser heap in another place, and a great parcel
of limes and lemons in another place; and taking a few of each with me, I
travelled homewards; resolving to come again, and bring a bag or sack, or what
I could make, to carry the rest home. Accordingly, having spent three days in
this journey, I came home (so I must now call my tent and my cave); but before
I got thither the grapes were spoiled; the richness of the fruit and the weight
of the juice having broken them and bruised them, they were good for little or
nothing; as to the limes, they were good, but I could bring but a few.
The next day, being the nineteenth, I went back, having made me two small bags
to bring home my harvest; but I was surprised, when coming to my heap of
grapes, which were so rich and fine when I gathered them, to find them all
spread about, trod to pieces, and dragged about, some here, some there, and
abundance eaten and devoured. By this I concluded there were some wild
creatures thereabouts, which had done this; but what they were I knew not.
However, as I found there was no laying them up on heaps, and no carrying them
away in a sack, but that one way they would be destroyed, and the other way
they would be crushed with their own weight, I took another course; for I
gathered a large quantity of the grapes, and hung upon the out-branches of the
trees, that they might cure and dry in the sun; and as for the limes and
lemons, I carried as many back as I could well stand under.
When I came home from this journey, I contemplated with great pleasure the
fruitfulness of that valley, and the pleasantness of the situation; the
security from storms on that side of the water, and the wood: and concluded
that I had pitched upon a place to fix my abode which was by far the worst part
of the country. Upon the whole, I began to consider of removing my habitation,
and looking out for a place equally safe as where now I was situate, if
possible, in that pleasant, fruitful part of the island.
This thought ran long in my head, and I was exceeding fond of it for some time,
the pleasantness of the place tempting me; but when I came to a nearer view of
it, I considered that I was now by the seaside, where it was at least possible
that something might happen to my advantage, and, by the same ill fate that
brought me hither might bring some other unhappy wretches to the same place;
and though it was scarce probable that any such thing should ever happen, yet
to enclose myself among the hills and woods in the centre of the island was to
anticipate my bondage, and to render such an affair not only improbable, but
impossible; and that therefore I ought not by any means to remove. However, I
was so enamoured of this place, that I spent much of my time there for the
whole of the remaining part of the month of July; and though upon second
thoughts, I resolved not to remove, yet I built me a little kind of a bower,
and surrounded it at a distance with a strong fence, being a double hedge, as
high as I could reach, well staked and filled between with brushwood; and here
I lay very secure, sometimes two or three nights together; always going over it
with a ladder; so that I fancied now I had my country house and my sea-coast
house; and this work took me up to the beginning of August.
I had but newly finished my fence, and began to enjoy my labour, when the rains
came on, and made me stick close to my first habitation; for though I had made
me a tent like the other, with a piece of a sail, and spread it very well, yet
I had not the shelter of a hill to keep me from storms, nor a cave behind me to
retreat into when the rains were extraordinary.
About the beginning of August, as I said, I had finished my bower, and began to
enjoy myself. The 3rd of August, I found the grapes I had hung up perfectly
dried, and, indeed, were excellent good raisins of the sun; so I began to take
them down from the trees, and it was very happy that I did so, for the rains
which followed would have spoiled them, and I had lost the best part of my
winter food; for I had above two hundred large bunches of them. No sooner had I
taken them all down, and carried the most of them home to my cave, than it
began to rain; and from hence, which was the 14th of August, it rained, more or
less, every day till the middle of October; and sometimes so violently, that I
could not stir out of my cave for several days.
In this season I was much surprised with the increase of my family; I had been
concerned for the loss of one of my cats, who ran away from me, or, as I
thought, had been dead, and I heard no more tidings of her till, to my
astonishment, she came home about the end of August with three kittens. This
was the more strange to me because, though I had killed a wild cat, as I called
it, with my gun, yet I thought it was quite a different kind from our European
cats; but the young cats were the same kind of house-breed as the old one; and
both my cats being females, I thought it very strange. But from these three
cats I afterwards came to be so pestered with cats that I was forced to kill
them like vermin or wild beasts, and to drive them from my house as much as
possible.
From the 14th of August to the 26th, incessant rain, so that I could not stir,
and was now very careful not to be much wet. In this confinement, I began to be
straitened for food: but venturing out twice, I one day killed a goat; and the
last day, which was the 26th, found a very large tortoise, which was a treat to
me, and my food was regulated thus: I ate a bunch of raisins for my breakfast;
a piece of the goat’s flesh, or of the turtle, for my dinner,
broiled—for, to my great misfortune, I had no vessel to boil or stew
anything; and two or three of the turtle’s eggs for my supper.
During this confinement in my cover by the rain, I worked daily two or three
hours at enlarging my cave, and by degrees worked it on towards one side, till
I came to the outside of the hill, and made a door or way out, which came
beyond my fence or wall; and so I came in and out this way. But I was not
perfectly easy at lying so open; for, as I had managed myself before, I was in
a perfect enclosure; whereas now I thought I lay exposed, and open for anything
to come in upon me; and yet I could not perceive that there was any living
thing to fear, the biggest creature that I had yet seen upon the island being a
goat.
30.—I was now come to the unhappy anniversary of my landing.
I cast up the notches on my post, and found I had been on shore three hundred
and sixty-five days. I kept this day as a solemn fast, setting it apart for
religious exercise, prostrating myself on the ground with the most serious
humiliation, confessing my sins to God, acknowledging His righteous judgments
upon me, and praying to Him to have mercy on me through Jesus Christ; and not
having tasted the least refreshment for twelve hours, even till the going down
of the sun, I then ate a biscuit-cake and a bunch of grapes, and went to bed,
finishing the day as I began it. I had all this time observed no Sabbath day;
for as at first I had no sense of religion upon my mind, I had, after some
time, omitted to distinguish the weeks, by making a longer notch than ordinary
for the Sabbath day, and so did not really know what any of the days were; but
now, having cast up the days as above, I found I had been there a year; so I
divided it into weeks, and set apart every seventh day for a Sabbath; though I
found at the end of my account I had lost a day or two in my reckoning. A
little after this, my ink began to fail me, and so I contented myself to use it
more sparingly, and to write down only the most remarkable events of my life,
without continuing a daily memorandum of other things.
The rainy season and the dry season began now to appear regular to me, and I
learned to divide them so as to provide for them accordingly; but I bought all
my experience before I had it, and this I am going to relate was one of the
most discouraging experiments that I made.
I have mentioned that I had saved the few ears of barley and rice, which I had
so surprisingly found spring up, as I thought, of themselves, and I believe
there were about thirty stalks of rice, and about twenty of barley; and now I
thought it a proper time to sow it, after the rains, the sun being in its
southern position, going from me. Accordingly, I dug up a piece of ground as
well as I could with my wooden spade, and dividing it into two parts, I sowed
my grain; but as I was sowing, it casually occurred to my thoughts that I would
not sow it all at first, because I did not know when was the proper time for
it, so I sowed about two-thirds of the seed, leaving about a handful of each.
It was a great comfort to me afterwards that I did so, for not one grain of
what I sowed this time came to anything: for the dry months following, the
earth having had no rain after the seed was sown, it had no moisture to assist
its growth, and never came up at all till the wet season had come again, and
then it grew as if it had been but newly sown. Finding my first seed did not
grow, which I easily imagined was by the drought, I sought for a moister piece
of ground to make another trial in, and I dug up a piece of ground near my new
bower, and sowed the rest of my seed in February, a little before the vernal
equinox; and this having the rainy months of March and April to water it,
sprung up very pleasantly, and yielded a very good crop; but having part of the
seed left only, and not daring to sow all that I had, I had but a small
quantity at last, my whole crop not amounting to above half a peck of each
kind. But by this experiment I was made master of my business, and knew exactly
when the proper season was to sow, and that I might expect two seed-times and
two harvests every year.
While this corn was growing I made a little discovery, which was of use to me
afterwards. As soon as the rains were over, and the weather began to settle,
which was about the month of November, I made a visit up the country to my
bower, where, though I had not been some months, yet I found all things just as
I left them. The circle or double hedge that I had made was not only firm and
entire, but the stakes which I had cut out of some trees that grew thereabouts
were all shot out and grown with long branches, as much as a willow-tree
usually shoots the first year after lopping its head. I could not tell what
tree to call it that these stakes were cut from. I was surprised, and yet very
well pleased, to see the young trees grow; and I pruned them, and led them up
to grow as much alike as I could; and it is scarce credible how beautiful a
figure they grew into in three years; so that though the hedge made a circle of
about twenty-five yards in diameter, yet the trees, for such I might now call
them, soon covered it, and it was a complete shade, sufficient to lodge under
all the dry season. This made me resolve to cut some more stakes, and make me a
hedge like this, in a semi-circle round my wall (I mean that of my first
dwelling), which I did; and placing the trees or stakes in a double row, at
about eight yards distance from my first fence, they grew presently, and were
at first a fine cover to my habitation, and afterwards served for a defence
also, as I shall observe in its order.
I found now that the seasons of the year might generally be divided, not into
summer and winter, as in Europe, but into the rainy seasons and the dry
seasons, which were generally thus:—The half of February, the whole of
March, and the half of April—rainy, the sun being then on or near the
equinox.
The half of April, the whole of May, June, and July, and the half of
August—dry, the sun being then to the north of the line.
The half of August, the whole of September, and the half of
October—rainy, the sun being then come back.
The half of October, the whole of November, December, and January, and the half
of February—dry, the sun being then to the south of the line.
The rainy seasons sometimes held longer or shorter as the winds happened to
blow, but this was the general observation I made. After I had found by
experience the ill consequences of being abroad in the rain, I took care to
furnish myself with provisions beforehand, that I might not be obliged to go
out, and I sat within doors as much as possible during the wet months. This
time I found much employment, and very suitable also to the time, for I found
great occasion for many things which I had no way to furnish myself with but by
hard labour and constant application; particularly I tried many ways to make
myself a basket, but all the twigs I could get for the purpose proved so
brittle that they would do nothing. It proved of excellent advantage to me now,
that when I was a boy, I used to take great delight in standing at a
basket-maker’s, in the town where my father lived, to see them make their
wicker-ware; and being, as boys usually are, very officious to help, and a
great observer of the manner in which they worked those things, and sometimes
lending a hand, I had by these means full knowledge of the methods of it, and I
wanted nothing but the materials, when it came into my mind that the twigs of
that tree from whence I cut my stakes that grew might possibly be as tough as
the sallows, willows, and osiers in England, and I resolved to try.
Accordingly, the next day I went to my country house, as I called it, and
cutting some of the smaller twigs, I found them to my purpose as much as I
could desire; whereupon I came the next time prepared with a hatchet to cut
down a quantity, which I soon found, for there was great plenty of them. These
I set up to dry within my circle or hedge, and when they were fit for use I
carried them to my cave; and here, during the next season, I employed myself in
making, as well as I could, a great many baskets, both to carry earth or to
carry or lay up anything, as I had occasion; and though I did not finish them
very handsomely, yet I made them sufficiently serviceable for my purpose; thus,
afterwards, I took care never to be without them; and as my wicker-ware
decayed, I made more, especially strong, deep baskets to place my corn in,
instead of sacks, when I should come to have any quantity of it.
Having mastered this difficulty, and employed a world of time about it, I
bestirred myself to see, if possible, how to supply two wants. I had no vessels
to hold anything that was liquid, except two runlets, which were almost full of
rum, and some glass bottles—some of the common size, and others which
were case bottles, square, for the holding of water, spirits, &c. I had not
so much as a pot to boil anything, except a great kettle, which I saved out of
the ship, and which was too big for such as I desired it—viz. to make
broth, and stew a bit of meat by itself. The second thing I fain would have had
was a tobacco-pipe, but it was impossible to me to make one; however, I found a
contrivance for that, too, at last. I employed myself in planting my second
rows of stakes or piles, and in this wicker-working all the summer or dry
season, when another business took me up more time than it could be imagined I
could spare.
CHAPTER VIII.
SURVEYS HIS POSITION
I mentioned before that I had a great mind to see the whole island, and that I
had travelled up the brook, and so on to where I built my bower, and where I
had an opening quite to the sea, on the other side of the island. I now
resolved to travel quite across to the sea-shore on that side; so, taking my
gun, a hatchet, and my dog, and a larger quantity of powder and shot than
usual, with two biscuit-cakes and a great bunch of raisins in my pouch for my
store, I began my journey. When I had passed the vale where my bower stood, as
above, I came within view of the sea to the west, and it being a very clear
day, I fairly descried land—whether an island or a continent I could not
tell; but it lay very high, extending from the W. to the W.S.W. at a very great
distance; by my guess it could not be less than fifteen or twenty leagues off.
I could not tell what part of the world this might be, otherwise than that I
knew it must be part of America, and, as I concluded by all my observations,
must be near the Spanish dominions, and perhaps was all inhabited by savages,
where, if I had landed, I had been in a worse condition than I was now; and
therefore I acquiesced in the dispositions of Providence, which I began now to
own and to believe ordered everything for the best; I say I quieted my mind
with this, and left off afflicting myself with fruitless wishes of being there.
Besides, after some thought upon this affair, I considered that if this land
was the Spanish coast, I should certainly, one time or other, see some vessel
pass or repass one way or other; but if not, then it was the savage coast
between the Spanish country and Brazils, where are found the worst of savages;
for they are cannibals or men-eaters, and fail not to murder and devour all the
human bodies that fall into their hands.
With these considerations, I walked very leisurely forward. I found that side
of the island where I now was much pleasanter than mine—the open or
savannah fields sweet, adorned with flowers and grass, and full of very fine
woods. I saw abundance of parrots, and fain I would have caught one, if
possible, to have kept it to be tame, and taught it to speak to me. I did,
after some painstaking, catch a young parrot, for I knocked it down with a
stick, and having recovered it, I brought it home; but it was some years before
I could make him speak; however, at last I taught him to call me by name very
familiarly. But the accident that followed, though it be a trifle, will be very
diverting in its place.
I was exceedingly diverted with this journey. I found in the low grounds hares
(as I thought them to be) and foxes; but they differed greatly from all the
other kinds I had met with, nor could I satisfy myself to eat them, though I
killed several. But I had no need to be venturous, for I had no want of food,
and of that which was very good too, especially these three sorts, viz. goats,
pigeons, and turtle, or tortoise, which added to my grapes, Leadenhall market
could not have furnished a table better than I, in proportion to the company;
and though my case was deplorable enough, yet I had great cause for
thankfulness that I was not driven to any extremities for food, but had rather
plenty, even to dainties.
I never travelled in this journey above two miles outright in a day, or
thereabouts; but I took so many turns and re-turns to see what discoveries I
could make, that I came weary enough to the place where I resolved to sit down
all night; and then I either reposed myself in a tree, or surrounded myself
with a row of stakes set upright in the ground, either from one tree to
another, or so as no wild creature could come at me without waking me.
As soon as I came to the sea-shore, I was surprised to see that I had taken up
my lot on the worst side of the island, for here, indeed, the shore was covered
with innumerable turtles, whereas on the other side I had found but three in a
year and a half. Here was also an infinite number of fowls of many kinds, some
which I had seen, and some which I had not seen before, and many of them very
good meat, but such as I knew not the names of, except those called penguins.
I could have shot as many as I pleased, but was very sparing of my powder and
shot, and therefore had more mind to kill a she-goat if I could, which I could
better feed on; and though there were many goats here, more than on my side the
island, yet it was with much more difficulty that I could come near them, the
country being flat and even, and they saw me much sooner than when I was on the
hills.
I confess this side of the country was much pleasanter than mine; but yet I had
not the least inclination to remove, for as I was fixed in my habitation it
became natural to me, and I seemed all the while I was here to be as it were
upon a journey, and from home. However, I travelled along the shore of the sea
towards the east, I suppose about twelve miles, and then setting up a great
pole upon the shore for a mark, I concluded I would go home again, and that the
next journey I took should be on the other side of the island east from my
dwelling, and so round till I came to my post again.
I took another way to come back than that I went, thinking I could easily keep
all the island so much in my view that I could not miss finding my first
dwelling by viewing the country; but I found myself mistaken, for being come
about two or three miles, I found myself descended into a very large valley,
but so surrounded with hills, and those hills covered with wood, that I could
not see which was my way by any direction but that of the sun, nor even then,
unless I knew very well the position of the sun at that time of the day. It
happened, to my further misfortune, that the weather proved hazy for three or
four days while I was in the valley, and not being able to see the sun, I
wandered about very uncomfortably, and at last was obliged to find the seaside,
look for my post, and come back the same way I went: and then, by easy
journeys, I turned homeward, the weather being exceeding hot, and my gun,
ammunition, hatchet, and other things very heavy.
In this journey my dog surprised a young kid, and seized upon it; and I,
running in to take hold of it, caught it, and saved it alive from the dog. I
had a great mind to bring it home if I could, for I had often been musing
whether it might not be possible to get a kid or two, and so raise a breed of
tame goats, which might supply me when my powder and shot should be all spent.
I made a collar for this little creature, and with a string, which I made of
some rope-yarn, which I always carried about me, I led him along, though with
some difficulty, till I came to my bower, and there I enclosed him and left
him, for I was very impatient to be at home, from whence I had been absent
above a month.
I cannot express what a satisfaction it was to me to come into my old hutch,
and lie down in my hammock-bed. This little wandering journey, without settled
place of abode, had been so unpleasant to me, that my own house, as I called it
to myself, was a perfect settlement to me compared to that; and it rendered
everything about me so comfortable, that I resolved I would never go a great
way from it again while it should be my lot to stay on the island.
I reposed myself here a week, to rest and regale myself after my long journey;
during which most of the time was taken up in the weighty affair of making a
cage for my Poll, who began now to be a mere domestic, and to be well
acquainted with me. Then I began to think of the poor kid which I had penned in
within my little circle, and resolved to go and fetch it home, or give it some
food; accordingly I went, and found it where I left it, for indeed it could not
get out, but was almost starved for want of food. I went and cut boughs of
trees, and branches of such shrubs as I could find, and threw it over, and
having fed it, I tied it as I did before, to lead it away; but it was so tame
with being hungry, that I had no need to have tied it, for it followed me like
a dog: and as I continually fed it, the creature became so loving, so gentle,
and so fond, that it became from that time one of my domestics also, and would
never leave me afterwards.
The rainy season of the autumnal equinox was now come, and I kept the 30th of
September in the same solemn manner as before, being the anniversary of my
landing on the island, having now been there two years, and no more prospect of
being delivered than the first day I came there, I spent the whole day in
humble and thankful acknowledgments of the many wonderful mercies which my
solitary condition was attended with, and without which it might have been
infinitely more miserable. I gave humble and hearty thanks that God had been
pleased to discover to me that it was possible I might be more happy in this
solitary condition than I should have been in the liberty of society, and in
all the pleasures of the world; that He could fully make up to me the
deficiencies of my solitary state, and the want of human society, by His
presence and the communications of His grace to my soul; supporting,
comforting, and encouraging me to depend upon His providence here, and hope for
His eternal presence hereafter.
It was now that I began sensibly to feel how much more happy this life I now
led was, with all its miserable circumstances, than the wicked, cursed,
abominable life I led all the past part of my days; and now I changed both my
sorrows and my joys; my very desires altered, my affections changed their
gusts, and my delights were perfectly new from what they were at my first
coming, or, indeed, for the two years past.
Before, as I walked about, either on my hunting or for viewing the country, the
anguish of my soul at my condition would break out upon me on a sudden, and my
very heart would die within me, to think of the woods, the mountains, the
deserts I was in, and how I was a prisoner, locked up with the eternal bars and
bolts of the ocean, in an uninhabited wilderness, without redemption. In the
midst of the greatest composure of my mind, this would break out upon me like a
storm, and make me wring my hands and weep like a child. Sometimes it would
take me in the middle of my work, and I would immediately sit down and sigh,
and look upon the ground for an hour or two together; and this was still worse
to me, for if I could burst out into tears, or vent myself by words, it would
go off, and the grief, having exhausted itself, would abate.
But now I began to exercise myself with new thoughts: I daily read the word of
God, and applied all the comforts of it to my present state. One morning, being
very sad, I opened the Bible upon these words, “I will never, never leave
thee, nor forsake thee.” Immediately it occurred that these words were to
me; why else should they be directed in such a manner, just at the moment when
I was mourning over my condition, as one forsaken of God and man? “Well,
then,” said I, “if God does not forsake me, of what ill consequence
can it be, or what matters it, though the world should all forsake me, seeing
on the other hand, if I had all the world, and should lose the favour and
blessing of God, there would be no comparison in the loss?”
From this moment I began to conclude in my mind that it was possible for me to
be more happy in this forsaken, solitary condition than it was probable I
should ever have been in any other particular state in the world; and with this
thought I was going to give thanks to God for bringing me to this place. I know
not what it was, but something shocked my mind at that thought, and I durst not
speak the words. “How canst thou become such a hypocrite,” said I,
even audibly, “to pretend to be thankful for a condition which, however
thou mayest endeavour to be contented with, thou wouldst rather pray heartily
to be delivered from?” So I stopped there; but though I could not say I
thanked God for being there, yet I sincerely gave thanks to God for opening my
eyes, by whatever afflicting providences, to see the former condition of my
life, and to mourn for my wickedness, and repent. I never opened the Bible, or
shut it, but my very soul within me blessed God for directing my friend in
England, without any order of mine, to pack it up among my goods, and for
assisting me afterwards to save it out of the wreck of the ship.
Thus, and in this disposition of mind, I began my third year; and though I have
not given the reader the trouble of so particular an account of my works this
year as the first, yet in general it may be observed that I was very seldom
idle, but having regularly divided my time according to the several daily
employments that were before me, such as: first, my duty to God, and the
reading the Scriptures, which I constantly set apart some time for thrice every
day; secondly, the going abroad with my gun for food, which generally took me
up three hours in every morning, when it did not rain; thirdly, the ordering,
cutting, preserving, and cooking what I had killed or caught for my supply;
these took up great part of the day. Also, it is to be considered, that in the
middle of the day, when the sun was in the zenith, the violence of the heat was
too great to stir out; so that about four hours in the evening was all the time
I could be supposed to work in, with this exception, that sometimes I changed
my hours of hunting and working, and went to work in the morning, and abroad
with my gun in the afternoon.
To this short time allowed for labour I desire may be added the exceeding
laboriousness of my work; the many hours which, for want of tools, want of
help, and want of skill, everything I did took up out of my time. For example,
I was full two and forty days in making a board for a long shelf, which I
wanted in my cave; whereas, two sawyers, with their tools and a saw-pit, would
have cut six of them out of the same tree in half a day.
My case was this: it was to be a large tree which was to be cut down, because
my board was to be a broad one. This tree I was three days in cutting down, and
two more cutting off the boughs, and reducing it to a log or piece of timber.
With inexpressible hacking and hewing I reduced both the sides of it into chips
till it began to be light enough to move; then I turned it, and made one side
of it smooth and flat as a board from end to end; then, turning that side
downward, cut the other side til I brought the plank to be about three inches
thick, and smooth on both sides. Any one may judge the labour of my hands in
such a piece of work; but labour and patience carried me through that, and many
other things. I only observe this in particular, to show the reason why so much
of my time went away with so little work—viz. that what might be a little
to be done with help and tools, was a vast labour and required a prodigious
time to do alone, and by hand. But notwithstanding this, with patience and
labour I got through everything that my circumstances made necessary to me to
do, as will appear by what follows.
I was now, in the months of November and December, expecting my crop of barley
and rice. The ground I had manured and dug up for them was not great; for, as I
observed, my seed of each was not above the quantity of half a peck, for I had
lost one whole crop by sowing in the dry season. But now my crop promised very
well, when on a sudden I found I was in danger of losing it all again by
enemies of several sorts, which it was scarcely possible to keep from it; as,
first, the goats, and wild creatures which I called hares, who, tasting the
sweetness of the blade, lay in it night and day, as soon as it came up, and eat
it so close, that it could get no time to shoot up into stalk.
This I saw no remedy for but by making an enclosure about it with a hedge;
which I did with a great deal of toil, and the more, because it required speed.
However, as my arable land was but small, suited to my crop, I got it totally
well fenced in about three weeks’ time; and shooting some of the
creatures in the daytime, I set my dog to guard it in the night, tying him up
to a stake at the gate, where he would stand and bark all night long; so in a
little time the enemies forsook the place, and the corn grew very strong and
well, and began to ripen apace.
But as the beasts ruined me before, while my corn was in the blade, so the
birds were as likely to ruin me now, when it was in the ear; for, going along
by the place to see how it throve, I saw my little crop surrounded with fowls,
of I know not how many sorts, who stood, as it were, watching till I should be
gone. I immediately let fly among them, for I always had my gun with me. I had
no sooner shot, but there rose up a little cloud of fowls, which I had not seen
at all, from among the corn itself.
This touched me sensibly, for I foresaw that in a few days they would devour
all my hopes; that I should be starved, and never be able to raise a crop at
all; and what to do I could not tell; however, I resolved not to lose my corn,
if possible, though I should watch it night and day. In the first place, I went
among it to see what damage was already done, and found they had spoiled a good
deal of it; but that as it was yet too green for them, the loss was not so
great but that the remainder was likely to be a good crop if it could be saved.
I stayed by it to load my gun, and then coming away, I could easily see the
thieves sitting upon all the trees about me, as if they only waited till I was
gone away, and the event proved it to be so; for as I walked off, as if I was
gone, I was no sooner out of their sight than they dropped down one by one into
the corn again. I was so provoked, that I could not have patience to stay till
more came on, knowing that every grain that they ate now was, as it might be
said, a peck-loaf to me in the consequence; but coming up to the hedge, I fired
again, and killed three of them. This was what I wished for; so I took them up,
and served them as we serve notorious thieves in England—hanged them in
chains, for a terror to others. It is impossible to imagine that this should
have such an effect as it had, for the fowls would not only not come at the
corn, but, in short, they forsook all that part of the island, and I could
never see a bird near the place as long as my scarecrows hung there. This I was
very glad of, you may be sure, and about the latter end of December, which was
our second harvest of the year, I reaped my corn.
I was sadly put to it for a scythe or sickle to cut it down, and all I could do
was to make one, as well as I could, out of one of the broadswords, or
cutlasses, which I saved among the arms out of the ship. However, as my first
crop was but small, I had no great difficulty to cut it down; in short, I
reaped it in my way, for I cut nothing off but the ears, and carried it away in
a great basket which I had made, and so rubbed it out with my hands; and at the
end of all my harvesting, I found that out of my half-peck of seed I had near
two bushels of rice, and about two bushels and a half of barley; that is to
say, by my guess, for I had no measure at that time.
However, this was a great encouragement to me, and I foresaw that, in time, it
would please God to supply me with bread. And yet here I was perplexed again,
for I neither knew how to grind or make meal of my corn, or indeed how to clean
it and part it; nor, if made into meal, how to make bread of it; and if how to
make it, yet I knew not how to bake it. These things being added to my desire
of having a good quantity for store, and to secure a constant supply, I
resolved not to taste any of this crop but to preserve it all for seed against
the next season; and in the meantime to employ all my study and hours of
working to accomplish this great work of providing myself with corn and bread.
It might be truly said, that now I worked for my bread. I believe few people
have thought much upon the strange multitude of little things necessary in the
providing, producing, curing, dressing, making, and finishing this one article
of bread.
I, that was reduced to a mere state of nature, found this to my daily
discouragement; and was made more sensible of it every hour, even after I had
got the first handful of seed-corn, which, as I have said, came up
unexpectedly, and indeed to a surprise.
First, I had no plough to turn up the earth—no spade or shovel to dig it.
Well, this I conquered by making me a wooden spade, as I observed before; but
this did my work but in a wooden manner; and though it cost me a great many
days to make it, yet, for want of iron, it not only wore out soon, but made my
work the harder, and made it be performed much worse. However, this I bore
with, and was content to work it out with patience, and bear with the badness
of the performance. When the corn was sown, I had no harrow, but was forced to
go over it myself, and drag a great heavy bough of a tree over it, to scratch
it, as it may be called, rather than rake or harrow it. When it was growing,
and grown, I have observed already how many things I wanted to fence it, secure
it, mow or reap it, cure and carry it home, thrash, part it from the chaff, and
save it. Then I wanted a mill to grind it, sieves to dress it, yeast and salt
to make it into bread, and an oven to bake it; but all these things I did
without, as shall be observed; and yet the corn was an inestimable comfort and
advantage to me too. All this, as I said, made everything laborious and tedious
to me; but that there was no help for. Neither was my time so much loss to me,
because, as I had divided it, a certain part of it was every day appointed to
these works; and as I had resolved to use none of the corn for bread till I had
a greater quantity by me, I had the next six months to apply myself wholly, by
labour and invention, to furnish myself with utensils proper for the performing
all the operations necessary for making the corn, when I had it, fit for my
use.
CHAPTER IX.
A BOAT
But first I was to prepare more land, for I had now seed enough to sow above an
acre of ground. Before I did this, I had a week’s work at least to make
me a spade, which, when it was done, was but a sorry one indeed, and very
heavy, and required double labour to work with it. However, I got through that,
and sowed my seed in two large flat pieces of ground, as near my house as I
could find them to my mind, and fenced them in with a good hedge, the stakes of
which were all cut off that wood which I had set before, and knew it would
grow; so that, in a year’s time, I knew I should have a quick or living
hedge, that would want but little repair. This work did not take me up less
than three months, because a great part of that time was the wet season, when I
could not go abroad. Within-doors, that is when it rained and I could not go
out, I found employment in the following occupations—always observing,
that all the while I was at work I diverted myself with talking to my parrot,
and teaching him to speak; and I quickly taught him to know his own name, and
at last to speak it out pretty loud, “Poll,” which was the first
word I ever heard spoken in the island by any mouth but my own. This,
therefore, was not my work, but an assistance to my work; for now, as I said, I
had a great employment upon my hands, as follows: I had long studied to make,
by some means or other, some earthen vessels, which, indeed, I wanted sorely,
but knew not where to come at them. However, considering the heat of the
climate, I did not doubt but if I could find out any clay, I might make some
pots that might, being dried in the sun, be hard enough and strong enough to
bear handling, and to hold anything that was dry, and required to be kept so;
and as this was necessary in the preparing corn, meal, &c., which was the
thing I was doing, I resolved to make some as large as I could, and fit only to
stand like jars, to hold what should be put into them.
It would make the reader pity me, or rather laugh at me, to tell how many
awkward ways I took to raise this paste; what odd, misshapen, ugly things I
made; how many of them fell in and how many fell out, the clay not being stiff
enough to bear its own weight; how many cracked by the over-violent heat of the
sun, being set out too hastily; and how many fell in pieces with only removing,
as well before as after they were dried; and, in a word, how, after having
laboured hard to find the clay—to dig it, to temper it, to bring it home,
and work it—I could not make above two large earthen ugly things (I
cannot call them jars) in about two months’ labour.
However, as the sun baked these two very dry and hard, I lifted them very
gently up, and set them down again in two great wicker baskets, which I had
made on purpose for them, that they might not break; and as between the pot and
the basket there was a little room to spare, I stuffed it full of the rice and
barley straw; and these two pots being to stand always dry I thought would hold
my dry corn, and perhaps the meal, when the corn was bruised.
Though I miscarried so much in my design for large pots, yet I made several
smaller things with better success; such as little round pots, flat dishes,
pitchers, and pipkins, and any things my hand turned to; and the heat of the
sun baked them quite hard.
But all this would not answer my end, which was to get an earthen pot to hold
what was liquid, and bear the fire, which none of these could do. It happened
after some time, making a pretty large fire for cooking my meat, when I went to
put it out after I had done with it, I found a broken piece of one of my
earthenware vessels in the fire, burnt as hard as a stone, and red as a tile. I
was agreeably surprised to see it, and said to myself, that certainly they
might be made to burn whole, if they would burn broken.
This set me to study how to order my fire, so as to make it burn some pots. I
had no notion of a kiln, such as the potters burn in, or of glazing them with
lead, though I had some lead to do it with; but I placed three large pipkins
and two or three pots in a pile, one upon another, and placed my firewood all
round it, with a great heap of embers under them. I plied the fire with fresh
fuel round the outside and upon the top, till I saw the pots in the inside
red-hot quite through, and observed that they did not crack at all. When I saw
them clear red, I let them stand in that heat about five or six hours, till I
found one of them, though it did not crack, did melt or run; for the sand which
was mixed with the clay melted by the violence of the heat, and would have run
into glass if I had gone on; so I slacked my fire gradually till the pots began
to abate of the red colour; and watching them all night, that I might not let
the fire abate too fast, in the morning I had three very good (I will not say
handsome) pipkins, and two other earthen pots, as hard burnt as could be
desired, and one of them perfectly glazed with the running of the sand.
After this experiment, I need not say that I wanted no sort of earthenware for
my use; but I must needs say as to the shapes of them, they were very
indifferent, as any one may suppose, when I had no way of making them but as
the children make dirt pies, or as a woman would make pies that never learned
to raise paste.
No joy at a thing of so mean a nature was ever equal to mine, when I found I
had made an earthen pot that would bear the fire; and I had hardly patience to
stay till they were cold before I set one on the fire again with some water in
it to boil me some meat, which it did admirably well; and with a piece of a kid
I made some very good broth, though I wanted oatmeal, and several other
ingredients requisite to make it as good as I would have had it been.
My next concern was to get me a stone mortar to stamp or beat some corn in; for
as to the mill, there was no thought of arriving at that perfection of art with
one pair of hands. To supply this want, I was at a great loss; for, of all the
trades in the world, I was as perfectly unqualified for a stone-cutter as for
any whatever; neither had I any tools to go about it with. I spent many a day
to find out a great stone big enough to cut hollow, and make fit for a mortar,
and could find none at all, except what was in the solid rock, and which I had
no way to dig or cut out; nor indeed were the rocks in the island of hardness
sufficient, but were all of a sandy, crumbling stone, which neither would bear
the weight of a heavy pestle, nor would break the corn without filling it with
sand. So, after a great deal of time lost in searching for a stone, I gave it
over, and resolved to look out for a great block of hard wood, which I found,
indeed, much easier; and getting one as big as I had strength to stir, I
rounded it, and formed it on the outside with my axe and hatchet, and then with
the help of fire and infinite labour, made a hollow place in it, as the Indians
in Brazil make their canoes. After this, I made a great heavy pestle or beater
of the wood called the iron-wood; and this I prepared and laid by against I had
my next crop of corn, which I proposed to myself to grind, or rather pound into
meal to make bread.
My next difficulty was to make a sieve or searce, to dress my meal, and to part
it from the bran and the husk; without which I did not see it possible I could
have any bread. This was a most difficult thing even to think on, for to be
sure I had nothing like the necessary thing to make it—I mean fine thin
canvas or stuff to searce the meal through. And here I was at a full stop for
many months; nor did I really know what to do. Linen I had none left but what
was mere rags; I had goat’s hair, but neither knew how to weave it or
spin it; and had I known how, here were no tools to work it with. All the
remedy that I found for this was, that at last I did remember I had, among the
seamen’s clothes which were saved out of the ship, some neckcloths of
calico or muslin; and with some pieces of these I made three small sieves
proper enough for the work; and thus I made shift for some years: how I did
afterwards, I shall show in its place.
The baking part was the next thing to be considered, and how I should make
bread when I came to have corn; for first, I had no yeast. As to that part,
there was no supplying the want, so I did not concern myself much about it. But
for an oven I was indeed in great pain. At length I found out an experiment for
that also, which was this: I made some earthen-vessels very broad but not deep,
that is to say, about two feet diameter, and not above nine inches deep. These
I burned in the fire, as I had done the other, and laid them by; and when I
wanted to bake, I made a great fire upon my hearth, which I had paved with some
square tiles of my own baking and burning also; but I should not call them
square.
When the firewood was burned pretty much into embers or live coals, I drew them
forward upon this hearth, so as to cover it all over, and there I let them lie
till the hearth was very hot. Then sweeping away all the embers, I set down my
loaf or loaves, and whelming down the earthen pot upon them, drew the embers
all round the outside of the pot, to keep in and add to the heat; and thus as
well as in the best oven in the world, I baked my barley-loaves, and became in
little time a good pastrycook into the bargain; for I made myself several cakes
and puddings of the rice; but I made no pies, neither had I anything to put
into them supposing I had, except the flesh either of fowls or goats.
It need not be wondered at if all these things took me up most part of the
third year of my abode here; for it is to be observed that in the intervals of
these things I had my new harvest and husbandry to manage; for I reaped my corn
in its season, and carried it home as well as I could, and laid it up in the
ear, in my large baskets, till I had time to rub it out, for I had no floor to
thrash it on, or instrument to thrash it with.
And now, indeed, my stock of corn increasing, I really wanted to build my barns
bigger; I wanted a place to lay it up in, for the increase of the corn now
yielded me so much, that I had of the barley about twenty bushels, and of the
rice as much or more; insomuch that now I resolved to begin to use it freely;
for my bread had been quite gone a great while; also I resolved to see what
quantity would be sufficient for me a whole year, and to sow but once a year.
Upon the whole, I found that the forty bushels of barley and rice were much
more than I could consume in a year; so I resolved to sow just the same
quantity every year that I sowed the last, in hopes that such a quantity would
fully provide me with bread, &c.
All the while these things were doing, you may be sure my thoughts ran many
times upon the prospect of land which I had seen from the other side of the
island; and I was not without secret wishes that I were on shore there,
fancying that, seeing the mainland, and an inhabited country, I might find some
way or other to convey myself further, and perhaps at last find some means of
escape.
But all this while I made no allowance for the dangers of such an undertaking,
and how I might fall into the hands of savages, and perhaps such as I might
have reason to think far worse than the lions and tigers of Africa: that if I
once came in their power, I should run a hazard of more than a thousand to one
of being killed, and perhaps of being eaten; for I had heard that the people of
the Caribbean coast were cannibals or man-eaters, and I knew by the latitude
that I could not be far from that shore. Then, supposing they were not
cannibals, yet they might kill me, as many Europeans who had fallen into their
hands had been served, even when they had been ten or twenty
together—much more I, that was but one, and could make little or no
defence; all these things, I say, which I ought to have considered well; and
did come into my thoughts afterwards, yet gave me no apprehensions at first,
and my head ran mightily upon the thought of getting over to the shore.
Now I wished for my boy Xury, and the long-boat with shoulder-of-mutton sail,
with which I sailed above a thousand miles on the coast of Africa; but this was
in vain: then I thought I would go and look at our ship’s boat, which, as
I have said, was blown up upon the shore a great way, in the storm, when we
were first cast away. She lay almost where she did at first, but not quite; and
was turned, by the force of the waves and the winds, almost bottom upward,
against a high ridge of beachy, rough sand, but no water about her. If I had
had hands to have refitted her, and to have launched her into the water, the
boat would have done well enough, and I might have gone back into the Brazils
with her easily enough; but I might have foreseen that I could no more turn her
and set her upright upon her bottom than I could remove the island; however, I
went to the woods, and cut levers and rollers, and brought them to the boat
resolving to try what I could do; suggesting to myself that if I could but turn
her down, I might repair the damage she had received, and she would be a very
good boat, and I might go to sea in her very easily.
I spared no pains, indeed, in this piece of fruitless toil, and spent, I think,
three or four weeks about it; at last finding it impossible to heave it up with
my little strength, I fell to digging away the sand, to undermine it, and so to
make it fall down, setting pieces of wood to thrust and guide it right in the
fall.
But when I had done this, I was unable to stir it up again, or to get under it,
much less to move it forward towards the water; so I was forced to give it
over; and yet, though I gave over the hopes of the boat, my desire to venture
over for the main increased, rather than decreased, as the means for it seemed
impossible.
This at length put me upon thinking whether it was not possible to make myself
a canoe, or periagua, such as the natives of those climates make, even without
tools, or, as I might say, without hands, of the trunk of a great tree. This I
not only thought possible, but easy, and pleased myself extremely with the
thoughts of making it, and with my having much more convenience for it than any
of the negroes or Indians; but not at all considering the particular
inconveniences which I lay under more than the Indians did—viz. want of
hands to move it, when it was made, into the water—a difficulty much
harder for me to surmount than all the consequences of want of tools could be
to them; for what was it to me, if when I had chosen a vast tree in the woods,
and with much trouble cut it down, if I had been able with my tools to hew and
dub the outside into the proper shape of a boat, and burn or cut out the inside
to make it hollow, so as to make a boat of it—if, after all this, I must
leave it just there where I found it, and not be able to launch it into the
water?
One would have thought I could not have had the least reflection upon my mind
of my circumstances while I was making this boat, but I should have immediately
thought how I should get it into the sea; but my thoughts were so intent upon
my voyage over the sea in it, that I never once considered how I should get it
off the land: and it was really, in its own nature, more easy for me to guide
it over forty-five miles of sea than about forty-five fathoms of land, where it
lay, to set it afloat in the water.
I went to work upon this boat the most like a fool that ever man did who had
any of his senses awake. I pleased myself with the design, without determining
whether I was ever able to undertake it; not but that the difficulty of
launching my boat came often into my head; but I put a stop to my inquiries
into it by this foolish answer which I gave myself—“Let me first
make it; I warrant I will find some way or other to get it along when it is
done.”
This was a most preposterous method; but the eagerness of my fancy prevailed,
and to work I went. I felled a cedar-tree, and I question much whether Solomon
ever had such a one for the building of the Temple of Jerusalem; it was five
feet ten inches diameter at the lower part next the stump, and four feet eleven
inches diameter at the end of twenty-two feet; after which it lessened for a
while, and then parted into branches. It was not without infinite labour that I
felled this tree; I was twenty days hacking and hewing at it at the bottom; I
was fourteen more getting the branches and limbs and the vast spreading head
cut off, which I hacked and hewed through with axe and hatchet, and
inexpressible labour; after this, it cost me a month to shape it and dub it to
a proportion, and to something like the bottom of a boat, that it might swim
upright as it ought to do. It cost me near three months more to clear the
inside, and work it out so as to make an exact boat of it; this I did, indeed,
without fire, by mere mallet and chisel, and by the dint of hard labour, till I
had brought it to be a very handsome periagua, and big enough to have carried
six-and-twenty men, and consequently big enough to have carried me and all my
cargo.
When I had gone through this work I was extremely delighted with it. The boat
was really much bigger than ever I saw a canoe or periagua, that was made of
one tree, in my life. Many a weary stroke it had cost, you may be sure; and had
I gotten it into the water, I make no question, but I should have begun the
maddest voyage, and the most unlikely to be performed, that ever was
undertaken.
But all my devices to get it into the water failed me; though they cost me
infinite labour too. It lay about one hundred yards from the water, and not
more; but the first inconvenience was, it was up hill towards the creek. Well,
to take away this discouragement, I resolved to dig into the surface of the
earth, and so make a declivity: this I began, and it cost me a prodigious deal
of pains (but who grudge pains who have their deliverance in view?); but when
this was worked through, and this difficulty managed, it was still much the
same, for I could no more stir the canoe than I could the other boat. Then I
measured the distance of ground, and resolved to cut a dock or canal, to bring
the water up to the canoe, seeing I could not bring the canoe down to the
water. Well, I began this work; and when I began to enter upon it, and
calculate how deep it was to be dug, how broad, how the stuff was to be thrown
out, I found that, by the number of hands I had, being none but my own, it must
have been ten or twelve years before I could have gone through with it; for the
shore lay so high, that at the upper end it must have been at least twenty feet
deep; so at length, though with great reluctancy, I gave this attempt over
also.
This grieved me heartily; and now I saw, though too late, the folly of
beginning a work before we count the cost, and before we judge rightly of our
own strength to go through with it.
In the middle of this work I finished my fourth year in this place, and kept my
anniversary with the same devotion, and with as much comfort as ever before;
for, by a constant study and serious application to the Word of God, and by the
assistance of His grace, I gained a different knowledge from what I had before.
I entertained different notions of things. I looked now upon the world as a
thing remote, which I had nothing to do with, no expectations from, and,
indeed, no desires about: in a word, I had nothing indeed to do with it, nor
was ever likely to have, so I thought it looked, as we may perhaps look upon it
hereafter—viz. as a place I had lived in, but was come out of it; and
well might I say, as Father Abraham to Dives, “Between me and thee is a
great gulf fixed.”
In the first place, I was removed from all the wickedness of the world here; I
had neither the lusts of the flesh, the lusts of the eye, nor the pride of
life. I had nothing to covet, for I had all that I was now capable of enjoying;
I was lord of the whole manor; or, if I pleased, I might call myself king or
emperor over the whole country which I had possession of: there were no rivals;
I had no competitor, none to dispute sovereignty or command with me: I might
have raised ship-loadings of corn, but I had no use for it; so I let as little
grow as I thought enough for my occasion. I had tortoise or turtle enough, but
now and then one was as much as I could put to any use: I had timber enough to
have built a fleet of ships; and I had grapes enough to have made wine, or to
have cured into raisins, to have loaded that fleet when it had been built.
But all I could make use of was all that was valuable: I had enough to eat and
supply my wants, and what was all the rest to me? If I killed more flesh than I
could eat, the dog must eat it, or vermin; if I sowed more corn than I could
eat, it must be spoiled; the trees that I cut down were lying to rot on the
ground; I could make no more use of them but for fuel, and that I had no
occasion for but to dress my food.
In a word, the nature and experience of things dictated to me, upon just
reflection, that all the good things of this world are no farther good to us
than they are for our use; and that, whatever we may heap up to give others, we
enjoy just as much as we can use, and no more. The most covetous, griping miser
in the world would have been cured of the vice of covetousness if he had been
in my case; for I possessed infinitely more than I knew what to do with. I had
no room for desire, except it was of things which I had not, and they were but
trifles, though, indeed, of great use to me. I had, as I hinted before, a
parcel of money, as well gold as silver, about thirty-six pounds sterling.
Alas! there the sorry, useless stuff lay; I had no more manner of business for
it; and often thought with myself that I would have given a handful of it for a
gross of tobacco-pipes; or for a hand-mill to grind my corn; nay, I would have
given it all for a sixpenny-worth of turnip and carrot seed out of England, or
for a handful of peas and beans, and a bottle of ink. As it was, I had not the
least advantage by it or benefit from it; but there it lay in a drawer, and
grew mouldy with the damp of the cave in the wet seasons; and if I had had the
drawer full of diamonds, it had been the same case—they had been of no
manner of value to me, because of no use.
I had now brought my state of life to be much easier in itself than it was at
first, and much easier to my mind, as well as to my body. I frequently sat down
to meat with thankfulness, and admired the hand of God’s providence,
which had thus spread my table in the wilderness. I learned to look more upon
the bright side of my condition, and less upon the dark side, and to consider
what I enjoyed rather than what I wanted; and this gave me sometimes such
secret comforts, that I cannot express them; and which I take notice of here,
to put those discontented people in mind of it, who cannot enjoy comfortably
what God has given them, because they see and covet something that He has not
given them. All our discontents about what we want appeared to me to spring
from the want of thankfulness for what we have.
Another reflection was of great use to me, and doubtless would be so to any one
that should fall into such distress as mine was; and this was, to compare my
present condition with what I at first expected it would be; nay, with what it
would certainly have been, if the good providence of God had not wonderfully
ordered the ship to be cast up nearer to the shore, where I not only could come
at her, but could bring what I got out of her to the shore, for my relief and
comfort; without which, I had wanted for tools to work, weapons for defence,
and gunpowder and shot for getting my food.
I spent whole hours, I may say whole days, in representing to myself, in the
most lively colours, how I must have acted if I had got nothing out of the
ship. How I could not have so much as got any food, except fish and turtles;
and that, as it was long before I found any of them, I must have perished
first; that I should have lived, if I had not perished, like a mere savage;
that if I had killed a goat or a fowl, by any contrivance, I had no way to flay
or open it, or part the flesh from the skin and the bowels, or to cut it up;
but must gnaw it with my teeth, and pull it with my claws, like a beast.
These reflections made me very sensible of the goodness of Providence to me,
and very thankful for my present condition, with all its hardships and
misfortunes; and this part also I cannot but recommend to the reflection of
those who are apt, in their misery, to say, “Is any affliction like
mine?” Let them consider how much worse the cases of some people are, and
their case might have been, if Providence had thought fit.
I had another reflection, which assisted me also to comfort my mind with hopes;
and this was comparing my present situation with what I had deserved, and had
therefore reason to expect from the hand of Providence. I had lived a dreadful
life, perfectly destitute of the knowledge and fear of God. I had been well
instructed by father and mother; neither had they been wanting to me in their
early endeavours to infuse a religious awe of God into my mind, a sense of my
duty, and what the nature and end of my being required of me. But, alas!
falling early into the seafaring life, which of all lives is the most destitute
of the fear of God, though His terrors are always before them; I say, falling
early into the seafaring life, and into seafaring company, all that little
sense of religion which I had entertained was laughed out of me by my
messmates; by a hardened despising of dangers, and the views of death, which
grew habitual to me by my long absence from all manner of opportunities to
converse with anything but what was like myself, or to hear anything that was
good or tended towards it.
So void was I of everything that was good, or the least sense of what I was, or
was to be, that, in the greatest deliverances I enjoyed—such as my escape
from Sallee; my being taken up by the Portuguese master of the ship; my being
planted so well in the Brazils; my receiving the cargo from England, and the
like—I never had once the words “Thank God!” so much as on my
mind, or in my mouth; nor in the greatest distress had I so much as a thought
to pray to Him, or so much as to say, “Lord, have mercy upon me!”
no, nor to mention the name of God, unless it was to swear by, and blaspheme
it.
I had terrible reflections upon my mind for many months, as I have already
observed, on account of my wicked and hardened life past; and when I looked
about me, and considered what particular providences had attended me since my
coming into this place, and how God had dealt bountifully with me—had not
only punished me less than my iniquity had deserved, but had so plentifully
provided for me—this gave me great hopes that my repentance was accepted,
and that God had yet mercy in store for me.
With these reflections I worked my mind up, not only to a resignation to the
will of God in the present disposition of my circumstances, but even to a
sincere thankfulness for my condition; and that I, who was yet a living man,
ought not to complain, seeing I had not the due punishment of my sins; that I
enjoyed so many mercies which I had no reason to have expected in that place;
that I ought never more to repine at my condition, but to rejoice, and to give
daily thanks for that daily bread, which nothing but a crowd of wonders could
have brought; that I ought to consider I had been fed even by a miracle, even
as great as that of feeding Elijah by ravens, nay, by a long series of
miracles; and that I could hardly have named a place in the uninhabitable part
of the world where I could have been cast more to my advantage; a place where,
as I had no society, which was my affliction on one hand, so I found no
ravenous beasts, no furious wolves or tigers, to threaten my life; no venomous
creatures, or poisons, which I might feed on to my hurt; no savages to murder
and devour me. In a word, as my life was a life of sorrow one way, so it was a
life of mercy another; and I wanted nothing to make it a life of comfort but to
be able to make my sense of God’s goodness to me, and care over me in
this condition, be my daily consolation; and after I did make a just
improvement on these things, I went away, and was no more sad. I had now been
here so long that many things which I had brought on shore for my help were
either quite gone, or very much wasted and near spent.
My ink, as I observed, had been gone some time, all but a very little, which I
eked out with water, a little and a little, till it was so pale, it scarce left
any appearance of black upon the paper. As long as it lasted I made use of it
to minute down the days of the month on which any remarkable thing happened to
me; and first, by casting up times past, I remembered that there was a strange
concurrence of days in the various providences which befell me, and which, if I
had been superstitiously inclined to observe days as fatal or fortunate, I
might have had reason to have looked upon with a great deal of curiosity.
First, I had observed that the same day that I broke away from my father and
friends and ran away to Hull, in order to go to sea, the same day afterwards I
was taken by the Sallee man-of-war, and made a slave; the same day of the year
that I escaped out of the wreck of that ship in Yarmouth Roads, that same
day-year afterwards I made my escape from Sallee in a boat; the same day of the
year I was born on—viz. the 30th of September, that same day I had my
life so miraculously saved twenty-six years after, when I was cast on shore in
this island; so that my wicked life and my solitary life began both on a day.
The next thing to my ink being wasted was that of my bread—I mean the
biscuit which I brought out of the ship; this I had husbanded to the last
degree, allowing myself but one cake of bread a-day for above a year; and yet I
was quite without bread for near a year before I got any corn of my own, and
great reason I had to be thankful that I had any at all, the getting it being,
as has been already observed, next to miraculous.
My clothes, too, began to decay; as to linen, I had had none a good while,
except some chequered shirts which I found in the chests of the other seamen,
and which I carefully preserved; because many times I could bear no other
clothes on but a shirt; and it was a very great help to me that I had, among
all the men’s clothes of the ship, almost three dozen of shirts. There
were also, indeed, several thick watch-coats of the seamen’s which were
left, but they were too hot to wear; and though it is true that the weather was
so violently hot that there was no need of clothes, yet I could not go quite
naked—no, though I had been inclined to it, which I was not—nor
could I abide the thought of it, though I was alone. The reason why I could not
go naked was, I could not bear the heat of the sun so well when quite naked as
with some clothes on; nay, the very heat frequently blistered my skin: whereas,
with a shirt on, the air itself made some motion, and whistling under the
shirt, was twofold cooler than without it. No more could I ever bring myself to
go out in the heat of the sun without a cap or a hat; the heat of the sun,
beating with such violence as it does in that place, would give me the headache
presently, by darting so directly on my head, without a cap or hat on, so that
I could not bear it; whereas, if I put on my hat it would presently go away.
Upon these views I began to consider about putting the few rags I had, which I
called clothes, into some order; I had worn out all the waistcoats I had, and
my business was now to try if I could not make jackets out of the great
watch-coats which I had by me, and with such other materials as I had; so I set
to work, tailoring, or rather, indeed, botching, for I made most piteous work
of it. However, I made shift to make two or three new waistcoats, which I hoped
would serve me a great while: as for breeches or drawers, I made but a very
sorry shift indeed till afterwards.
I have mentioned that I saved the skins of all the creatures that I killed, I
mean four-footed ones, and I had them hung up, stretched out with sticks in the
sun, by which means some of them were so dry and hard that they were fit for
little, but others were very useful. The first thing I made of these was a
great cap for my head, with the hair on the outside, to shoot off the rain; and
this I performed so well, that after I made me a suit of clothes wholly of
these skins—that is to say, a waistcoat, and breeches open at the knees,
and both loose, for they were rather wanting to keep me cool than to keep me
warm. I must not omit to acknowledge that they were wretchedly made; for if I
was a bad carpenter, I was a worse tailor. However, they were such as I made
very good shift with, and when I was out, if it happened to rain, the hair of
my waistcoat and cap being outermost, I was kept very dry.
After this, I spent a great deal of time and pains to make an umbrella; I was,
indeed, in great want of one, and had a great mind to make one; I had seen them
made in the Brazils, where they are very useful in the great heats there, and I
felt the heats every jot as great here, and greater too, being nearer the
equinox; besides, as I was obliged to be much abroad, it was a most useful
thing to me, as well for the rains as the heats. I took a world of pains with
it, and was a great while before I could make anything likely to hold: nay,
after I had thought I had hit the way, I spoiled two or three before I made one
to my mind: but at last I made one that answered indifferently well: the main
difficulty I found was to make it let down. I could make it spread, but if it
did not let down too, and draw in, it was not portable for me any way but just
over my head, which would not do. However, at last, as I said, I made one to
answer, and covered it with skins, the hair upwards, so that it cast off the
rain like a pent-house, and kept off the sun so effectually, that I could walk
out in the hottest of the weather with greater advantage than I could before in
the coolest, and when I had no need of it could close it, and carry it under my
arm.
Thus I lived mighty comfortably, my mind being entirely composed by resigning
myself to the will of God, and throwing myself wholly upon the disposal of His
providence. This made my life better than sociable, for when I began to regret
the want of conversation I would ask myself, whether thus conversing mutually
with my own thoughts, and (as I hope I may say) with even God Himself, by
ejaculations, was not better than the utmost enjoyment of human society in the
world?
CHAPTER X.
TAMES GOATS
I cannot say that after this, for five years, any extraordinary thing happened
to me, but I lived on in the same course, in the same posture and place, as
before; the chief things I was employed in, besides my yearly labour of
planting my barley and rice, and curing my raisins, of both which I always kept
up just enough to have sufficient stock of one year’s provisions
beforehand; I say, besides this yearly labour, and my daily pursuit of going
out with my gun, I had one labour, to make a canoe, which at last I finished:
so that, by digging a canal to it of six feet wide and four feet deep, I
brought it into the creek, almost half a mile. As for the first, which was so
vastly big, for I made it without considering beforehand, as I ought to have
done, how I should be able to launch it, so, never being able to bring it into
the water, or bring the water to it, I was obliged to let it lie where it was
as a memorandum to teach me to be wiser the next time: indeed, the next time,
though I could not get a tree proper for it, and was in a place where I could
not get the water to it at any less distance than, as I have said, near half a
mile, yet, as I saw it was practicable at last, I never gave it over; and
though I was near two years about it, yet I never grudged my labour, in hopes
of having a boat to go off to sea at last.
However, though my little periagua was finished, yet the size of it was not at
all answerable to the design which I had in view when I made the first; I mean
of venturing over to the , where it was above forty miles
broad; accordingly, the smallness of my boat assisted to put an end to that
design, and now I thought no more of it. As I had a boat, my next design was to
make a cruise round the island; for as I had been on the other side in one
place, crossing, as I have already described it, over the land, so the
discoveries I made in that little journey made me very eager to see other parts
of the coast; and now I had a boat, I thought of nothing but sailing round the
island.
For this purpose, that I might do everything with discretion and consideration,
I fitted up a little mast in my boat, and made a sail too out of some of the
pieces of the ship’s sails which lay in store, and of which I had a great
stock by me. Having fitted my mast and sail, and tried the boat, I found she
would sail very well; then I made little lockers or boxes at each end of my
boat, to put provisions, necessaries, ammunition, &c., into, to be kept
dry, either from rain or the spray of the sea; and a little, long, hollow place
I cut in the inside of the boat, where I could lay my gun, making a flap to
hang down over it to keep it dry.
I fixed my umbrella also in the step at the stern, like a mast, to stand over
my head, and keep the heat of the sun off me, like an awning; and thus I every
now and then took a little voyage upon the sea, but never went far out, nor far
from the little creek. At last, being eager to view the circumference of my
little kingdom, I resolved upon my cruise; and accordingly I victualled my ship
for the voyage, putting in two dozen of loaves (cakes I should call them) of
barley-bread, an earthen pot full of parched rice (a food I ate a good deal
of), a little bottle of rum, half a goat, and powder and shot for killing more,
and two large watch-coats, of those which, as I mentioned before, I had saved
out of the seamen’s chests; these I took, one to lie upon, and the other
to cover me in the night.
It was the 6th of November, in the sixth year of my reign—or my
captivity, which you please—that I set out on this voyage, and I found it
much longer than I expected; for though the island itself was not very large,
yet when I came to the east side of it, I found a great ledge of rocks lie out
about two leagues into the sea, some above water, some under it; and beyond
that a shoal of sand, lying dry half a league more, so that I was obliged to go
a great way out to sea to double the point.
When I first discovered them, I was going to give over my enterprise, and come
back again, not knowing how far it might oblige me to go out to sea; and above
all, doubting how I should get back again: so I came to an anchor; for I had
made a kind of an anchor with a piece of a broken grappling which I got out of
the ship.
Having secured my boat, I took my gun and went on shore, climbing up a hill,
which seemed to overlook that point where I saw the full extent of it, and
resolved to venture.
In my viewing the sea from that hill where I stood, I perceived a strong, and
indeed a most furious current, which ran to the east, and even came close to
the point; and I took the more notice of it because I saw there might be some
danger that when I came into it I might be carried out to sea by the strength
of it, and not be able to make the island again; and indeed, had I not got
first upon this hill, I believe it would have been so; for there was the same
current on the other side the island, only that it set off at a further
distance, and I saw there was a strong eddy under the shore; so I had nothing
to do but to get out of the first current, and I should presently be in an
eddy.
I lay here, however, two days, because the wind blowing pretty fresh at ESE.,
and that being just contrary to the current, made a great breach of the sea
upon the point: so that it was not safe for me to keep too close to the shore
for the breach, nor to go too far off, because of the stream.
The third day, in the morning, the wind having abated overnight, the sea was
calm, and I ventured: but I am a warning to all rash and ignorant pilots; for
no sooner was I come to the point, when I was not even my boat’s length
from the shore, but I found myself in a great depth of water, and a current
like the sluice of a mill; it carried my boat along with it with such violence
that all I could do could not keep her so much as on the edge of it; but I
found it hurried me farther and farther out from the eddy, which was on my left
hand. There was no wind stirring to help me, and all I could do with my paddles
signified nothing: and now I began to give myself over for lost; for as the
current was on both sides of the island, I knew in a few leagues distance they
must join again, and then I was irrecoverably gone; nor did I see any
possibility of avoiding it; so that I had no prospect before me but of
perishing, not by the sea, for that was calm enough, but of starving from
hunger. I had, indeed, found a tortoise on the shore, as big almost as I could
lift, and had tossed it into the boat; and I had a great jar of fresh water,
that is to say, one of my earthen pots; but what was all this to being driven
into the vast ocean, where, to be sure, there was no shore, no mainland or
island, for a thousand leagues at least?
And now I saw how easy it was for the providence of God to make even the most
miserable condition of mankind worse. Now I looked back upon my desolate,
solitary island as the most pleasant place in the world and all the happiness
my heart could wish for was to be but there again. I stretched out my hands to
it, with eager wishes—“O happy desert!” said I, “I
shall never see thee more. O miserable creature! whither am going?” Then
I reproached myself with my unthankful temper, and that I had repined at my
solitary condition; and now what would I give to be on shore there again! Thus,
we never see the true state of our condition till it is illustrated to us by
its contraries, nor know how to value what we enjoy, but by the want of it. It
is scarcely possible to imagine the consternation I was now in, being driven
from my beloved island (for so it appeared to me now to be) into the wide
ocean, almost two leagues, and in the utmost despair of ever recovering it
again. However, I worked hard till, indeed, my strength was almost exhausted,
and kept my boat as much to the northward, that is, towards the side of the
current which the eddy lay on, as possibly I could; when about noon, as the sun
passed the meridian, I thought I felt a little breeze of wind in my face,
springing up from SSE. This cheered my heart a little, and especially when, in
about half-an-hour more, it blew a pretty gentle gale. By this time I had got
at a frightful distance from the island, and had the least cloudy or hazy
weather intervened, I had been undone another way, too; for I had no compass on
board, and should never have known how to have steered towards the island, if I
had but once lost sight of it; but the weather continuing clear, I applied
myself to get up my mast again, and spread my sail, standing away to the north
as much as possible, to get out of the current.
Just as I had set my mast and sail, and the boat began to stretch away, I saw
even by the clearness of the water some alteration of the current was near; for
where the current was so strong the water was foul; but perceiving the water
clear, I found the current abate; and presently I found to the east, at about
half a mile, a breach of the sea upon some rocks: these rocks I found caused
the current to part again, and as the main stress of it ran away more
southerly, leaving the rocks to the north-east, so the other returned by the
repulse of the rocks, and made a strong eddy, which ran back again to the
north-west, with a very sharp stream.
They who know what it is to have a reprieve brought to them upon the ladder, or
to be rescued from thieves just going to murder them, or who have been in such
extremities, may guess what my present surprise of joy was, and how gladly I
put my boat into the stream of this eddy; and the wind also freshening, how
gladly I spread my sail to it, running cheerfully before the wind, and with a
strong tide or eddy underfoot.
This eddy carried me about a league on my way back again, directly towards the
island, but about two leagues more to the northward than the current which
carried me away at first; so that when I came near the island, I found myself
open to the northern shore of it, that is to say, the other end of the island,
opposite to that which I went out from.
When I had made something more than a league of way by the help of this current
or eddy, I found it was spent, and served me no further. However, I found that
being between two great currents—viz. that on the south side, which had
hurried me away, and that on the north, which lay about a league on the other
side; I say, between these two, in the wake of the island, I found the water at
least still, and running no way; and having still a breeze of wind fair for me,
I kept on steering directly for the island, though not making such fresh way as
I did before.
About four o’clock in the evening, being then within a league of the
island, I found the point of the rocks which occasioned this disaster
stretching out, as is described before, to the southward, and casting off the
current more southerly, had, of course, made another eddy to the north; and
this I found very strong, but not directly setting the way my course lay, which
was due west, but almost full north. However, having a fresh gale, I stretched
across this eddy, slanting north-west; and in about an hour came within about a
mile of the shore, where, it being smooth water, I soon got to land.
When I was on shore, God I fell on my knees and gave God thanks for my
deliverance, resolving to lay aside all thoughts of my deliverance by my boat;
and refreshing myself with such things as I had, I brought my boat close to the
shore, in a little cove that I had spied under some trees, and laid me down to
sleep, being quite spent with the labour and fatigue of the voyage.
I was now at a great loss which way to get home with my boat! I had run so much
hazard, and knew too much of the case, to think of attempting it by the way I
went out; and what might be at the other side (I mean the west side) I knew
not, nor had I any mind to run any more ventures; so I resolved on the next
morning to make my way westward along the shore, and to see if there was no
creek where I might lay up my frigate in safety, so as to have her again if I
wanted her. In about three miles or thereabouts, coasting the shore, I came to
a very good inlet or bay, about a mile over, which narrowed till it came to a
very little rivulet or brook, where I found a very convenient harbour for my
boat, and where she lay as if she had been in a little dock made on purpose for
her. Here I put in, and having stowed my boat very safe, I went on shore to
look about me, and see where I was.
I soon found I had but a little passed by the place where I had been before,
when I travelled on foot to that shore; so taking nothing out of my boat but my
gun and umbrella, for it was exceedingly hot, I began my march. The way was
comfortable enough after such a voyage as I had been upon, and I reached my old
bower in the evening, where I found everything standing as I left it; for I
always kept it in good order, being, as I said before, my country house.
I got over the fence, and laid me down in the shade to rest my limbs, for I was
very weary, and fell asleep; but judge you, if you can, that read my story,
what a surprise I must be in when I was awaked out of my sleep by a voice
calling me by my name several times, “Robin, Robin, Robin Crusoe: poor
Robin Crusoe! Where are you, Robin Crusoe? Where are you? Where have you
been?”
I was so dead asleep at first, being fatigued with rowing, or part of the day,
and with walking the latter part, that I did not wake thoroughly; but dozing
thought I dreamed that somebody spoke to me; but as the voice continued to
repeat, “Robin Crusoe, Robin Crusoe,” at last I began to wake more
perfectly, and was at first dreadfully frightened, and started up in the utmost
consternation; but no sooner were my eyes open, but I saw my Poll sitting on
the top of the hedge; and immediately knew that it was he that spoke to me; for
just in such bemoaning language I had used to talk to him and teach him; and he
had learned it so perfectly that he would sit upon my finger, and lay his bill
close to my face and cry, “Poor Robin Crusoe! Where are you? Where have
you been? How came you here?” and such things as I had taught him.
However, even though I knew it was the parrot, and that indeed it could be
nobody else, it was a good while before I could compose myself. First, I was
amazed how the creature got thither; and then, how he should just keep about
the place, and nowhere else; but as I was well satisfied it could be nobody but
honest Poll, I got over it; and holding out my hand, and calling him by his
name, “Poll,” the sociable creature came to me, and sat upon my
thumb, as he used to do, and continued talking to me, “Poor Robin Crusoe!
and how did I come here? and where had I been?” just as if he had been
overjoyed to see me again; and so I carried him home along with me.
I had now had enough of rambling to sea for some time, and had enough to do for
many days to sit still and reflect upon the danger I had been in. I would have
been very glad to have had my boat again on my side of the island; but I knew
not how it was practicable to get it about. As to the east side of the island,
which I had gone round, I knew well enough there was no venturing that way; my
very heart would shrink, and my very blood run chill, but to think of it; and
as to the other side of the island, I did not know how it might be there; but
supposing the current ran with the same force against the shore at the east as
it passed by it on the other, I might run the same risk of being driven down
the stream, and carried by the island, as I had been before of being carried
away from it: so with these thoughts, I contented myself to be without any
boat, though it had been the product of so many months’ labour to make
it, and of so many more to get it into the sea.
In this government of my temper I remained near a year; and lived a very
sedate, retired life, as you may well suppose; and my thoughts being very much
composed as to my condition, and fully comforted in resigning myself to the
dispositions of Providence, I thought I lived really very happily in all things
except that of society.
I improved myself in this time in all the mechanic exercises which my
necessities put me upon applying myself to; and I believe I should, upon
occasion, have made a very good carpenter, especially considering how few tools
I had.
Besides this, I arrived at an unexpected perfection in my earthenware, and
contrived well enough to make them with a wheel, which I found infinitely
easier and better; because I made things round and shaped, which before were
filthy things indeed to look on. But I think I was never more vain of my own
performance, or more joyful for anything I found out, than for my being able to
make a tobacco-pipe; and though it was a very ugly, clumsy thing when it was
done, and only burned red, like other earthenware, yet as it was hard and firm,
and would draw the smoke, I was exceedingly comforted with it, for I had been
always used to smoke; and there were pipes in the ship, but I forgot them at
first, not thinking there was tobacco in the island; and afterwards, when I
searched the ship again, I could not come at any pipes.
In my wicker-ware also I improved much, and made abundance of necessary
baskets, as well as my invention showed me; though not very handsome, yet they
were such as were very handy and convenient for laying things up in, or
fetching things home. For example, if I killed a goat abroad, I could hang it
up in a tree, flay it, dress it, and cut it in pieces, and bring it home in a
basket; and the like by a turtle; I could cut it up, take out the eggs and a
piece or two of the flesh, which was enough for me, and bring them home in a
basket, and leave the rest behind me. Also, large deep baskets were the
receivers of my corn, which I always rubbed out as soon as it was dry and
cured, and kept it in great baskets.
I began now to perceive my powder abated considerably; this was a want which it
was impossible for me to supply, and I began seriously to consider what I must
do when I should have no more powder; that is to say, how I should kill any
goats. I had, as is observed in the third year of my being here, kept a young
kid, and bred her up tame, and I was in hopes of getting a he-goat; but I could
not by any means bring it to pass, till my kid grew an old goat; and as I could
never find in my heart to kill her, she died at last of mere age.
But being now in the eleventh year of my residence, and, as I have said, my
ammunition growing low, I set myself to study some art to trap and snare the
goats, to see whether I could not catch some of them alive; and particularly I
wanted a she-goat great with young. For this purpose I made snares to hamper
them; and I do believe they were more than once taken in them; but my tackle
was not good, for I had no wire, and I always found them broken and my bait
devoured. At length I resolved to try a pitfall; so I dug several large pits in
the earth, in places where I had observed the goats used to feed, and over
those pits I placed hurdles of my own making too, with a great weight upon
them; and several times I put ears of barley and dry rice without setting the
trap; and I could easily perceive that the goats had gone in and eaten up the
corn, for I could see the marks of their feet. At length I set three traps in
one night, and going the next morning I found them, all standing, and yet the
bait eaten and gone; this was very discouraging. However, I altered my traps;
and not to trouble you with particulars, going one morning to see my traps, I
found in one of them a large old he-goat; and in one of the others three kids,
a male and two females.
As to the old one, I knew not what to do with him; he was so fierce I durst not
go into the pit to him; that is to say, to bring him away alive, which was what
I wanted. I could have killed him, but that was not my business, nor would it
answer my end; so I even let him out, and he ran away as if he had been
frightened out of his wits. But I did not then know what I afterwards learned,
that hunger will tame a lion. If I had let him stay three or four days without
food, and then have carried him some water to drink and then a little corn, he
would have been as tame as one of the kids; for they are mighty sagacious,
tractable creatures, where they are well used.
However, for the present I let him go, knowing no better at that time: then I
went to the three kids, and taking them one by one, I tied them with strings
together, and with some difficulty brought them all home.
It was a good while before they would feed; but throwing them some sweet corn,
it tempted them, and they began to be tame. And now I found that if I expected
to supply myself with goats’ flesh, when I had no powder or shot left,
breeding some up tame was my only way, when, perhaps, I might have them about
my house like a flock of sheep. But then it occurred to me that I must keep the
tame from the wild, or else they would always run wild when they grew up; and
the only way for this was to have some enclosed piece of ground, well fenced
either with hedge or pale, to keep them in so effectually, that those within
might not break out, or those without break in.
This was a great undertaking for one pair of hands yet, as I saw there was an
absolute necessity for doing it, my first work was to find out a proper piece
of ground, where there was likely to be herbage for them to eat, water for them
to drink, and cover to keep them from the sun.
Those who understand such enclosures will think I had very little contrivance
when I pitched upon a place very proper for all these (being a plain, open
piece of meadow land, or savannah, as our people call it in the western
colonies), which had two or three little drills of fresh water in it, and at
one end was very woody—I say, they will smile at my forecast, when I
shall tell them I began by enclosing this piece of ground in such a manner
that, my hedge or pale must have been at least two miles about. Nor was the
madness of it so great as to the compass, for if it was ten miles about, I was
like to have time enough to do it in; but I did not consider that my goats
would be as wild in so much compass as if they had had the whole island, and I
should have so much room to chase them in that I should never catch them.
My hedge was begun and carried on, I believe, about fifty yards when this
thought occurred to me; so I presently stopped short, and, for the beginning, I
resolved to enclose a piece of about one hundred and fifty yards in length, and
one hundred yards in breadth, which, as it would maintain as many as I should
have in any reasonable time, so, as my stock increased, I could add more ground
to my enclosure.
This was acting with some prudence, and I went to work with courage. I was
about three months hedging in the first piece; and, till I had done it, I
tethered the three kids in the best part of it, and used them to feed as near
me as possible, to make them familiar; and very often I would go and carry them
some ears of barley, or a handful of rice, and feed them out of my hand; so
that after my enclosure was finished and I let them loose, they would follow me
up and down, bleating after me for a handful of corn.
This answered my end, and in about a year and a half I had a flock of about
twelve goats, kids and all; and in two years more I had three-and-forty,
besides several that I took and killed for my food. After that, I enclosed five
several pieces of ground to feed them in, with little pens to drive them to
take them as I wanted, and gates out of one piece of ground into another.
But this was not all; for now I not only had goat’s flesh to feed on when
I pleased, but milk too—a thing which, indeed, in the beginning, I did
not so much as think of, and which, when it came into my thoughts, was really
an agreeable surprise, for now I set up my dairy, and had sometimes a gallon or
two of milk in a day. And as Nature, who gives supplies of food to every
creature, dictates even naturally how to make use of it, so I, that had never
milked a cow, much less a goat, or seen butter or cheese made only when I was a
boy, after a great many essays and miscarriages, made both butter and cheese at
last, also salt (though I found it partly made to my hand by the heat of the
sun upon some of the rocks of the sea), and never wanted it afterwards. How
mercifully can our Creator treat His creatures, even in those conditions in
which they seemed to be overwhelmed in destruction! How can He sweeten the
bitterest providences, and give us cause to praise Him for dungeons and
prisons! What a table was here spread for me in the wilderness, where I saw
nothing at first but to perish for hunger!
CHAPTER XI.
FINDS PRINT OF MAN’S FOOT ON THE SAND
It would have made a Stoic smile to have seen me and my little family sit down
to dinner. There was my majesty the prince and lord of the whole island; I had
the lives of all my subjects at my absolute command; I could hang, draw, give
liberty, and take it away, and no rebels among all my subjects. Then, to see
how like a king I dined, too, all alone, attended by my servants! Poll, as if
he had been my favourite, was the only person permitted to talk to me. My dog,
who was now grown old and crazy, and had found no species to multiply his kind
upon, sat always at my right hand; and two cats, one on one side of the table
and one on the other, expecting now and then a bit from my hand, as a mark of
especial favour.
But these were not the two cats which I brought on shore at first, for they
were both of them dead, and had been interred near my habitation by my own
hand; but one of them having multiplied by I know not what kind of creature,
these were two which I had preserved tame; whereas the rest ran wild in the
woods, and became indeed troublesome to me at last, for they would often come
into my house, and plunder me too, till at last I was obliged to shoot them,
and did kill a great many; at length they left me. With this attendance and in
this plentiful manner I lived; neither could I be said to want anything but
society; and of that, some time after this, I was likely to have too much.
I was something impatient, as I have observed, to have the use of my boat,
though very loath to run any more hazards; and therefore sometimes I sat
contriving ways to get her about the island, and at other times I sat myself
down contented enough without her. But I had a strange uneasiness in my mind to
go down to the point of the island where, as I have said in my last ramble, I
went up the hill to see how the shore lay, and how the current set, that I
might see what I had to do: this inclination increased upon me every day, and
at length I resolved to travel thither by land, following the edge of the
shore. I did so; but had any one in England met such a man as I was, it must
either have frightened him, or raised a great deal of laughter; and as I
frequently stood still to look at myself, I could not but smile at the notion
of my travelling through Yorkshire with such an equipage, and in such a dress.
Be pleased to take a sketch of my figure, as follows.
I had a great high shapeless cap, made of a goat’s skin, with a flap
hanging down behind, as well to keep the sun from me as to shoot the rain off
from running into my neck, nothing being so hurtful in these climates as the
rain upon the flesh under the clothes.
I had a short jacket of goat’s skin, the skirts coming down to about the
middle of the thighs, and a pair of open-kneed breeches of the same; the
breeches were made of the skin of an old he-goat, whose hair hung down such a
length on either side that, like pantaloons, it reached to the middle of my
legs; stockings and shoes I had none, but had made me a pair of somethings, I
scarce knew what to call them, like buskins, to flap over my legs, and lace on
either side like spatterdashes, but of a most barbarous shape, as indeed were
all the rest of my clothes.
I had on a broad belt of goat’s skin dried, which I drew together with
two thongs of the same instead of buckles, and in a kind of a frog on either
side of this, instead of a sword and dagger, hung a little saw and a hatchet,
one on one side and one on the other. I had another belt not so broad, and
fastened in the same manner, which hung over my shoulder, and at the end of it,
under my left arm, hung two pouches, both made of goat’s skin too, in one
of which hung my powder, in the other my shot. At my back I carried my basket,
and on my shoulder my gun, and over my head a great clumsy, ugly,
goat’s-skin umbrella, but which, after all, was the most necessary thing
I had about me next to my gun. As for my face, the colour of it was really not
so mulatto-like as one might expect from a man not at all careful of it, and
living within nine or ten degrees of the equinox. My beard I had once suffered
to grow till it was about a quarter of a yard long; but as I had both scissors
and razors sufficient, I had cut it pretty short, except what grew on my upper
lip, which I had trimmed into a large pair of Mahometan whiskers, such as I had
seen worn by some Turks at Sallee, for the Moors did not wear such, though the
Turks did; of these moustachios, or whiskers, I will not say they were long
enough to hang my hat upon them, but they were of a length and shape monstrous
enough, and such as in England would have passed for frightful.
But all this is by-the-bye; for as to my figure, I had so few to observe me
that it was of no manner of consequence, so I say no more of that. In this kind
of dress I went my new journey, and was out five or six days. I travelled first
along the sea-shore, directly to the place where I first brought my boat to an
anchor to get upon the rocks; and having no boat now to take care of, I went
over the land a nearer way to the same height that I was upon before, when,
looking forward to the points of the rocks which lay out, and which I was
obliged to double with my boat, as is said above, I was surprised to see the
sea all smooth and quiet—no rippling, no motion, no current, any more
there than in other places. I was at a strange loss to understand this, and
resolved to spend some time in the observing it, to see if nothing from the
sets of the tide had occasioned it; but I was presently convinced how it
was—viz. that the tide of ebb setting from the west, and joining with the
current of waters from some great river on the shore, must be the occasion of
this current, and that, according as the wind blew more forcibly from the west
or from the north, this current came nearer or went farther from the shore;
for, waiting thereabouts till evening, I went up to the rock again, and then
the tide of ebb being made, I plainly saw the current again as before, only
that it ran farther off, being near half a league from the shore, whereas in my
case it set close upon the shore, and hurried me and my canoe along with it,
which at another time it would not have done.
This observation convinced me that I had nothing to do but to observe the
ebbing and the flowing of the tide, and I might very easily bring my boat about
the island again; but when I began to think of putting it in practice, I had
such terror upon my spirits at the remembrance of the danger I had been in,
that I could not think of it again with any patience, but, on the contrary, I
took up another resolution, which was more safe, though more
laborious—and this was, that I would build, or rather make, me another
periagua or canoe, and so have one for one side of the island, and one for the
other.
You are to understand that now I had, as I may call it, two plantations in the
island—one my little fortification or tent, with the wall about it, under
the rock, with the cave behind me, which by this time I had enlarged into
several apartments or caves, one within another. One of these, which was the
driest and largest, and had a door out beyond my wall or
fortification—that is to say, beyond where my wall joined to the
rock—was all filled up with the large earthen pots of which I have given
an account, and with fourteen or fifteen great baskets, which would hold five
or six bushels each, where I laid up my stores of provisions, especially my
corn, some in the ear, cut off short from the straw, and the other rubbed out
with my hand.
As for my wall, made, as before, with long stakes or piles, those piles grew
all like trees, and were by this time grown so big, and spread so very much,
that there was not the least appearance, to any one’s view, of any
habitation behind them.
Near this dwelling of mine, but a little farther within the land, and upon
lower ground, lay my two pieces of corn land, which I kept duly cultivated and
sowed, and which duly yielded me their harvest in its season; and whenever I
had occasion for more corn, I had more land adjoining as fit as that.
Besides this, I had my country seat, and I had now a tolerable plantation there
also; for, first, I had my little bower, as I called it, which I kept in
repair—that is to say, I kept the hedge which encircled it in constantly
fitted up to its usual height, the ladder standing always in the inside. I kept
the trees, which at first were no more than stakes, but were now grown very
firm and tall, always cut, so that they might spread and grow thick and wild,
and make the more agreeable shade, which they did effectually to my mind. In
the middle of this I had my tent always standing, being a piece of a sail
spread over poles, set up for that purpose, and which never wanted any repair
or renewing; and under this I had made me a squab or couch with the skins of
the creatures I had killed, and with other soft things, and a blanket laid on
them, such as belonged to our sea-bedding, which I had saved; and a great
watch-coat to cover me. And here, whenever I had occasion to be absent from my
chief seat, I took up my country habitation.
Adjoining to this I had my enclosures for my cattle, that is to say my goats,
and I had taken an inconceivable deal of pains to fence and enclose this
ground. I was so anxious to see it kept entire, lest the goats should break
through, that I never left off till, with infinite labour, I had stuck the
outside of the hedge so full of small stakes, and so near to one another, that
it was rather a pale than a hedge, and there was scarce room to put a hand
through between them; which afterwards, when those stakes grew, as they all did
in the next rainy season, made the enclosure strong like a wall, indeed
stronger than any wall.
This will testify for me that I was not idle, and that I spared no pains to
bring to pass whatever appeared necessary for my comfortable support, for I
considered the keeping up a breed of tame creatures thus at my hand would be a
living magazine of flesh, milk, butter, and cheese for me as long as I lived in
the place, if it were to be forty years; and that keeping them in my reach
depended entirely upon my perfecting my enclosures to such a degree that I
might be sure of keeping them together; which by this method, indeed, I so
effectually secured, that when these little stakes began to grow, I had planted
them so very thick that I was forced to pull some of them up again.
In this place also I had my grapes growing, which I principally depended on for
my winter store of raisins, and which I never failed to preserve very
carefully, as the best and most agreeable dainty of my whole diet; and indeed
they were not only agreeable, but medicinal, wholesome, nourishing, and
refreshing to the last degree.
As this was also about half-way between my other habitation and the place where
I had laid up my boat, I generally stayed and lay here in my way thither, for I
used frequently to visit my boat; and I kept all things about or belonging to
her in very good order. Sometimes I went out in her to divert myself, but no
more hazardous voyages would I go, scarcely ever above a stone’s cast or
two from the shore, I was so apprehensive of being hurried out of my knowledge
again by the currents or winds, or any other accident. But now I come to a new
scene of my life.
It happened one day, about noon, going towards my boat, I was exceedingly
surprised with the print of a man’s naked foot on the shore, which was
very plain to be seen on the sand. I stood like one thunderstruck, or as if I
had seen an apparition. I listened, I looked round me, but I could hear
nothing, nor see anything; I went up to a rising ground to look farther; I went
up the shore and down the shore, but it was all one; I could see no other
impression but that one. I went to it again to see if there were any more, and
to observe if it might not be my fancy; but there was no room for that, for
there was exactly the print of a foot—toes, heel, and every part of a
foot. How it came thither I knew not, nor could I in the least imagine; but
after innumerable fluttering thoughts, like a man perfectly confused and out of
myself, I came home to my fortification, not feeling, as we say, the ground I
went on, but terrified to the last degree, looking behind me at every two or
three steps, mistaking every bush and tree, and fancying every stump at a
distance to be a man. Nor is it possible to describe how many various shapes my
affrighted imagination represented things to me in, how many wild ideas were
found every moment in my fancy, and what strange, unaccountable whimsies came
into my thoughts by the way.
When I came to my castle (for so I think I called it ever after this), I fled
into it like one pursued. Whether I went over by the ladder, as first
contrived, or went in at the hole in the rock, which I had called a door, I
cannot remember; no, nor could I remember the next morning, for never
frightened hare fled to cover, or fox to earth, with more terror of mind than I
to this retreat.
I slept none that night; the farther I was from the occasion of my fright, the
greater my apprehensions were, which is something contrary to the nature of
such things, and especially to the usual practice of all creatures in fear; but
I was so embarrassed with my own frightful ideas of the thing, that I formed
nothing but dismal imaginations to myself, even though I was now a great way
off. Sometimes I fancied it must be the devil, and reason joined in with me in
this supposition, for how should any other thing in human shape come into the
place? Where was the vessel that brought them? What marks were there of any
other footstep? And how was it possible a man should come there? But then, to
think that Satan should take human shape upon him in such a place, where there
could be no manner of occasion for it, but to leave the print of his foot
behind him, and that even for no purpose too, for he could not be sure I should
see it—this was an amusement the other way. I considered that the devil
might have found out abundance of other ways to have terrified me than this of
the single print of a foot; that as I lived quite on the other side of the
island, he would never have been so simple as to leave a mark in a place where
it was ten thousand to one whether I should ever see it or not, and in the sand
too, which the first surge of the sea, upon a high wind, would have defaced
entirely. All this seemed inconsistent with the thing itself and with all the
notions we usually entertain of the subtlety of the devil.
Abundance of such things as these assisted to argue me out of all apprehensions
of its being the devil; and I presently concluded then that it must be some
more dangerous creature—viz. that it must be some of the savages of the
mainland opposite who had wandered out to sea in their canoes, and either
driven by the currents or by contrary winds, had made the island, and had been
on shore, but were gone away again to sea; being as loath, perhaps, to have
stayed in this desolate island as I would have been to have had them.
While these reflections were rolling in my mind, I was very thankful in my
thoughts that I was so happy as not to be thereabouts at that time, or that
they did not see my boat, by which they would have concluded that some
inhabitants had been in the place, and perhaps have searched farther for me.
Then terrible thoughts racked my imagination about their having found out my
boat, and that there were people here; and that, if so, I should certainly have
them come again in greater numbers and devour me; that if it should happen that
they should not find me, yet they would find my enclosure, destroy all my corn,
and carry away all my flock of tame goats, and I should perish at last for mere
want.
Thus my fear banished all my religious hope, all that former confidence in God,
which was founded upon such wonderful experience as I had had of His goodness;
as if He that had fed me by miracle hitherto could not preserve, by His power,
the provision which He had made for me by His goodness. I reproached myself
with my laziness, that would not sow any more corn one year than would just
serve me till the next season, as if no accident could intervene to prevent my
enjoying the crop that was upon the ground; and this I thought so just a
reproof, that I resolved for the future to have two or three years’ corn
beforehand; so that, whatever might come, I might not perish for want of bread.
How strange a chequer-work of Providence is the life of man! and by what secret
different springs are the affections hurried about, as different circumstances
present! To-day we love what to-morrow we hate; to-day we seek what to-morrow
we shun; to-day we desire what to-morrow we fear, nay, even tremble at the
apprehensions of. This was exemplified in me, at this time, in the most lively
manner imaginable; for I, whose only affliction was that I seemed banished from
human society, that I was alone, circumscribed by the boundless ocean, cut off
from mankind, and condemned to what I call silent life; that I was as one whom
Heaven thought not worthy to be numbered among the living, or to appear among
the rest of His creatures; that to have seen one of my own species would have
seemed to me a raising me from death to life, and the greatest blessing that
Heaven itself, next to the supreme blessing of salvation, could bestow; I say,
that I should now tremble at the very apprehensions of seeing a man, and was
ready to sink into the ground at but the shadow or silent appearance of a man
having set his foot in the island.
Such is the uneven state of human life; and it afforded me a great many curious
speculations afterwards, when I had a little recovered my first surprise. I
considered that this was the station of life the infinitely wise and good
providence of God had determined for me; that as I could not foresee what the
ends of Divine wisdom might be in all this, so I was not to dispute His
sovereignty; who, as I was His creature, had an undoubted right, by creation,
to govern and dispose of me absolutely as He thought fit; and who, as I was a
creature that had offended Him, had likewise a judicial right to condemn me to
what punishment He thought fit; and that it was my part to submit to bear His
indignation, because I had sinned against Him. I then reflected, that as God,
who was not only righteous but omnipotent, had thought fit thus to punish and
afflict me, so He was able to deliver me: that if He did not think fit to do
so, it was my unquestioned duty to resign myself absolutely and entirely to His
will; and, on the other hand, it was my duty also to hope in Him, pray to Him,
and quietly to attend to the dictates and directions of His daily providence.
These thoughts took me up many hours, days, nay, I may say weeks and months:
and one particular effect of my cogitations on this occasion I cannot omit. One
morning early, lying in my bed, and filled with thoughts about my danger from
the appearances of savages, I found it discomposed me very much; upon which
these words of the Scripture came into my thoughts, “Call upon Me in the
day of trouble, and I will deliver thee, and thou shalt glorify Me.” Upon
this, rising cheerfully out of my bed, my heart was not only comforted, but I
was guided and encouraged to pray earnestly to God for deliverance: when I had
done praying I took up my Bible, and opening it to read, the first words that
presented to me were, “Wait on the Lord, and be of good cheer, and He
shall strengthen thy heart; wait, I say, on the Lord.” It is impossible
to express the comfort this gave me. In answer, I thankfully laid down the
book, and was no more sad, at least on that occasion.
In the middle of these cogitations, apprehensions, and reflections, it came
into my thoughts one day that all this might be a mere chimera of my own, and
that this foot might be the print of my own foot, when I came on shore from my
boat: this cheered me up a little, too, and I began to persuade myself it was
all a delusion; that it was nothing else but my own foot; and why might I not
come that way from the boat, as well as I was going that way to the boat?
Again, I considered also that I could by no means tell for certain where I had
trod, and where I had not; and that if, at last, this was only the print of my
own foot, I had played the part of those fools who try to make stories of
spectres and apparitions, and then are frightened at them more than anybody.
Now I began to take courage, and to peep abroad again, for I had not stirred
out of my castle for three days and nights, so that I began to starve for
provisions; for I had little or nothing within doors but some barley-cakes and
water; then I knew that my goats wanted to be milked too, which usually was my
evening diversion: and the poor creatures were in great pain and inconvenience
for want of it; and, indeed, it almost spoiled some of them, and almost dried
up their milk. Encouraging myself, therefore, with the belief that this was
nothing but the print of one of my own feet, and that I might be truly said to
start at my own shadow, I began to go abroad again, and went to my country
house to milk my flock: but to see with what fear I went forward, how often I
looked behind me, how I was ready every now and then to lay down my basket and
run for my life, it would have made any one have thought I was haunted with an
evil conscience, or that I had been lately most terribly frightened; and so,
indeed, I had. However, I went down thus two or three days, and having seen
nothing, I began to be a little bolder, and to think there was really nothing
in it but my own imagination; but I could not persuade myself fully of this
till I should go down to the shore again, and see this print of a foot, and
measure it by my own, and see if there was any similitude or fitness, that I
might be assured it was my own foot: but when I came to the place, first, it
appeared evidently to me, that when I laid up my boat I could not possibly be
on shore anywhere thereabouts; secondly, when I came to measure the mark with
my own foot, I found my foot not so large by a great deal. Both these things
filled my head with new imaginations, and gave me the vapours again to the
highest degree, so that I shook with cold like one in an ague; and I went home
again, filled with the belief that some man or men had been on shore there; or,
in short, that the island was inhabited, and I might be surprised before I was
aware; and what course to take for my security I knew not.
Oh, what ridiculous resolutions men take when possessed with fear! It deprives
them of the use of those means which reason offers for their relief. The first
thing I proposed to myself was, to throw down my enclosures, and turn all my
tame cattle wild into the woods, lest the enemy should find them, and then
frequent the island in prospect of the same or the like booty: then the simple
thing of digging up my two corn-fields, lest they should find such a grain
there, and still be prompted to frequent the island: then to demolish my bower
and tent, that they might not see any vestiges of habitation, and be prompted
to look farther, in order to find out the persons inhabiting.
These were the subject of the first night’s cogitations after I was come
home again, while the apprehensions which had so overrun my mind were fresh
upon me, and my head was full of vapours. Thus, fear of danger is ten thousand
times more terrifying than danger itself, when apparent to the eyes; and we
find the burden of anxiety greater, by much, than the evil which we are anxious
about: and what was worse than all this, I had not that relief in this trouble
that from the resignation I used to practise I hoped to have. I looked, I
thought, like Saul, who complained not only that the Philistines were upon him,
but that God had forsaken him; for I did not now take due ways to compose my
mind, by crying to God in my distress, and resting upon His providence, as I
had done before, for my defence and deliverance; which, if I had done, I had at
least been more cheerfully supported under this new surprise, and perhaps
carried through it with more resolution.
This confusion of my thoughts kept me awake all night; but in the morning I
fell asleep; and having, by the amusement of my mind, been as it were tired,
and my spirits exhausted, I slept very soundly, and waked much better composed
than I had ever been before. And now I began to think sedately; and, upon
debate with myself, I concluded that this island (which was so exceedingly
pleasant, fruitful, and no farther from the mainland than as I had seen) was
not so entirely abandoned as I might imagine; that although there were no
stated inhabitants who lived on the spot, yet that there might sometimes come
boats off from the shore, who, either with design, or perhaps never but when
they were driven by cross winds, might come to this place; that I had lived
there fifteen years now and had not met with the least shadow or figure of any
people yet; and that, if at any time they should be driven here, it was
probable they went away again as soon as ever they could, seeing they had never
thought fit to fix here upon any occasion; that the most I could suggest any
danger from was from any casual accidental landing of straggling people from
the main, who, as it was likely, if they were driven hither, were here against
their wills, so they made no stay here, but went off again with all possible
speed; seldom staying one night on shore, lest they should not have the help of
the tides and daylight back again; and that, therefore, I had nothing to do but
to consider of some safe retreat, in case I should see any savages land upon
the spot.
Now, I began sorely to repent that I had dug my cave so large as to bring a
door through again, which door, as I said, came out beyond where my
fortification joined to the rock: upon maturely considering this, therefore, I
resolved to draw me a second fortification, in the manner of a semicircle, at a
distance from my wall, just where I had planted a double row of trees about
twelve years before, of which I made mention: these trees having been planted
so thick before, they wanted but few piles to be driven between them, that they
might be thicker and stronger, and my wall would be soon finished. So that I
had now a double wall; and my outer wall was thickened with pieces of timber,
old cables, and everything I could think of, to make it strong; having in it
seven little holes, about as big as I might put my arm out at. In the inside of
this I thickened my wall to about ten feet thick with continually bringing
earth out of my cave, and laying it at the foot of the wall, and walking upon
it; and through the seven holes I contrived to plant the muskets, of which I
took notice that I had got seven on shore out of the ship; these I planted like
my cannon, and fitted them into frames, that held them like a carriage, so that
I could fire all the seven guns in two minutes’ time; this wall I was
many a weary month in finishing, and yet never thought myself safe till it was
done.
When this was done I stuck all the ground without my wall, for a great length
every way, as full with stakes or sticks of the osier-like wood, which I found
so apt to grow, as they could well stand; insomuch that I believe I might set
in near twenty thousand of them, leaving a pretty large space between them and
my wall, that I might have room to see an enemy, and they might have no shelter
from the young trees, if they attempted to approach my outer wall.
Thus in two years’ time I had a thick grove; and in five or six
years’ time I had a wood before my dwelling, growing so monstrously thick
and strong that it was indeed perfectly impassable: and no men, of what kind
soever, could ever imagine that there was anything beyond it, much less a
habitation. As for the way which I proposed to myself to go in and out (for I
left no avenue), it was by setting two ladders, one to a part of the rock which
was low, and then broke in, and left room to place another ladder upon that; so
when the two ladders were taken down no man living could come down to me
without doing himself mischief; and if they had come down, they were still on
the outside of my outer wall.
Thus I took all the measures human prudence could suggest for my own
preservation; and it will be seen at length that they were not altogether
without just reason; though I foresaw nothing at that time more than my mere
fear suggested to me.
CHAPTER XII.
A CAVE RETREAT
While this was doing, I was not altogether careless of my other affairs; for I
had a great concern upon me for my little herd of goats: they were not only a
ready supply to me on every occasion, and began to be sufficient for me,
without the expense of powder and shot, but also without the fatigue of hunting
after the wild ones; and I was loath to lose the advantage of them, and to have
them all to nurse up over again.
For this purpose, after long consideration, I could think of but two ways to
preserve them: one was, to find another convenient place to dig a cave
underground, and to drive them into it every night; and the other was to
enclose two or three little bits of land, remote from one another, and as much
concealed as I could, where I might keep about half-a-dozen young goats in each
place; so that if any disaster happened to the flock in general, I might be
able to raise them again with little trouble and time: and this though it would
require a good deal of time and labour, I thought was the most rational design.
Accordingly, I spent some time to find out the most retired parts of the
island; and I pitched upon one, which was as private, indeed, as my heart could
wish: it was a little damp piece of ground in the middle of the hollow and
thick woods, where, as is observed, I almost lost myself once before,
endeavouring to come back that way from the eastern part of the island. Here I
found a clear piece of land, near three acres, so surrounded with woods that it
was almost an enclosure by nature; at least, it did not want near so much
labour to make it so as the other piece of ground I had worked so hard at.
I immediately went to work with this piece of ground; and in less than a
month’s time I had so fenced it round that my flock, or herd, call it
which you please, which were not so wild now as at first they might be supposed
to be, were well enough secured in it: so, without any further delay, I removed
ten young she-goats and two he-goats to this piece, and when they were there I
continued to perfect the fence till I had made it as secure as the other;
which, however, I did at more leisure, and it took me up more time by a great
deal. All this labour I was at the expense of, purely from my apprehensions on
account of the print of a man’s foot; for as yet I had never seen any
human creature come near the island; and I had now lived two years under this
uneasiness, which, indeed, made my life much less comfortable than it was
before, as may be well imagined by any who know what it is to live in the
constant snare of the fear of man. And this I must observe, with grief, too,
that the discomposure of my mind had great impression also upon the religious
part of my thoughts; for the dread and terror of falling into the hands of
savages and cannibals lay so upon my spirits, that I seldom found myself in a
due temper for application to my Maker; at least, not with the sedate calmness
and resignation of soul which I was wont to do: I rather prayed to God as under
great affliction and pressure of mind, surrounded with danger, and in
expectation every night of being murdered and devoured before morning; and I
must testify, from my experience, that a temper of peace, thankfulness, love,
and affection, is much the more proper frame for prayer than that of terror and
discomposure: and that under the dread of mischief impending, a man is no more
fit for a comforting performance of the duty of praying to God than he is for a
repentance on a sick-bed; for these discomposures affect the mind, as the
others do the body; and the discomposure of the mind must necessarily be as
great a disability as that of the body, and much greater; praying to God being
properly an act of the mind, not of the body.
But to go on. After I had thus secured one part of my little living stock, I
went about the whole island, searching for another private place to make such
another deposit; when, wandering more to the west point of the island than I
had ever done yet, and looking out to sea, I thought I saw a boat upon the sea,
at a great distance. I had found a perspective glass or two in one of the
seamen’s chests, which I saved out of our ship, but I had it not about
me; and this was so remote that I could not tell what to make of it, though I
looked at it till my eyes were not able to hold to look any longer; whether it
was a boat or not I do not know, but as I descended from the hill I could see
no more of it, so I gave it over; only I resolved to go no more out without a
perspective glass in my pocket. When I was come down the hill to the end of the
island, where, indeed, I had never been before, I was presently convinced that
the seeing the print of a man’s foot was not such a strange thing in the
island as I imagined: and but that it was a special providence that I was cast
upon the side of the island where the savages never came, I should easily have
known that nothing was more frequent than for the canoes from the main, when
they happened to be a little too far out at sea, to shoot over to that side of
the island for harbour: likewise, as they often met and fought in their canoes,
the victors, having taken any prisoners, would bring them over to this shore,
where, according to their dreadful customs, being all cannibals, they would
kill and eat them; of which hereafter.
When I was come down the hill to the shore, as I said above, being the SW.
point of the island, I was perfectly confounded and amazed; nor is it possible
for me to express the horror of my mind at seeing the shore spread with skulls,
hands, feet, and other bones of human bodies; and particularly I observed a
place where there had been a fire made, and a circle dug in the earth, like a
cockpit, where I supposed the savage wretches had sat down to their human
feastings upon the bodies of their fellow-creatures.
I was so astonished with the sight of these things, that I entertained no
notions of any danger to myself from it for a long while: all my apprehensions
were buried in the thoughts of such a pitch of inhuman, hellish brutality, and
the horror of the degeneracy of human nature, which, though I had heard of it
often, yet I never had so near a view of before; in short, I turned away my
face from the horrid spectacle; my stomach grew sick, and I was just at the
point of fainting, when nature discharged the disorder from my stomach; and
having vomited with uncommon violence, I was a little relieved, but could not
bear to stay in the place a moment; so I got up the hill again with all the
speed I could, and walked on towards my own habitation.
When I came a little out of that part of the island I stood still awhile, as
amazed, and then, recovering myself, I looked up with the utmost affection of
my soul, and, with a flood of tears in my eyes, gave God thanks, that had cast
my first lot in a part of the world where I was distinguished from such
dreadful creatures as these; and that, though I had esteemed my present
condition very miserable, had yet given me so many comforts in it that I had
still more to give thanks for than to complain of: and this, above all, that I
had, even in this miserable condition, been comforted with the knowledge of
Himself, and the hope of His blessing: which was a felicity more than
sufficiently equivalent to all the misery which I had suffered, or could
suffer.
In this frame of thankfulness I went home to my castle, and began to be much
easier now, as to the safety of my circumstances, than ever I was before: for I
observed that these wretches never came to this island in search of what they
could get; perhaps not seeking, not wanting, or not expecting anything here;
and having often, no doubt, been up the covered, woody part of it without
finding anything to their purpose. I knew I had been here now almost eighteen
years, and never saw the least footsteps of human creature there before; and I
might be eighteen years more as entirely concealed as I was now, if I did not
discover myself to them, which I had no manner of occasion to do; it being my
only business to keep myself entirely concealed where I was, unless I found a
better sort of creatures than cannibals to make myself known to. Yet I
entertained such an abhorrence of the savage wretches that I have been speaking
of, and of the wretched, inhuman custom of their devouring and eating one
another up, that I continued pensive and sad, and kept close within my own
circle for almost two years after this: when I say my own circle, I mean by it
my three plantations—viz. my castle, my country seat (which I called my
bower), and my enclosure in the woods: nor did I look after this for any other
use than an enclosure for my goats; for the aversion which nature gave me to
these hellish wretches was such, that I was as fearful of seeing them as of
seeing the devil himself. I did not so much as go to look after my boat all
this time, but began rather to think of making another; for I could not think
of ever making any more attempts to bring the other boat round the island to
me, lest I should meet with some of these creatures at sea; in which case, if I
had happened to have fallen into their hands, I knew what would have been my
lot.
Time, however, and the satisfaction I had that I was in no danger of being
discovered by these people, began to wear off my uneasiness about them; and I
began to live just in the same composed manner as before, only with this
difference, that I used more caution, and kept my eyes more about me than I did
before, lest I should happen to be seen by any of them; and particularly, I was
more cautious of firing my gun, lest any of them, being on the island, should
happen to hear it. It was, therefore, a very good providence to me that I had
furnished myself with a tame breed of goats, and that I had no need to hunt any
more about the woods, or shoot at them; and if I did catch any of them after
this, it was by traps and snares, as I had done before; so that for two years
after this I believe I never fired my gun once off, though I never went out
without it; and what was more, as I had saved three pistols out of the ship, I
always carried them out with me, or at least two of them, sticking them in my
goat-skin belt. I also furbished up one of the great cutlasses that I had out
of the ship, and made me a belt to hang it on also; so that I was now a most
formidable fellow to look at when I went abroad, if you add to the former
description of myself the particular of two pistols, and a broadsword hanging
at my side in a belt, but without a scabbard.
Things going on thus, as I have said, for some time, I seemed, excepting these
cautions, to be reduced to my former calm, sedate way of living. All these
things tended to show me more and more how far my condition was from being
miserable, compared to some others; nay, to many other particulars of life
which it might have pleased God to have made my lot. It put me upon reflecting
how little repining there would be among mankind at any condition of life if
people would rather compare their condition with those that were worse, in
order to be thankful, than be always comparing them with those which are
better, to assist their murmurings and complainings.
As in my present condition there were not really many things which I wanted, so
indeed I thought that the frights I had been in about these savage wretches,
and the concern I had been in for my own preservation, had taken off the edge
of my invention, for my own conveniences; and I had dropped a good design,
which I had once bent my thoughts upon, and that was to try if I could not make
some of my barley into malt, and then try to brew myself some beer. This was
really a whimsical thought, and I reproved myself often for the simplicity of
it: for I presently saw there would be the want of several things necessary to
the making my beer that it would be impossible for me to supply; as, first,
casks to preserve it in, which was a thing that, as I have observed already, I
could never compass: no, though I spent not only many days, but weeks, nay
months, in attempting it, but to no purpose. In the next place, I had no hops
to make it keep, no yeast to make it work, no copper or kettle to make it boil;
and yet with all these things wanting, I verily believe, had not the frights
and terrors I was in about the savages intervened, I had undertaken it, and
perhaps brought it to pass too; for I seldom gave anything over without
accomplishing it, when once I had it in my head to began it. But my invention
now ran quite another way; for night and day I could think of nothing but how I
might destroy some of the monsters in their cruel, bloody entertainment, and if
possible save the victim they should bring hither to destroy. It would take up
a larger volume than this whole work is intended to be to set down all the
contrivances I hatched, or rather brooded upon, in my thoughts, for the
destroying these creatures, or at least frightening them so as to prevent their
coming hither any more: but all this was abortive; nothing could be possible to
take effect, unless I was to be there to do it myself: and what could one man
do among them, when perhaps there might be twenty or thirty of them together
with their darts, or their bows and arrows, with which they could shoot as true
to a mark as I could with my gun?
Sometimes I thought of digging a hole under the place where they made their
fire, and putting in five or six pounds of gunpowder, which, when they kindled
their fire, would consequently take fire, and blow up all that was near it: but
as, in the first place, I should be unwilling to waste so much powder upon
them, my store being now within the quantity of one barrel, so neither could I
be sure of its going off at any certain time, when it might surprise them; and,
at best, that it would do little more than just blow the fire about their ears
and fright them, but not sufficient to make them forsake the place: so I laid
it aside; and then proposed that I would place myself in ambush in some
convenient place, with my three guns all double-loaded, and in the middle of
their bloody ceremony let fly at them, when I should be sure to kill or wound
perhaps two or three at every shot; and then falling in upon them with my three
pistols and my sword, I made no doubt but that, if there were twenty, I should
kill them all. This fancy pleased my thoughts for some weeks, and I was so full
of it that I often dreamed of it, and, sometimes, that I was just going to let
fly at them in my sleep. I went so far with it in my imagination that I
employed myself several days to find out proper places to put myself in
ambuscade, as I said, to watch for them, and I went frequently to the place
itself, which was now grown more familiar to me; but while my mind was thus
filled with thoughts of revenge and a bloody putting twenty or thirty of them
to the sword, as I may call it, the horror I had at the place, and at the
signals of the barbarous wretches devouring one another, abetted my malice.
Well, at length I found a place in the side of the hill where I was satisfied I
might securely wait till I saw any of their boats coming; and might then, even
before they would be ready to come on shore, convey myself unseen into some
thickets of trees, in one of which there was a hollow large enough to conceal
me entirely; and there I might sit and observe all their bloody doings, and
take my full aim at their heads, when they were so close together as that it
would be next to impossible that I should miss my shot, or that I could fail
wounding three or four of them at the first shot. In this place, then, I
resolved to fulfil my design; and accordingly I prepared two muskets and my
ordinary fowling-piece. The two muskets I loaded with a brace of slugs each,
and four or five smaller bullets, about the size of pistol bullets; and the
fowling-piece I loaded with near a handful of swan-shot of the largest size; I
also loaded my pistols with about four bullets each; and, in this posture, well
provided with ammunition for a second and third charge, I prepared myself for
my expedition.
After I had thus laid the scheme of my design, and in my imagination put it in
practice, I continually made my tour every morning to the top of the hill,
which was from my castle, as I called it, about three miles or more, to see if
I could observe any boats upon the sea, coming near the island, or standing
over towards it; but I began to tire of this hard duty, after I had for two or
three months constantly kept my watch, but came always back without any
discovery; there having not, in all that time, been the least appearance, not
only on or near the shore, but on the whole ocean, so far as my eye or glass
could reach every way.
As long as I kept my daily tour to the hill, to look out, so long also I kept
up the vigour of my design, and my spirits seemed to be all the while in a
suitable frame for so outrageous an execution as the killing twenty or thirty
naked savages, for an offence which I had not at all entered into any
discussion of in my thoughts, any farther than my passions were at first fired
by the horror I conceived at the unnatural custom of the people of that
country, who, it seems, had been suffered by Providence, in His wise
disposition of the world, to have no other guide than that of their own
abominable and vitiated passions; and consequently were left, and perhaps had
been so for some ages, to act such horrid things, and receive such dreadful
customs, as nothing but nature, entirely abandoned by Heaven, and actuated by
some hellish degeneracy, could have run them into. But now, when, as I have
said, I began to be weary of the fruitless excursion which I had made so long
and so far every morning in vain, so my opinion of the action itself began to
alter; and I began, with cooler and calmer thoughts, to consider what I was
going to engage in; what authority or call I had to pretend to be judge and
executioner upon these men as criminals, whom Heaven had thought fit for so
many ages to suffer unpunished to go on, and to be as it were the executioners
of His judgments one upon another; how far these people were offenders against
me, and what right I had to engage in the quarrel of that blood which they shed
promiscuously upon one another. I debated this very often with myself thus:
“How do I know what God Himself judges in this particular case? It is
certain these people do not commit this as a crime; it is not against their own
consciences reproving, or their light reproaching them; they do not know it to
be an offence, and then commit it in defiance of divine justice, as we do in
almost all the sins we commit. They think it no more a crime to kill a captive
taken in war than we do to kill an ox; or to eat human flesh than we do to eat
mutton.”
When I considered this a little, it followed necessarily that I was certainly
in the wrong; that these people were not murderers, in the sense that I had
before condemned them in my thoughts, any more than those Christians were
murderers who often put to death the prisoners taken in battle; or more
frequently, upon many occasions, put whole troops of men to the sword, without
giving quarter, though they threw down their arms and submitted. In the next
place, it occurred to me that although the usage they gave one another was thus
brutish and inhuman, yet it was really nothing to me: these people had done me
no injury: that if they attempted, or I saw it necessary, for my immediate
preservation, to fall upon them, something might be said for it: but that I was
yet out of their power, and they really had no knowledge of me, and
consequently no design upon me; and therefore it could not be just for me to
fall upon them; that this would justify the conduct of the Spaniards in all
their barbarities practised in America, where they destroyed millions of these
people; who, however they were idolators and barbarians, and had several bloody
and barbarous rites in their customs, such as sacrificing human bodies to their
idols, were yet, as to the Spaniards, very innocent people; and that the
rooting them out of the country is spoken of with the utmost abhorrence and
detestation by even the Spaniards themselves at this time, and by all other
Christian nations of Europe, as a mere butchery, a bloody and unnatural piece
of cruelty, unjustifiable either to God or man; and for which the very name of
a Spaniard is reckoned to be frightful and terrible, to all people of humanity
or of Christian compassion; as if the kingdom of Spain were particularly
eminent for the produce of a race of men who were without principles of
tenderness, or the common bowels of pity to the miserable, which is reckoned to
be a mark of generous temper in the mind.
These considerations really put me to a pause, and to a kind of a full stop;
and I began by little and little to be off my design, and to conclude I had
taken wrong measures in my resolution to attack the savages; and that it was
not my business to meddle with them, unless they first attacked me; and this it
was my business, if possible, to prevent: but that, if I were discovered and
attacked by them, I knew my duty. On the other hand, I argued with myself that
this really was the way not to deliver myself, but entirely to ruin and destroy
myself; for unless I was sure to kill every one that not only should be on
shore at that time, but that should ever come on shore afterwards, if but one
of them escaped to tell their country-people what had happened, they would come
over again by thousands to revenge the death of their fellows, and I should
only bring upon myself a certain destruction, which, at present, I had no
manner of occasion for. Upon the whole, I concluded that I ought, neither in
principle nor in policy, one way or other, to concern myself in this affair:
that my business was, by all possible means to conceal myself from them, and
not to leave the least sign for them to guess by that there were any living
creatures upon the island—I mean of human shape. Religion joined in with
this prudential resolution; and I was convinced now, many ways, that I was
perfectly out of my duty when I was laying all my bloody schemes for the
destruction of innocent creatures—I mean innocent as to me. As to the
crimes they were guilty of towards one another, I had nothing to do with them;
they were national, and I ought to leave them to the justice of God, who is the
Governor of nations, and knows how, by national punishments, to make a just
retribution for national offences, and to bring public judgments upon those who
offend in a public manner, by such ways as best please Him. This appeared so
clear to me now, that nothing was a greater satisfaction to me than that I had
not been suffered to do a thing which I now saw so much reason to believe would
have been no less a sin than that of wilful murder if I had committed it; and I
gave most humble thanks on my knees to God, that He had thus delivered me from
blood-guiltiness; beseeching Him to grant me the protection of His providence,
that I might not fall into the hands of the barbarians, or that I might not lay
my hands upon them, unless I had a more clear call from Heaven to do it, in
defence of my own life.
In this disposition I continued for near a year after this; and so far was I
from desiring an occasion for falling upon these wretches, that in all that
time I never once went up the hill to see whether there were any of them in
sight, or to know whether any of them had been on shore there or not, that I
might not be tempted to renew any of my contrivances against them, or be
provoked by any advantage that might present itself to fall upon them; only
this I did: I went and removed my boat, which I had on the other side of the
island, and carried it down to the east end of the whole island, where I ran it
into a little cove, which I found under some high rocks, and where I knew, by
reason of the currents, the savages durst not, at least would not, come with
their boats upon any account whatever. With my boat I carried away everything
that I had left there belonging to her, though not necessary for the bare going
thither—viz. a mast and sail which I had made for her, and a thing like
an anchor, but which, indeed, could not be called either anchor or grapnel;
however, it was the best I could make of its kind: all these I removed, that
there might not be the least shadow for discovery, or appearance of any boat,
or of any human habitation upon the island. Besides this, I kept myself, as I
said, more retired than ever, and seldom went from my cell except upon my
constant employment, to milk my she-goats, and manage my little flock in the
wood, which, as it was quite on the other part of the island, was out of
danger; for certain, it is that these savage people, who sometimes haunted this
island, never came with any thoughts of finding anything here, and consequently
never wandered off from the coast, and I doubt not but they might have been
several times on shore after my apprehensions of them had made me cautious, as
well as before. Indeed, I looked back with some horror upon the thoughts of
what my condition would have been if I had chopped upon them and been
discovered before that; when, naked and unarmed, except with one gun, and that
loaded often only with small shot, I walked everywhere, peeping and peering
about the island, to see what I could get; what a surprise should I have been
in if, when I discovered the print of a man’s foot, I had, instead of
that, seen fifteen or twenty savages, and found them pursuing me, and by the
swiftness of their running no possibility of my escaping them! The thoughts of
this sometimes sank my very soul within me, and distressed my mind so much that
I could not soon recover it, to think what I should have done, and how I should
not only have been unable to resist them, but even should not have had presence
of mind enough to do what I might have done; much less what now, after so much
consideration and preparation, I might be able to do. Indeed, after serious
thinking of these things, I would be melancholy, and sometimes it would last a
great while; but I resolved it all at last into thankfulness to that Providence
which had delivered me from so many unseen dangers, and had kept me from those
mischiefs which I could have no way been the agent in delivering myself from,
because I had not the least notion of any such thing depending, or the least
supposition of its being possible. This renewed a contemplation which often had
come into my thoughts in former times, when first I began to see the merciful
dispositions of Heaven, in the dangers we run through in this life; how
wonderfully we are delivered when we know nothing of it; how, when we are in a
quandary as we call it, a doubt or hesitation whether to go this way or that
way, a secret hint shall direct us this way, when we intended to go that way:
nay, when sense, our own inclination, and perhaps business has called us to go
the other way, yet a strange impression upon the mind, from we know not what
springs, and by we know not what power, shall overrule us to go this way; and
it shall afterwards appear that had we gone that way, which we should have
gone, and even to our imagination ought to have gone, we should have been
ruined and lost. Upon these and many like reflections I afterwards made it a
certain rule with me, that whenever I found those secret hints or pressings of
mind to doing or not doing anything that presented, or going this way or that
way, I never failed to obey the secret dictate; though I knew no other reason
for it than such a pressure or such a hint hung upon my mind. I could give many
examples of the success of this conduct in the course of my life, but more
especially in the latter part of my inhabiting this unhappy island; besides
many occasions which it is very likely I might have taken notice of, if I had
seen with the same eyes then that I see with now. But it is never too late to
be wise; and I cannot but advise all considering men, whose lives are attended
with such extraordinary incidents as mine, or even though not so extraordinary,
not to slight such secret intimations of Providence, let them come from what
invisible intelligence they will. That I shall not discuss, and perhaps cannot
account for; but certainly they are a proof of the converse of spirits, and a
secret communication between those embodied and those unembodied, and such a
proof as can never be withstood; of which I shall have occasion to give some
remarkable instances in the remainder of my solitary residence in this dismal
place.
I believe the reader of this will not think it strange if I confess that these
anxieties, these constant dangers I lived in, and the concern that was now upon
me, put an end to all invention, and to all the contrivances that I had laid
for my future accommodations and conveniences. I had the care of my safety more
now upon my hands than that of my food. I cared not to drive a nail, or chop a
stick of wood now, for fear the noise I might make should be heard: much less
would I fire a gun for the same reason: and above all I was intolerably uneasy
at making any fire, lest the smoke, which is visible at a great distance in the
day, should betray me. For this reason, I removed that part of my business
which required fire, such as burning of pots and pipes, &c., into my new
apartment in the woods; where, after I had been some time, I found, to my
unspeakable consolation, a mere natural cave in the earth, which went in a vast
way, and where, I daresay, no savage, had he been at the mouth of it, would be
so hardy as to venture in; nor, indeed, would any man else, but one who, like
me, wanted nothing so much as a safe retreat.
The mouth of this hollow was at the bottom of a great rock, where, by mere
accident (I would say, if I did not see abundant reason to ascribe all such
things now to Providence), I was cutting down some thick branches of trees to
make charcoal; and before I go on I must observe the reason of my making this
charcoal, which was this—I was afraid of making a smoke about my
habitation, as I said before; and yet I could not live there without baking my
bread, cooking my meat, &c.; so I contrived to burn some wood here, as I
had seen done in England, under turf, till it became chark or dry coal: and
then putting the fire out, I preserved the coal to carry home, and perform the
other services for which fire was wanting, without danger of smoke. But this is
by-the-bye. While I was cutting down some wood here, I perceived that, behind a
very thick branch of low brushwood or underwood, there was a kind of hollow
place: I was curious to look in it; and getting with difficulty into the mouth
of it, I found it was pretty large, that is to say, sufficient for me to stand
upright in it, and perhaps another with me: but I must confess to you that I
made more haste out than I did in, when looking farther into the place, and
which was perfectly dark, I saw two broad shining eyes of some creature,
whether devil or man I knew not, which twinkled like two stars; the dim light
from the cave’s mouth shining directly in, and making the reflection.
However, after some pause I recovered myself, and began to call myself a
thousand fools, and to think that he that was afraid to see the devil was not
fit to live twenty years in an island all alone; and that I might well think
there was nothing in this cave that was more frightful than myself. Upon this,
plucking up my courage, I took up a firebrand, and in I rushed again, with the
stick flaming in my hand: I had not gone three steps in before I was almost as
frightened as before; for I heard a very loud sigh, like that of a man in some
pain, and it was followed by a broken noise, as of words half expressed, and
then a deep sigh again. I stepped back, and was indeed struck with such a
surprise that it put me into a cold sweat, and if I had had a hat on my head, I
will not answer for it that my hair might not have lifted it off. But still
plucking up my spirits as well as I could, and encouraging myself a little with
considering that the power and presence of God was everywhere, and was able to
protect me, I stepped forward again, and by the light of the firebrand, holding
it up a little over my head, I saw lying on the ground a monstrous, frightful
old he-goat, just making his will, as we say, and gasping for life, and, dying,
indeed, of mere old age. I stirred him a little to see if I could get him out,
and he essayed to get up, but was not able to raise himself; and I thought with
myself he might even lie there—for if he had frightened me, so he would
certainly fright any of the savages, if any of them should be so hardy as to
come in there while he had any life in him.
I was now recovered from my surprise, and began to look round me, when I found
the cave was but very small—that is to say, it might be about twelve feet
over, but in no manner of shape, neither round nor square, no hands having ever
been employed in making it but those of mere Nature. I observed also that there
was a place at the farther side of it that went in further, but was so low that
it required me to creep upon my hands and knees to go into it, and whither it
went I knew not; so, having no candle, I gave it over for that time, but
resolved to go again the next day provided with candles and a tinder-box, which
I had made of the lock of one of the muskets, with some wildfire in the pan.
Accordingly, the next day I came provided with six large candles of my own
making (for I made very good candles now of goat’s tallow, but was hard
set for candle-wick, using sometimes rags or rope-yarn, and sometimes the dried
rind of a weed like nettles); and going into this low place I was obliged to
creep upon all-fours as I have said, almost ten yards—which, by the way,
I thought was a venture bold enough, considering that I knew not how far it
might go, nor what was beyond it. When I had got through the strait, I found
the roof rose higher up, I believe near twenty feet; but never was such a
glorious sight seen in the island, I daresay, as it was to look round the sides
and roof of this vault or cave—the wall reflected a hundred thousand
lights to me from my two candles. What it was in the rock—whether
diamonds or any other precious stones, or gold which I rather supposed it to
be—I knew not. The place I was in was a most delightful cavity, or
grotto, though perfectly dark; the floor was dry and level, and had a sort of a
small loose gravel upon it, so that there was no nauseous or venomous creature
to be seen, neither was there any damp or wet on the sides or roof. The only
difficulty in it was the entrance—which, however, as it was a place of
security, and such a retreat as I wanted; I thought was a convenience; so that
I was really rejoiced at the discovery, and resolved, without any delay, to
bring some of those things which I was most anxious about to this place:
particularly, I resolved to bring hither my magazine of powder, and all my
spare arms—viz. two fowling-pieces—for I had three in all—and
three muskets—for of them I had eight in all; so I kept in my castle only
five, which stood ready mounted like pieces of cannon on my outmost fence, and
were ready also to take out upon any expedition. Upon this occasion of removing
my ammunition I happened to open the barrel of powder which I took up out of
the sea, and which had been wet, and I found that the water had penetrated
about three or four inches into the powder on every side, which caking and
growing hard, had preserved the inside like a kernel in the shell, so that I
had near sixty pounds of very good powder in the centre of the cask. This was a
very agreeable discovery to me at that time; so I carried all away thither,
never keeping above two or three pounds of powder with me in my castle, for
fear of a surprise of any kind; I also carried thither all the lead I had left
for bullets.
I fancied myself now like one of the ancient giants who were said to live in
caves and holes in the rocks, where none could come at them; for I persuaded
myself, while I was here, that if five hundred savages were to hunt me, they
could never find me out—or if they did, they would not venture to attack
me here. The old goat whom I found expiring died in the mouth of the cave the
next day after I made this discovery; and I found it much easier to dig a great
hole there, and throw him in and cover him with earth, than to drag him out; so
I interred him there, to prevent offence to my nose.
CHAPTER XIII.
WRECK OF A SPANISH SHIP
I was now in the twenty-third year of my residence in this island, and was so
naturalised to the place and the manner of living, that, could I but have
enjoyed the certainty that no savages would come to the place to disturb me, I
could have been content to have capitulated for spending the rest of my time
there, even to the last moment, till I had laid me down and died, like the old
goat in the cave. I had also arrived to some little diversions and amusements,
which made the time pass a great deal more pleasantly with me than it did
before—first, I had taught my Poll, as I noted before, to speak; and he
did it so familiarly, and talked so articulately and plain, that it was very
pleasant to me; and he lived with me no less than six-and-twenty years. How
long he might have lived afterwards I know not, though I know they have a
notion in the Brazils that they live a hundred years. My dog was a pleasant and
loving companion to me for no less than sixteen years of my time, and then died
of mere old age. As for my cats, they multiplied, as I have observed, to that
degree that I was obliged to shoot several of them at first, to keep them from
devouring me and all I had; but at length, when the two old ones I brought with
me were gone, and after some time continually driving them from me, and letting
them have no provision with me, they all ran wild into the woods, except two or
three favourites, which I kept tame, and whose young, when they had any, I
always drowned; and these were part of my family. Besides these I always kept
two or three household kids about me, whom I taught to feed out of my hand; and
I had two more parrots, which talked pretty well, and would all call
“Robin Crusoe,” but none like my first; nor, indeed, did I take the
pains with any of them that I had done with him. I had also several tame
sea-fowls, whose name I knew not, that I caught upon the shore, and cut their
wings; and the little stakes which I had planted before my castle-wall being
now grown up to a good thick grove, these fowls all lived among these low
trees, and bred there, which was very agreeable to me; so that, as I said
above, I began to be very well contented with the life I led, if I could have
been secured from the dread of the savages. But it was otherwise directed; and
it may not be amiss for all people who shall meet with my story to make this
just observation from it: How frequently, in the course of our lives, the evil
which in itself we seek most to shun, and which, when we are fallen into, is
the most dreadful to us, is oftentimes the very means or door of our
deliverance, by which alone we can be raised again from the affliction we are
fallen into. I could give many examples of this in the course of my
unaccountable life; but in nothing was it more particularly remarkable than in
the circumstances of my last years of solitary residence in this island.
It was now the month of December, as I said above, in my twenty-third year; and
this, being the southern solstice (for winter I cannot call it), was the
particular time of my harvest, and required me to be pretty much abroad in the
fields, when, going out early in the morning, even before it was thorough
daylight, I was surprised with seeing a light of some fire upon the shore, at a
distance from me of about two miles, toward that part of the island where I had
observed some savages had been, as before, and not on the other side; but, to
my great affliction, it was on my side of the island.
I was indeed terribly surprised at the sight, and stopped short within my
grove, not daring to go out, lest I might be surprised; and yet I had no more
peace within, from the apprehensions I had that if these savages, in rambling
over the island, should find my corn standing or cut, or any of my works or
improvements, they would immediately conclude that there were people in the
place, and would then never rest till they had found me out. In this extremity
I went back directly to my castle, pulled up the ladder after me, and made all
things without look as wild and natural as I could.
Then I prepared myself within, putting myself in a posture of defence. I loaded
all my cannon, as I called them—that is to say, my muskets, which were
mounted upon my new fortification—and all my pistols, and resolved to
defend myself to the last gasp—not forgetting seriously to commend myself
to the Divine protection, and earnestly to pray to God to deliver me out of the
hands of the barbarians. I continued in this posture about two hours, and began
to be impatient for intelligence abroad, for I had no spies to send out. After
sitting a while longer, and musing what I should do in this case, I was not
able to bear sitting in ignorance longer; so setting up my ladder to the side
of the hill, where there was a flat place, as I observed before, and then
pulling the ladder after me, I set it up again and mounted the top of the hill,
and pulling out my perspective glass, which I had taken on purpose, I laid me
down flat on my belly on the ground, and began to look for the place. I
presently found there were no less than nine naked savages sitting round a
small fire they had made, not to warm them, for they had no need of that, the
weather being extremely hot, but, as I supposed, to dress some of their
barbarous diet of human flesh which they had brought with them, whether alive
or dead I could not tell.
They had two canoes with them, which they had hauled up upon the shore; and as
it was then ebb of tide, they seemed to me to wait for the return of the flood
to go away again. It is not easy to imagine what confusion this sight put me
into, especially seeing them come on my side of the island, and so near to me;
but when I considered their coming must be always with the current of the ebb,
I began afterwards to be more sedate in my mind, being satisfied that I might
go abroad with safety all the time of the flood of tide, if they were not on
shore before; and having made this observation, I went abroad about my harvest
work with the more composure.
As I expected, so it proved; for as soon as the tide made to the westward I saw
them all take boat and row (or paddle as we call it) away. I should have
observed, that for an hour or more before they went off they were dancing, and
I could easily discern their postures and gestures by my glass. I could not
perceive, by my nicest observation, but that they were stark naked, and had not
the least covering upon them; but whether they were men or women I could not
distinguish.
As soon as I saw them shipped and gone, I took two guns upon my shoulders, and
two pistols in my girdle, and my great sword by my side without a scabbard, and
with all the speed I was able to make went away to the hill where I had
discovered the first appearance of all; and as soon as I got thither, which was
not in less than two hours (for I could not go quickly, being so loaded with
arms as I was), I perceived there had been three canoes more of the savages at
that place; and looking out farther, I saw they were all at sea together,
making over for the main. This was a dreadful sight to me, especially as, going
down to the shore, I could see the marks of horror which the dismal work they
had been about had left behind it—viz. the blood, the bones, and part of
the flesh of human bodies eaten and devoured by those wretches with merriment
and sport. I was so filled with indignation at the sight, that I now began to
premeditate the destruction of the next that I saw there, let them be whom or
how many soever. It seemed evident to me that the visits which they made thus
to this island were not very frequent, for it was above fifteen months before
any more of them came on shore there again—that is to say, I neither saw
them nor any footsteps or signals of them in all that time; for as to the rainy
seasons, then they are sure not to come abroad, at least not so far. Yet all
this while I lived uncomfortably, by reason of the constant apprehensions of
their coming upon me by surprise: from whence I observe, that the expectation
of evil is more bitter than the suffering, especially if there is no room to
shake off that expectation or those apprehensions.
During all this time I was in a murdering humour, and spent most of my hours,
which should have been better employed, in contriving how to circumvent and
fall upon them the very next time I should see them—especially if they
should be divided, as they were the last time, into two parties; nor did I
consider at all that if I killed one party—suppose ten or a dozen—I
was still the next day, or week, or month, to kill another, and so another,
even , till I should be, at length, no less a murderer than
they were in being man-eaters—and perhaps much more so. I spent my days
now in great perplexity and anxiety of mind, expecting that I should one day or
other fall into the hands of these merciless creatures; and if I did at any
time venture abroad, it was not without looking around me with the greatest
care and caution imaginable. And now I found, to my great comfort, how happy it
was that I had provided a tame flock or herd of goats, for I durst not upon any
account fire my gun, especially near that side of the island where they usually
came, lest I should alarm the savages; and if they had fled from me now, I was
sure to have them come again with perhaps two or three hundred canoes with them
in a few days, and then I knew what to expect. However, I wore out a year and
three months more before I ever saw any more of the savages, and then I found
them again, as I shall soon observe. It is true they might have been there once
or twice; but either they made no stay, or at least I did not see them; but in
the month of May, as near as I could calculate, and in my four-and-twentieth
year, I had a very strange encounter with them; of which in its place.
The perturbation of my mind during this fifteen or sixteen months’
interval was very great; I slept unquietly, dreamed always frightful dreams,
and often started out of my sleep in the night. In the day great troubles
overwhelmed my mind; and in the night I dreamed often of killing the savages
and of the reasons why I might justify doing it.
But to waive all this for a while. It was in the middle of May, on the
sixteenth day, I think, as well as my poor wooden calendar would reckon, for I
marked all upon the post still; I say, it was on the sixteenth of May that it
blew a very great storm of wind all day, with a great deal of lightning and
thunder, and; a very foul night it was after it. I knew not what was the
particular occasion of it, but as I was reading in the Bible, and taken up with
very serious thoughts about my present condition, I was surprised with the
noise of a gun, as I thought, fired at sea. This was, to be sure, a surprise
quite of a different nature from any I had met with before; for the notions
this put into my thoughts were quite of another kind. I started up in the
greatest haste imaginable; and, in a trice, clapped my ladder to the middle
place of the rock, and pulled it after me; and mounting it the second time, got
to the top of the hill the very moment that a flash of fire bid me listen for a
second gun, which, accordingly, in about half a minute I heard; and by the
sound, knew that it was from that part of the sea where I was driven down the
current in my boat. I immediately considered that this must be some ship in
distress, and that they had some comrade, or some other ship in company, and
fired these for signals of distress, and to obtain help. I had the presence of
mind at that minute to think, that though I could not help them, it might be
that they might help me; so I brought together all the dry wood I could get at
hand, and making a good handsome pile, I set it on fire upon the hill. The wood
was dry, and blazed freely; and, though the wind blew very hard, yet it burned
fairly out; so that I was certain, if there was any such thing as a ship, they
must needs see it. And no doubt they did; for as soon as ever my fire blazed
up, I heard another gun, and after that several others, all from the same
quarter. I plied my fire all night long, till daybreak: and when it was broad
day, and the air cleared up, I saw something at a great distance at sea, full
east of the island, whether a sail or a hull I could not distinguish—no,
not with my glass: the distance was so great, and the weather still something
hazy also; at least, it was so out at sea.
I looked frequently at it all that day, and soon perceived that it did not
move; so I presently concluded that it was a ship at anchor; and being eager,
you may be sure, to be satisfied, I took my gun in my hand, and ran towards the
south side of the island to the rocks where I had formerly been carried away by
the current; and getting up there, the weather by this time being perfectly
clear, I could plainly see, to my great sorrow, the wreck of a ship, cast away
in the night upon those concealed rocks which I found when I was out in my
boat; and which rocks, as they checked the violence of the stream, and made a
kind of counter-stream, or eddy, were the occasion of my recovering from the
most desperate, hopeless condition that ever I had been in in all my life.
Thus, what is one man’s safety is another man’s destruction; for it
seems these men, whoever they were, being out of their knowledge, and the rocks
being wholly under water, had been driven upon them in the night, the wind
blowing hard at ENE. Had they seen the island, as I must necessarily suppose
they did not, they must, as I thought, have endeavoured to have saved
themselves on shore by the help of their boat; but their firing off guns for
help, especially when they saw, as I imagined, my fire, filled me with many
thoughts. First, I imagined that upon seeing my light they might have put
themselves into their boat, and endeavoured to make the shore: but that the sea
running very high, they might have been cast away. Other times I imagined that
they might have lost their boat before, as might be the case many ways;
particularly by the breaking of the sea upon their ship, which many times
obliged men to stave, or take in pieces, their boat, and sometimes to throw it
overboard with their own hands. Other times I imagined they had some other ship
or ships in company, who, upon the signals of distress they made, had taken
them up, and carried them off. Other times I fancied they were all gone off to
sea in their boat, and being hurried away by the current that I had been
formerly in, were carried out into the great ocean, where there was nothing but
misery and perishing: and that, perhaps, they might by this time think of
starving, and of being in a condition to eat one another.
As all these were but conjectures at best, so, in the condition I was in, I
could do no more than look on upon the misery of the poor men, and pity them;
which had still this good effect upon my side, that it gave me more and more
cause to give thanks to God, who had so happily and comfortably provided for me
in my desolate condition; and that of two ships’ companies, who were now
cast away upon this part of the world, not one life should be spared but mine.
I learned here again to observe, that it is very rare that the providence of
God casts us into any condition so low, or any misery so great, but we may see
something or other to be thankful for, and may see others in worse
circumstances than our own. Such certainly was the case of these men, of whom I
could not so much as see room to suppose any were saved; nothing could make it
rational so much as to wish or expect that they did not all perish there,
except the possibility only of their being taken up by another ship in company;
and this was but mere possibility indeed, for I saw not the least sign or
appearance of any such thing. I cannot explain, by any possible energy of
words, what a strange longing I felt in my soul upon this sight, breaking out
sometimes thus: “Oh that there had been but one or two, nay, or but one
soul saved out of this ship, to have escaped to me, that I might but have had
one companion, one fellow-creature, to have spoken to me and to have conversed
with!” In all the time of my solitary life I never felt so earnest, so
strong a desire after the society of my fellow-creatures, or so deep a regret
at the want of it.
There are some secret springs in the affections which, when they are set
a-going by some object in view, or, though not in view, yet rendered present to
the mind by the power of imagination, that motion carries out the soul, by its
impetuosity, to such violent, eager embracings of the object, that the absence
of it is insupportable. Such were these earnest wishings that but one man had
been saved. I believe I repeated the words, “Oh that it had been but
one!” a thousand times; and my desires were so moved by it, that when I
spoke the words my hands would clinch together, and my fingers would press the
palms of my hands, so that if I had had any soft thing in my hand I should have
crushed it involuntarily; and the teeth in my head would strike together, and
set against one another so strong, that for some time I could not part them
again. Let the naturalists explain these things, and the reason and manner of
them. All I can do is to describe the fact, which was even surprising to me
when I found it, though I knew not from whence it proceeded; it was doubtless
the effect of ardent wishes, and of strong ideas formed in my mind, realising
the comfort which the conversation of one of my fellow-Christians would have
been to me. But it was not to be; either their fate or mine, or both, forbade
it; for, till the last year of my being on this island, I never knew whether
any were saved out of that ship or no; and had only the affliction, some days
after, to see the corpse of a drowned boy come on shore at the end of the
island which was next the shipwreck. He had no clothes on but a seaman’s
waistcoat, a pair of open-kneed linen drawers, and a blue linen shirt; but
nothing to direct me so much as to guess what nation he was of. He had nothing
in his pockets but two pieces of eight and a tobacco pipe—the last was to
me of ten times more value than the first.
It was now calm, and I had a great mind to venture out in my boat to this
wreck, not doubting but I might find something on board that might be useful to
me. But that did not altogether press me so much as the possibility that there
might be yet some living creature on board, whose life I might not only save,
but might, by saving that life, comfort my own to the last degree; and this
thought clung so to my heart that I could not be quiet night or day, but I must
venture out in my boat on board this wreck; and committing the rest to
God’s providence, I thought the impression was so strong upon my mind
that it could not be resisted—that it must come from some invisible
direction, and that I should be wanting to myself if I did not go.
Under the power of this impression, I hastened back to my castle, prepared
everything for my voyage, took a quantity of bread, a great pot of fresh water,
a compass to steer by, a bottle of rum (for I had still a great deal of that
left), and a basket of raisins; and thus, loading myself with everything
necessary. I went down to my boat, got the water out of her, got her afloat,
loaded all my cargo in her, and then went home again for more. My second cargo
was a great bag of rice, the umbrella to set up over my head for a shade,
another large pot of water, and about two dozen of small loaves, or barley
cakes, more than before, with a bottle of goat’s milk and a cheese; all
which with great labour and sweat I carried to my boat; and praying to God to
direct my voyage, I put out, and rowing or paddling the canoe along the shore,
came at last to the utmost point of the island on the north-east side. And now
I was to launch out into the ocean, and either to venture or not to venture. I
looked on the rapid currents which ran constantly on both sides of the island
at a distance, and which were very terrible to me from the remembrance of the
hazard I had been in before, and my heart began to fail me; for I foresaw that
if I was driven into either of those currents, I should be carried a great way
out to sea, and perhaps out of my reach or sight of the island again; and that
then, as my boat was but small, if any little gale of wind should rise, I
should be inevitably lost.
These thoughts so oppressed my mind that I began to give over my enterprise;
and having hauled my boat into a little creek on the shore, I stepped out, and
sat down upon a rising bit of ground, very pensive and anxious, between fear
and desire, about my voyage; when, as I was musing, I could perceive that the
tide was turned, and the flood come on; upon which my going was impracticable
for so many hours. Upon this, presently it occurred to me that I should go up
to the highest piece of ground I could find, and observe, if I could, how the
sets of the tide or currents lay when the flood came in, that I might judge
whether, if I was driven one way out, I might not expect to be driven another
way home, with the same rapidity of the currents. This thought was no sooner in
my head than I cast my eye upon a little hill which sufficiently overlooked the
sea both ways, and from whence I had a clear view of the currents or sets of
the tide, and which way I was to guide myself in my return. Here I found, that
as the current of ebb set out close by the south point of the island, so the
current of the flood set in close by the shore of the north side; and that I
had nothing to do but to keep to the north side of the island in my return, and
I should do well enough.
Encouraged by this observation, I resolved the next morning to set out with the
first of the tide; and reposing myself for the night in my canoe, under the
watch-coat I mentioned, I launched out. I first made a little out to sea, full
north, till I began to feel the benefit of the current, which set eastward, and
which carried me at a great rate; and yet did not so hurry me as the current on
the south side had done before, so as to take from me all government of the
boat; but having a strong steerage with my paddle, I went at a great rate
directly for the wreck, and in less than two hours I came up to it. It was a
dismal sight to look at; the ship, which by its building was Spanish, stuck
fast, jammed in between two rocks. All the stern and quarter of her were beaten
to pieces by the sea; and as her forecastle, which stuck in the rocks, had run
on with great violence, her mainmast and foremast were brought by the
board—that is to say, broken short off; but her bowsprit was sound, and
the head and bow appeared firm. When I came close to her, a dog appeared upon
her, who, seeing me coming, yelped and cried; and as soon as I called him,
jumped into the sea to come to me. I took him into the boat, but found him
almost dead with hunger and thirst. I gave him a cake of my bread, and he
devoured it like a ravenous wolf that had been starving a fortnight in the
snow; I then gave the poor creature some fresh water, with which, if I would
have let him, he would have burst himself. After this I went on board; but the
first sight I met with was two men drowned in the cook-room, or forecastle of
the ship, with their arms fast about one another. I concluded, as is indeed
probable, that when the ship struck, it being in a storm, the sea broke so high
and so continually over her, that the men were not able to bear it, and were
strangled with the constant rushing in of the water, as much as if they had
been under water. Besides the dog, there was nothing left in the ship that had
life; nor any goods, that I could see, but what were spoiled by the water.
There were some casks of liquor, whether wine or brandy I knew not, which lay
lower in the hold, and which, the water being ebbed out, I could see; but they
were too big to meddle with. I saw several chests, which I believe belonged to
some of the seamen; and I got two of them into the boat, without examining what
was in them. Had the stern of the ship been fixed, and the forepart broken off,
I am persuaded I might have made a good voyage; for by what I found in those
two chests I had room to suppose the ship had a great deal of wealth on board;
and, if I may guess from the course she steered, she must have been bound from
Buenos Ayres, or the Rio de la Plata, in the south part of America, beyond the
Brazils to the Havannah, in the Gulf of Mexico, and so perhaps to Spain. She
had, no doubt, a great treasure in her, but of no use, at that time, to
anybody; and what became of the crew I then knew not.
I found, besides these chests, a little cask full of liquor, of about twenty
gallons, which I got into my boat with much difficulty. There were several
muskets in the cabin, and a great powder-horn, with about four pounds of powder
in it; as for the muskets, I had no occasion for them, so I left them, but took
the powder-horn. I took a fire-shovel and tongs, which I wanted extremely, as
also two little brass kettles, a copper pot to make chocolate, and a gridiron;
and with this cargo, and the dog, I came away, the tide beginning to make home
again—and the same evening, about an hour within night, I reached the
island again, weary and fatigued to the last degree. I reposed that night in
the boat and in the morning I resolved to harbour what I had got in my new
cave, and not carry it home to my castle. After refreshing myself, I got all my
cargo on shore, and began to examine the particulars. The cask of liquor I
found to be a kind of rum, but not such as we had at the Brazils; and, in a
word, not at all good; but when I came to open the chests, I found several
things of great use to me—for example, I found in one a fine case of
bottles, of an extraordinary kind, and filled with cordial waters, fine and
very good; the bottles held about three pints each, and were tipped with
silver. I found two pots of very good succades, or sweetmeats, so fastened also
on the top that the salt-water had not hurt them; and two more of the same,
which the water had spoiled. I found some very good shirts, which were very
welcome to me; and about a dozen and a half of white linen handkerchiefs and
coloured neckcloths; the former were also very welcome, being exceedingly
refreshing to wipe my face in a hot day. Besides this, when I came to the till
in the chest, I found there three great bags of pieces of eight, which held
about eleven hundred pieces in all; and in one of them, wrapped up in a paper,
six doubloons of gold, and some small bars or wedges of gold; I suppose they
might all weigh near a pound. In the other chest were some clothes, but of
little value; but, by the circumstances, it must have belonged to the
gunner’s mate; though there was no powder in it, except two pounds of
fine glazed powder, in three flasks, kept, I suppose, for charging their
fowling-pieces on occasion. Upon the whole, I got very little by this voyage
that was of any use to me; for, as to the money, I had no manner of occasion
for it; it was to me as the dirt under my feet, and I would have given it all
for three or four pair of English shoes and stockings, which were things I
greatly wanted, but had had none on my feet for many years. I had, indeed, got
two pair of shoes now, which I took off the feet of two drowned men whom I saw
in the wreck, and I found two pair more in one of the chests, which were very
welcome to me; but they were not like our English shoes, either for ease or
service, being rather what we call pumps than shoes. I found in this
seaman’s chest about fifty pieces of eight, in rials, but no gold: I
supposed this belonged to a poorer man than the other, which seemed to belong
to some officer. Well, however, I lugged this money home to my cave, and laid
it up, as I had done that before which I had brought from our own ship; but it
was a great pity, as I said, that the other part of this ship had not come to
my share: for I am satisfied I might have loaded my canoe several times over
with money; and, thought I, if I ever escape to England, it might lie here safe
enough till I come again and fetch it.
CHAPTER XIV.
A DREAM REALISED
Having now brought all my things on shore and secured them, I went back to my boat, and rowed or paddled her along the shore to her old harbour, where I laid her up, and made the best of my way to my old habitation, where I found everything safe and quiet. I began now to repose myself, live after my old fashion, and take care of my family affairs; and for a while I lived easy enough, only that I was more vigilant than I used to be, looked out oftener, and did not go abroad so much; and if at any time I did stir with any freedom, it was always to the east part of the island, where I was pretty well satisfied the savages never came, and where I could go without so many precautions, and such a load of arms and ammunition as I always carried with me if I went the other way.
I lived in this condition near two years more; but my unlucky head, that was always to let me know it was born to make my body miserable, was all these two years filled with projects and designs how, if it were possible, I might get away from this island: for sometimes I was for making another voyage to the wreck, though my reason told me that there was nothing left there worth the hazard of my voyage; sometimes for a ramble one way, sometimes another—and I believe verily, if I had had the boat that I went from Sallee in, I should have ventured to sea, bound anywhere, I knew not whither.
I have been, in all my circumstances, a memento to those who are touched with the general plague of mankind, whence, for aught I know, one half of their miseries flow: I mean that of not being satisfied with the station wherein God and Nature hath placed them—for, not to look back upon my primitive condition, and the excellent advice of my father, the opposition to which was, as I may call it, my , my subsequent mistakes of the same kind had been the means of my coming into this miserable condition; for had that Providence which so happily seated me at the Brazils as a planter blessed me with confined desires, and I could have been contented to have gone on gradually, I might have been by this time—I mean in the time of my being in this island—one of the most considerable planters in the Brazils—nay, I am persuaded, that by the improvements I had made in that little time I lived there, and the increase I should probably have made if I had remained, I might have been worth a hundred thousand moidores—and what business had I to leave a settled fortune, a well-stocked plantation, improving and increasing, to turn supercargo to Guinea to fetch negroes, when patience and time would have so increased our stock at home, that we could have bought them at our own door from those whose business it was to fetch them? and though it had cost us something more, yet the difference of that price was by no means worth saving at so great a hazard.
But as this is usually the fate of young heads, so reflection upon the folly of
it is as commonly the exercise of more years, or of the dear-bought experience
of time—so it was with me now; and yet so deep had the mistake taken root
in my temper, that I could not satisfy myself in my station, but was
continually poring upon the means and possibility of my escape from this place;
and that I may, with greater pleasure to the reader, bring on the remaining
part of my story, it may not be improper to give some account of my first
conceptions on the subject of this foolish scheme for my escape, and how, and
upon what foundation, I acted.
I am now to be supposed retired into my castle, after my late voyage to the
wreck, my frigate laid up and secured under water, as usual, and my condition
restored to what it was before: I had more wealth, indeed, than I had before,
but was not at all the richer; for I had no more use for it than the Indians of
Peru had before the Spaniards came there.
It was one of the nights in the rainy season in March, the four-and-twentieth
year of my first setting foot in this island of solitude, I was lying in my bed
or hammock, awake, very well in health, had no pain, no distemper, no
uneasiness of body, nor any uneasiness of mind more than ordinary, but could by
no means close my eyes, that is, so as to sleep; no, not a wink all night long,
otherwise than as follows:
It is impossible to set down the innumerable crowd of thoughts that whirled
through that great thoroughfare of the brain, the memory, in this night’s
time. I ran over the whole history of my life in miniature, or by abridgment,
as I may call it, to my coming to this island, and also of that part of my life
since I came to this island. In my reflections upon the state of my case since
I came on shore on this island, I was comparing the happy posture of my affairs
in the first years of my habitation here, with the life of anxiety, fear, and
care which I had lived in ever since I had seen the print of a foot in the
sand. Not that I did not believe the savages had frequented the island even all
the while, and might have been several hundreds of them at times on shore
there; but I had never known it, and was incapable of any apprehensions about
it; my satisfaction was perfect, though my danger was the same, and I was as
happy in not knowing my danger as if I had never really been exposed to it.
This furnished my thoughts with many very profitable reflections, and
particularly this one: How infinitely good that Providence is, which has
provided, in its government of mankind, such narrow bounds to his sight and
knowledge of things; and though he walks in the midst of so many thousand
dangers, the sight of which, if discovered to him, would distract his mind and
sink his spirits, he is kept serene and calm, by having the events of things
hid from his eyes, and knowing nothing of the dangers which surround him.
After these thoughts had for some time entertained me, I came to reflect
seriously upon the real danger I had been in for so many years in this very
island, and how I had walked about in the greatest security, and with all
possible tranquillity, even when perhaps nothing but the brow of a hill, a
great tree, or the casual approach of night, had been between me and the worst
kind of destruction—viz. that of falling into the hands of cannibals and
savages, who would have seized on me with the same view as I would on a goat or
turtle; and have thought it no more crime to kill and devour me than I did of a
pigeon or a curlew. I would unjustly slander myself if I should say I was not
sincerely thankful to my great Preserver, to whose singular protection I
acknowledged, with great humanity, all these unknown deliverances were due, and
without which I must inevitably have fallen into their merciless hands.
When these thoughts were over, my head was for some time taken up in
considering the nature of these wretched creatures, I mean the savages, and how
it came to pass in the world that the wise Governor of all things should give
up any of His creatures to such inhumanity—nay, to something so much
below even brutality itself—as to devour its own kind: but as this ended
in some (at that time) fruitless speculations, it occurred to me to inquire
what part of the world these wretches lived in? how far off the coast was from
whence they came? what they ventured over so far from home for? what kind of
boats they had? and why I might not order myself and my business so that I
might be able to go over thither, as they were to come to me?
I never so much as troubled myself to consider what I should do with myself
when I went thither; what would become of me if I fell into the hands of these
savages; or how I should escape them if they attacked me; no, nor so much as
how it was possible for me to reach the coast, and not to be attacked by some
or other of them, without any possibility of delivering myself; and if I should
not fall into their hands, what I should do for provision, or whither I should
bend my course; none of these thoughts, I say, so much as came in my way; but
my mind was wholly bent upon the notion of my passing over in my boat to the
mainland. I looked upon my present condition as the most miserable that could
possibly be; that I was not able to throw myself into anything but death, that
could be called worse; and if I reached the shore of the main I might perhaps
meet with relief, or I might coast along, as I did on the African shore, till I
came to some inhabited country, and where I might find some relief; and after
all, perhaps I might fall in with some Christian ship that might take me in:
and if the worst came to the worst, I could but die, which would put an end to
all these miseries at once. Pray note, all this was the fruit of a disturbed
mind, an impatient temper, made desperate, as it were, by the long continuance
of my troubles, and the disappointments I had met in the wreck I had been on
board of, and where I had been so near obtaining what I so earnestly longed
for—somebody to speak to, and to learn some knowledge from them of the
place where I was, and of the probable means of my deliverance. I was agitated
wholly by these thoughts; all my calm of mind, in my resignation to Providence,
and waiting the issue of the dispositions of Heaven, seemed to be suspended;
and I had as it were no power to turn my thoughts to anything but to the
project of a voyage to the main, which came upon me with such force, and such
an impetuosity of desire, that it was not to be resisted.
When this had agitated my thoughts for two hours or more, with such violence
that it set my very blood into a ferment, and my pulse beat as if I had been in
a fever, merely with the extraordinary fervour of my mind about it,
Nature—as if I had been fatigued and exhausted with the very thoughts of
it—threw me into a sound sleep. One would have thought I should have
dreamed of it, but I did not, nor of anything relating to it, but I dreamed
that as I was going out in the morning as usual from my castle, I saw upon the
shore two canoes and eleven savages coming to land, and that they brought with
them another savage whom they were going to kill in order to eat him; when, on
a sudden, the savage that they were going to kill jumped away, and ran for his
life; and I thought in my sleep that he came running into my little thick grove
before my fortification, to hide himself; and that I seeing him alone, and not
perceiving that the others sought him that way, showed myself to him, and
smiling upon him, encouraged him: that he kneeled down to me, seeming to pray
me to assist him; upon which I showed him my ladder, made him go up, and
carried him into my cave, and he became my servant; and that as soon as I had
got this man, I said to myself, “Now I may certainly venture to the
mainland, for this fellow will serve me as a pilot, and will tell me what to
do, and whither to go for provisions, and whither not to go for fear of being
devoured; what places to venture into, and what to shun.” I waked with
this thought; and was under such inexpressible impressions of joy at the
prospect of my escape in my dream, that the disappointments which I felt upon
coming to myself, and finding that it was no more than a dream, were equally
extravagant the other way, and threw me into a very great dejection of spirits.
Upon this, however, I made this conclusion: that my only way to go about to
attempt an escape was, to endeavour to get a savage into my possession: and, if
possible, it should be one of their prisoners, whom they had condemned to be
eaten, and should bring hither to kill. But these thoughts still were attended
with this difficulty: that it was impossible to effect this without attacking a
whole caravan of them, and killing them all; and this was not only a very
desperate attempt, and might miscarry, but, on the other hand, I had greatly
scrupled the lawfulness of it to myself; and my heart trembled at the thoughts
of shedding so much blood, though it was for my deliverance. I need not repeat
the arguments which occurred to me against this, they being the same mentioned
before; but though I had other reasons to offer now—viz. that those men
were enemies to my life, and would devour me if they could; that it was
self-preservation, in the highest degree, to deliver myself from this death of
a life, and was acting in my own defence as much as if they were actually
assaulting me, and the like; I say though these things argued for it, yet the
thoughts of shedding human blood for my deliverance were very terrible to me,
and such as I could by no means reconcile myself to for a great while. However,
at last, after many secret disputes with myself, and after great perplexities
about it (for all these arguments, one way and another, struggled in my head a
long time), the eager prevailing desire of deliverance at length mastered all
the rest; and I resolved, if possible, to get one of these savages into my
hands, cost what it would. My next thing was to contrive how to do it, and
this, indeed, was very difficult to resolve on; but as I could pitch upon no
probable means for it, so I resolved to put myself upon the watch, to see them
when they came on shore, and leave the rest to the event; taking such measures
as the opportunity should present, let what would be.
With these resolutions in my thoughts, I set myself upon the scout as often as
possible, and indeed so often that I was heartily tired of it; for it was above
a year and a half that I waited; and for great part of that time went out to
the west end, and to the south-west corner of the island almost every day, to
look for canoes, but none appeared. This was very discouraging, and began to
trouble me much, though I cannot say that it did in this case (as it had done
some time before) wear off the edge of my desire to the thing; but the longer
it seemed to be delayed, the more eager I was for it: in a word, I was not at
first so careful to shun the sight of these savages, and avoid being seen by
them, as I was now eager to be upon them. Besides, I fancied myself able to
manage one, nay, two or three savages, if I had them, so as to make them
entirely slaves to me, to do whatever I should direct them, and to prevent
their being able at any time to do me any hurt. It was a great while that I
pleased myself with this affair; but nothing still presented itself; all my
fancies and schemes came to nothing, for no savages came near me for a great
while.
About a year and a half after I entertained these notions (and by long musing
had, as it were, resolved them all into nothing, for want of an occasion to put
them into execution), I was surprised one morning by seeing no less than five
canoes all on shore together on my side the island, and the people who belonged
to them all landed and out of my sight. The number of them broke all my
measures; for seeing so many, and knowing that they always came four or six, or
sometimes more in a boat, I could not tell what to think of it, or how to take
my measures to attack twenty or thirty men single-handed; so lay still in my
castle, perplexed and discomforted. However, I put myself into the same
position for an attack that I had formerly provided, and was just ready for
action, if anything had presented. Having waited a good while, listening to
hear if they made any noise, at length, being very impatient, I set my guns at
the foot of my ladder, and clambered up to the top of the hill, by my two
stages, as usual; standing so, however, that my head did not appear above the
hill, so that they could not perceive me by any means. Here I observed, by the
help of my perspective glass, that they were no less than thirty in number;
that they had a fire kindled, and that they had meat dressed. How they had
cooked it I knew not, or what it was; but they were all dancing, in I know not
how many barbarous gestures and figures, their own way, round the fire.
While I was thus looking on them, I perceived, by my perspective, two miserable
wretches dragged from the boats, where, it seems, they were laid by, and were
now brought out for the slaughter. I perceived one of them immediately fall;
being knocked down, I suppose, with a club or wooden sword, for that was their
way; and two or three others were at work immediately, cutting him open for
their cookery, while the other victim was left standing by himself, till they
should be ready for him. In that very moment this poor wretch, seeing himself a
little at liberty and unbound, Nature inspired him with hopes of life, and he
started away from them, and ran with incredible swiftness along the sands,
directly towards me; I mean towards that part of the coast where my habitation
was. I was dreadfully frightened, I must acknowledge, when I perceived him run
my way; and especially when, as I thought, I saw him pursued by the whole body:
and now I expected that part of my dream was coming to pass, and that he would
certainly take shelter in my grove; but I could not depend, by any means, upon
my dream, that the other savages would not pursue him thither and find him
there. However, I kept my station, and my spirits began to recover when I found
that there was not above three men that followed him; and still more was I
encouraged, when I found that he outstripped them exceedingly in running, and
gained ground on them; so that, if he could but hold out for half-an-hour, I
saw easily he would fairly get away from them all.
There was between them and my castle the creek, which I mentioned often in the
first part of my story, where I landed my cargoes out of the ship; and this I
saw plainly he must necessarily swim over, or the poor wretch would be taken
there; but when the savage escaping came thither, he made nothing of it, though
the tide was then up; but plunging in, swam through in about thirty strokes, or
thereabouts, landed, and ran with exceeding strength and swiftness. When the
three persons came to the creek, I found that two of them could swim, but the
third could not, and that, standing on the other side, he looked at the others,
but went no farther, and soon after went softly back again; which, as it
happened, was very well for him in the end. I observed that the two who swam
were yet more than twice as strong swimming over the creek as the fellow was
that fled from them. It came very warmly upon my thoughts, and indeed
irresistibly, that now was the time to get me a servant, and, perhaps, a
companion or assistant; and that I was plainly called by Providence to save
this poor creature’s life. I immediately ran down the ladders with all
possible expedition, fetched my two guns, for they were both at the foot of the
ladders, as I observed before, and getting up again with the same haste to the
top of the hill, I crossed towards the sea; and having a very short cut, and
all down hill, placed myself in the way between the pursuers and the pursued,
hallowing aloud to him that fled, who, looking back, was at first perhaps as
much frightened at me as at them; but I beckoned with my hand to him to come
back; and, in the meantime, I slowly advanced towards the two that followed;
then rushing at once upon the foremost, I knocked him down with the stock of my
piece. I was loath to fire, because I would not have the rest hear; though, at
that distance, it would not have been easily heard, and being out of sight of
the smoke, too, they would not have known what to make of it. Having knocked
this fellow down, the other who pursued him stopped, as if he had been
frightened, and I advanced towards him: but as I came nearer, I perceived
presently he had a bow and arrow, and was fitting it to shoot at me: so I was
then obliged to shoot at him first, which I did, and killed him at the first
shot. The poor savage who fled, but had stopped, though he saw both his enemies
fallen and killed, as he thought, yet was so frightened with the fire and noise
of my piece that he stood stock still, and neither came forward nor went
backward, though he seemed rather inclined still to fly than to come on. I
hallooed again to him, and made signs to come forward, which he easily
understood, and came a little way; then stopped again, and then a little
farther, and stopped again; and I could then perceive that he stood trembling,
as if he had been taken prisoner, and had just been to be killed, as his two
enemies were. I beckoned to him again to come to me, and gave him all the signs
of encouragement that I could think of; and he came nearer and nearer, kneeling
down every ten or twelve steps, in token of acknowledgment for saving his life.
I smiled at him, and looked pleasantly, and beckoned to him to come still
nearer; at length he came close to me; and then he kneeled down again, kissed
the ground, and laid his head upon the ground, and taking me by the foot, set
my foot upon his head; this, it seems, was in token of swearing to be my slave
for ever. I took him up and made much of him, and encouraged him all I could.
But there was more work to do yet; for I perceived the savage whom I had
knocked down was not killed, but stunned with the blow, and began to come to
himself: so I pointed to him, and showed him the savage, that he was not dead;
upon this he spoke some words to me, and though I could not understand them,
yet I thought they were pleasant to hear; for they were the first sound of a
man’s voice that I had heard, my own excepted, for above twenty-five
years. But there was no time for such reflections now; the savage who was
knocked down recovered himself so far as to sit up upon the ground, and I
perceived that my savage began to be afraid; but when I saw that, I presented
my other piece at the man, as if I would shoot him: upon this my savage, for so
I call him now, made a motion to me to lend him my sword, which hung naked in a
belt by my side, which I did. He no sooner had it, but he runs to his enemy,
and at one blow cut off his head so cleverly, no executioner in Germany could
have done it sooner or better; which I thought very strange for one who, I had
reason to believe, never saw a sword in his life before, except their own
wooden swords: however, it seems, as I learned afterwards, they make their
wooden swords so sharp, so heavy, and the wood is so hard, that they will even
cut off heads with them, ay, and arms, and that at one blow, too. When he had
done this, he comes laughing to me in sign of triumph, and brought me the sword
again, and with abundance of gestures which I did not understand, laid it down,
with the head of the savage that he had killed, just before me. But that which
astonished him most was to know how I killed the other Indian so far off; so,
pointing to him, he made signs to me to let him go to him; and I bade him go,
as well as I could. When he came to him, he stood like one amazed, looking at
him, turning him first on one side, then on the other; looked at the wound the
bullet had made, which it seems was just in his breast, where it had made a
hole, and no great quantity of blood had followed; but he had bled inwardly,
for he was quite dead. He took up his bow and arrows, and came back; so I
turned to go away, and beckoned him to follow me, making signs to him that more
might come after them. Upon this he made signs to me that he should bury them
with sand, that they might not be seen by the rest, if they followed; and so I
made signs to him again to do so. He fell to work; and in an instant he had
scraped a hole in the sand with his hands big enough to bury the first in, and
then dragged him into it, and covered him; and did so by the other also; I
believe he had him buried them both in a quarter of an hour. Then, calling
away, I carried him, not to my castle, but quite away to my cave, on the
farther part of the island: so I did not let my dream come to pass in that
part, that he came into my grove for shelter. Here I gave him bread and a bunch
of raisins to eat, and a draught of water, which I found he was indeed in great
distress for, from his running: and having refreshed him, I made signs for him
to go and lie down to sleep, showing him a place where I had laid some
rice-straw, and a blanket upon it, which I used to sleep upon myself sometimes;
so the poor creature lay down, and went to sleep.
He was a comely, handsome fellow, perfectly well made, with straight, strong
limbs, not too large; tall, and well-shaped; and, as I reckon, about twenty-six
years of age. He had a very good countenance, not a fierce and surly aspect,
but seemed to have something very manly in his face; and yet he had all the
sweetness and softness of a European in his countenance, too, especially when
he smiled. His hair was long and black, not curled like wool; his forehead very
high and large; and a great vivacity and sparkling sharpness in his eyes. The
colour of his skin was not quite black, but very tawny; and yet not an ugly,
yellow, nauseous tawny, as the Brazilians and Virginians, and other natives of
America are, but of a bright kind of a dun olive-colour, that had in it
something very agreeable, though not very easy to describe. His face was round
and plump; his nose small, not flat, like the negroes; a very good mouth, thin
lips, and his fine teeth well set, and as white as ivory.
After he had slumbered, rather than slept, about half-an-hour, he awoke again,
and came out of the cave to me, for I had been milking my goats which I had in
the enclosure just by: when he espied me he came running to me, laying himself
down again upon the ground, with all the possible signs of an humble, thankful
disposition, making a great many antic gestures to show it. At last he lays his
head flat upon the ground, close to my foot, and sets my other foot upon his
head, as he had done before; and after this made all the signs to me of
subjection, servitude, and submission imaginable, to let me know how he would
serve me so long as he lived. I understood him in many things, and let him know
I was very well pleased with him. In a little time I began to speak to him; and
teach him to speak to me; and first, I let him know his name should be Friday,
which was the day I saved his life; I called him so for the memory of the time.
I likewise taught him to say Master; and then let him know that was to be my
name; I likewise taught him to say Yes and No and to know the meaning of them.
I gave him some milk in an earthen pot, and let him see me drink it before him,
and sop my bread in it; and gave him a cake of bread to do the like, which he
quickly complied with, and made signs that it was very good for him. I kept
there with him all that night; but as soon as it was day I beckoned to him to
come with me, and let him know I would give him some clothes; at which he
seemed very glad, for he was stark naked. As we went by the place where he had
buried the two men, he pointed exactly to the place, and showed me the marks
that he had made to find them again, making signs to me that we should dig them
up again and eat them. At this I appeared very angry, expressed my abhorrence
of it, made as if I would vomit at the thoughts of it, and beckoned with my
hand to him to come away, which he did immediately, with great submission. I
then led him up to the top of the hill, to see if his enemies were gone; and
pulling out my glass I looked, and saw plainly the place where they had been,
but no appearance of them or their canoes; so that it was plain they were gone,
and had left their two comrades behind them, without any search after them.
But I was not content with this discovery; but having now more courage, and
consequently more curiosity, I took my man Friday with me, giving him the sword
in his hand, with the bow and arrows at his back, which I found he could use
very dexterously, making him carry one gun for me, and I two for myself; and
away we marched to the place where these creatures had been; for I had a mind
now to get some further intelligence of them. When I came to the place my very
blood ran chill in my veins, and my heart sunk within me, at the horror of the
spectacle; indeed, it was a dreadful sight, at least it was so to me, though
Friday made nothing of it. The place was covered with human bones, the ground
dyed with their blood, and great pieces of flesh left here and there,
half-eaten, mangled, and scorched; and, in short, all the tokens of the
triumphant feast they had been making there, after a victory over their
enemies. I saw three skulls, five hands, and the bones of three or four legs
and feet, and abundance of other parts of the bodies; and Friday, by his signs,
made me understand that they brought over four prisoners to feast upon; that
three of them were eaten up, and that he, pointing to himself, was the fourth;
that there had been a great battle between them and their next king, of whose
subjects, it seems, he had been one, and that they had taken a great number of
prisoners; all which were carried to several places by those who had taken them
in the fight, in order to feast upon them, as was done here by these wretches
upon those they brought hither.
I caused Friday to gather all the skulls, bones, flesh, and whatever remained,
and lay them together in a heap, and make a great fire upon it, and burn them
all to ashes. I found Friday had still a hankering stomach after some of the
flesh, and was still a cannibal in his nature; but I showed so much abhorrence
at the very thoughts of it, and at the least appearance of it, that he durst
not discover it: for I had, by some means, let him know that I would kill him
if he offered it.
When he had done this, we came back to our castle; and there I fell to work for
my man Friday; and first of all, I gave him a pair of linen drawers, which I
had out of the poor gunner’s chest I mentioned, which I found in the
wreck, and which, with a little alteration, fitted him very well; and then I
made him a jerkin of goat’s skin, as well as my skill would allow (for I
was now grown a tolerably good tailor); and I gave him a cap which I made of
hare’s skin, very convenient, and fashionable enough; and thus he was
clothed, for the present, tolerably well, and was mighty well pleased to see
himself almost as well clothed as his master. It is true he went awkwardly in
these clothes at first: wearing the drawers was very awkward to him, and the
sleeves of the waistcoat galled his shoulders and the inside of his arms; but a
little easing them where he complained they hurt him, and using himself to
them, he took to them at length very well.
The next day, after I came home to my hutch with him, I began to consider where
I should lodge him: and that I might do well for him and yet be perfectly easy
myself, I made a little tent for him in the vacant place between my two
fortifications, in the inside of the last, and in the outside of the first. As
there was a door or entrance there into my cave, I made a formal framed
door-case, and a door to it, of boards, and set it up in the passage, a little
within the entrance; and, causing the door to open in the inside, I barred it
up in the night, taking in my ladders, too; so that Friday could no way come at
me in the inside of my innermost wall, without making so much noise in getting
over that it must needs awaken me; for my first wall had now a complete roof
over it of long poles, covering all my tent, and leaning up to the side of the
hill; which was again laid across with smaller sticks, instead of laths, and
then thatched over a great thickness with the rice-straw, which was strong,
like reeds; and at the hole or place which was left to go in or out by the
ladder I had placed a kind of trap-door, which, if it had been attempted on the
outside, would not have opened at all, but would have fallen down and made a
great noise—as to weapons, I took them all into my side every night. But
I needed none of all this precaution; for never man had a more faithful,
loving, sincere servant than Friday was to me: without passions, sullenness, or
designs, perfectly obliged and engaged; his very affections were tied to me,
like those of a child to a father; and I daresay he would have sacrificed his
life to save mine upon any occasion whatsoever—the many testimonies he
gave me of this put it out of doubt, and soon convinced me that I needed to use
no precautions for my safety on his account.
This frequently gave me occasion to observe, and that with wonder, that however
it had pleased God in His providence, and in the government of the works of His
hands, to take from so great a part of the world of His creatures the best uses
to which their faculties and the powers of their souls are adapted, yet that He
has bestowed upon them the same powers, the same reason, the same affections,
the same sentiments of kindness and obligation, the same passions and
resentments of wrongs, the same sense of gratitude, sincerity, fidelity, and
all the capacities of doing good and receiving good that He has given to us;
and that when He pleases to offer them occasions of exerting these, they are as
ready, nay, more ready, to apply them to the right uses for which they were
bestowed than we are. This made me very melancholy sometimes, in reflecting, as
the several occasions presented, how mean a use we make of all these, even
though we have these powers enlightened by the great lamp of instruction, the
Spirit of God, and by the knowledge of His word added to our understanding; and
why it has pleased God to hide the like saving knowledge from so many millions
of souls, who, if I might judge by this poor savage, would make a much better
use of it than we did. From hence I sometimes was led too far, to invade the
sovereignty of Providence, and, as it were, arraign the justice of so arbitrary
a disposition of things, that should hide that sight from some, and reveal it
to others, and yet expect a like duty from both; but I shut it up, and checked
my thoughts with this conclusion: first, that we did not know by what light and
law these should be condemned; but that as God was necessarily, and by the
nature of His being, infinitely holy and just, so it could not be, but if these
creatures were all sentenced to absence from Himself, it was on account of
sinning against that light which, as the Scripture says, was a law to
themselves, and by such rules as their consciences would acknowledge to be
just, though the foundation was not discovered to us; and secondly, that still
as we all are the clay in the hand of the potter, no vessel could say to him,
“Why hast thou formed me thus?”
But to return to my new companion. I was greatly delighted with him, and made
it my business to teach him everything that was proper to make him useful,
handy, and helpful; but especially to make him speak, and understand me when I
spoke; and he was the aptest scholar that ever was; and particularly was so
merry, so constantly diligent, and so pleased when he could but understand me,
or make me understand him, that it was very pleasant for me to talk to him. Now
my life began to be so easy that I began to say to myself that could I but have
been safe from more savages, I cared not if I was never to remove from the
place where I lived.
CHAPTER XV.
FRIDAY’S EDUCATION
After I had been two or three days returned to my castle, I thought that, in
order to bring Friday off from his horrid way of feeding, and from the relish
of a cannibal’s stomach, I ought to let him taste other flesh; so I took
him out with me one morning to the woods. I went, indeed, intending to kill a
kid out of my own flock; and bring it home and dress it; but as I was going I
saw a she-goat lying down in the shade, and two young kids sitting by her. I
catched hold of Friday. “Hold,” said I, “stand still;”
and made signs to him not to stir: immediately I presented my piece, shot, and
killed one of the kids. The poor creature, who had at a distance, indeed, seen
me kill the savage, his enemy, but did not know, nor could imagine how it was
done, was sensibly surprised, trembled, and shook, and looked so amazed that I
thought he would have sunk down. He did not see the kid I shot at, or perceive
I had killed it, but ripped up his waistcoat to feel whether he was not
wounded; and, as I found presently, thought I was resolved to kill him: for he
came and kneeled down to me, and embracing my knees, said a great many things I
did not understand; but I could easily see the meaning was to pray me not to
kill him.
I soon found a way to convince him that I would do him no harm; and taking him
up by the hand, laughed at him, and pointing to the kid which I had killed,
beckoned to him to run and fetch it, which he did: and while he was wondering,
and looking to see how the creature was killed, I loaded my gun again.
By-and-by I saw a great fowl, like a hawk, sitting upon a tree within shot; so,
to let Friday understand a little what I would do, I called him to me again,
pointed at the fowl, which was indeed a parrot, though I thought it had been a
hawk; I say, pointing to the parrot, and to my gun, and to the ground under the
parrot, to let him see I would make it fall, I made him understand that I would
shoot and kill that bird; accordingly, I fired, and bade him look, and
immediately he saw the parrot fall. He stood like one frightened again,
notwithstanding all I had said to him; and I found he was the more amazed,
because he did not see me put anything into the gun, but thought that there
must be some wonderful fund of death and destruction in that thing, able to
kill man, beast, bird, or anything near or far off; and the astonishment this
created in him was such as could not wear off for a long time; and I believe,
if I would have let him, he would have worshipped me and my gun. As for the gun
itself, he would not so much as touch it for several days after; but he would
speak to it and talk to it, as if it had answered him, when he was by himself;
which, as I afterwards learned of him, was to desire it not to kill him. Well,
after his astonishment was a little over at this, I pointed to him to run and
fetch the bird I had shot, which he did, but stayed some time; for the parrot,
not being quite dead, had fluttered away a good distance from the place where
she fell: however, he found her, took her up, and brought her to me; and as I
had perceived his ignorance about the gun before, I took this advantage to
charge the gun again, and not to let him see me do it, that I might be ready
for any other mark that might present; but nothing more offered at that time:
so I brought home the kid, and the same evening I took the skin off, and cut it
out as well as I could; and having a pot fit for that purpose, I boiled or
stewed some of the flesh, and made some very good broth. After I had begun to
eat some I gave some to my man, who seemed very glad of it, and liked it very
well; but that which was strangest to him was to see me eat salt with it. He
made a sign to me that the salt was not good to eat; and putting a little into
his own mouth, he seemed to nauseate it, and would spit and sputter at it,
washing his mouth with fresh water after it: on the other hand, I took some
meat into my mouth without salt, and I pretended to spit and sputter for want
of salt, as much as he had done at the salt; but it would not do; he would
never care for salt with meat or in his broth; at least, not for a great while,
and then but a very little.
Having thus fed him with boiled meat and broth, I was resolved to feast him the
next day by roasting a piece of the kid: this I did by hanging it before the
fire on a string, as I had seen many people do in England, setting two poles
up, one on each side of the fire, and one across the top, and tying the string
to the cross stick, letting the meat turn continually. This Friday admired very
much; but when he came to taste the flesh, he took so many ways to tell me how
well he liked it, that I could not but understand him: and at last he told me,
as well as he could, he would never eat man’s flesh any more, which I was
very glad to hear.
The next day I set him to work beating some corn out, and sifting it in the
manner I used to do, as I observed before; and he soon understood how to do it
as well as I, especially after he had seen what the meaning of it was, and that
it was to make bread of; for after that I let him see me make my bread, and
bake it too; and in a little time Friday was able to do all the work for me as
well as I could do it myself.
I began now to consider, that having two mouths to feed instead of one, I must
provide more ground for my harvest, and plant a larger quantity of corn than I
used to do; so I marked out a larger piece of land, and began the fence in the
same manner as before, in which Friday worked not only very willingly and very
hard, but did it very cheerfully: and I told him what it was for; that it was
for corn to make more bread, because he was now with me, and that I might have
enough for him and myself too. He appeared very sensible of that part, and let
me know that he thought I had much more labour upon me on his account than I
had for myself; and that he would work the harder for me if I would tell him
what to do.
This was the pleasantest year of all the life I led in this place. Friday began
to talk pretty well, and understand the names of almost everything I had
occasion to call for, and of every place I had to send him to, and talked a
great deal to me; so that, in short, I began now to have some use for my tongue
again, which, indeed, I had very little occasion for before. Besides the
pleasure of talking to him, I had a singular satisfaction in the fellow
himself: his simple, unfeigned honesty appeared to me more and more every day,
and I began really to love the creature; and on his side I believe he loved me
more than it was possible for him ever to love anything before.
I had a mind once to try if he had any inclination for his own country again;
and having taught him English so well that he could answer me almost any
question, I asked him whether the nation that he belonged to never conquered in
battle? At which he smiled, and said—“Yes, yes, we always fight the
better;” that is, he meant always get the better in fight; and so we
began the following discourse:—
.—You always fight the better; how came you to be taken
prisoner, then, Friday?
.—My nation beat much for all that.
.—How beat? If your nation beat them, how came you to be
taken?
.—They more many than my nation, in the place where me was;
they take one, two, three, and me: my nation over-beat them in the yonder
place, where me no was; there my nation take one, two, great thousand.
.—But why did not your side recover you from the hands of
your enemies, then?
.—They run, one, two, three, and me, and make go in the
canoe; my nation have no canoe that time.
.—Well, Friday, and what does your nation do with the men
they take? Do they carry them away and eat them, as these did?
.—Yes, my nation eat mans too; eat all up.
.—Where do they carry them?
.—Go to other place, where they think.
.—Do they come hither?
.—Yes, yes, they come hither; come other else place.
.—Have you been here with them?
.—Yes, I have been here (points to the NW. side of the
island, which, it seems, was their side).
By this I understood that my man Friday had formerly been among the savages who
used to come on shore on the farther part of the island, on the same man-eating
occasions he was now brought for; and some time after, when I took the courage
to carry him to that side, being the same I formerly mentioned, he presently
knew the place, and told me he was there once, when they ate up twenty men, two
women, and one child; he could not tell twenty in English, but he numbered them
by laying so many stones in a row, and pointing to me to tell them over.
I have told this passage, because it introduces what follows: that after this
discourse I had with him, I asked him how far it was from our island to the
shore, and whether the canoes were not often lost. He told me there was no
danger, no canoes ever lost: but that after a little way out to sea, there was
a current and wind, always one way in the morning, the other in the afternoon.
This I understood to be no more than the sets of the tide, as going out or
coming in; but I afterwards understood it was occasioned by the great draft and
reflux of the mighty river Orinoco, in the mouth or gulf of which river, as I
found afterwards, our island lay; and that this land, which I perceived to be
W. and NW., was the great island Trinidad, on the north point of the mouth of
the river. I asked Friday a thousand questions about the country, the
inhabitants, the sea, the coast, and what nations were near; he told me all he
knew with the greatest openness imaginable. I asked him the names of the
several nations of his sort of people, but could get no other name than Caribs;
from whence I easily understood that these were the Caribbees, which our maps
place on the part of America which reaches from the mouth of the river Orinoco
to Guiana, and onwards to St. Martha. He told me that up a great way beyond the
moon, that was beyond the setting of the moon, which must be west from their
country, there dwelt white bearded men, like me, and pointed to my great
whiskers, which I mentioned before; and that they had killed much mans, that
was his word: by all which I understood he meant the Spaniards, whose cruelties
in America had been spread over the whole country, and were remembered by all
the nations from father to son.
I inquired if he could tell me how I might go from this island, and get among
those white men. He told me, “Yes, yes, you may go in two canoe.” I
could not understand what he meant, or make him describe to me what he meant by
two canoe, till at last, with great difficulty, I found he meant it must be in
a large boat, as big as two canoes. This part of Friday’s discourse I
began to relish very well; and from this time I entertained some hopes that,
one time or other, I might find an opportunity to make my escape from this
place, and that this poor savage might be a means to help me.
During the long time that Friday had now been with me, and that he began to
speak to me, and understand me, I was not wanting to lay a foundation of
religious knowledge in his mind; particularly I asked him one time, who made
him. The creature did not understand me at all, but thought I had asked who was
his father—but I took it up by another handle, and asked him who made the
sea, the ground we walked on, and the hills and woods. He told me, “It
was one Benamuckee, that lived beyond all;” he could describe nothing of
this great person, but that he was very old, “much older,” he said,
“than the sea or land, than the moon or the stars.” I asked him
then, if this old person had made all things, why did not all things worship
him? He looked very grave, and, with a perfect look of innocence, said,
“All things say O to him.” I asked him if the people who die in his
country went away anywhere? He said, “Yes; they all went to
Benamuckee.” Then I asked him whether those they eat up went thither too.
He said, “Yes.”
From these things, I began to instruct him in the knowledge of the true God; I
told him that the great Maker of all things lived up there, pointing up towards
heaven; that He governed the world by the same power and providence by which He
made it; that He was omnipotent, and could do everything for us, give
everything to us, take everything from us; and thus, by degrees, I opened his
eyes. He listened with great attention, and received with pleasure the notion
of Jesus Christ being sent to redeem us; and of the manner of making our
prayers to God, and His being able to hear us, even in heaven. He told me one
day, that if our God could hear us, up beyond the sun, he must needs be a
greater God than their Benamuckee, who lived but a little way off, and yet
could not hear till they went up to the great mountains where he dwelt to speak
to them. I asked him if ever he went thither to speak to him. He said,
“No; they never went that were young men; none went thither but the old
men,” whom he called their Oowokakee; that is, as I made him explain to
me, their religious, or clergy; and that they went to say O (so he called
saying prayers), and then came back and told them what Benamuckee said. By this
I observed, that there is priestcraft even among the most blinded, ignorant
pagans in the world; and the policy of making a secret of religion, in order to
preserve the veneration of the people to the clergy, not only to be found in
the Roman, but, perhaps, among all religions in the world, even among the most
brutish and barbarous savages.
I endeavoured to clear up this fraud to my man Friday; and told him that the
pretence of their old men going up to the mountains to say O to their god
Benamuckee was a cheat; and their bringing word from thence what he said was
much more so; that if they met with any answer, or spake with any one there, it
must be with an evil spirit; and then I entered into a long discourse with him
about the devil, the origin of him, his rebellion against God, his enmity to
man, the reason of it, his setting himself up in the dark parts of the world to
be worshipped instead of God, and as God, and the many stratagems he made use
of to delude mankind to their ruin; how he had a secret access to our passions
and to our affections, and to adapt his snares to our inclinations, so as to
cause us even to be our own tempters, and run upon our destruction by our own
choice.
I found it was not so easy to imprint right notions in his mind about the devil
as it was about the being of a God. Nature assisted all my arguments to
evidence to him even the necessity of a great First Cause, an overruling,
governing Power, a secret directing Providence, and of the equity and justice
of paying homage to Him that made us, and the like; but there appeared nothing
of this kind in the notion of an evil spirit, of his origin, his being, his
nature, and above all, of his inclination to do evil, and to draw us in to do
so too; and the poor creature puzzled me once in such a manner, by a question
merely natural and innocent, that I scarce knew what to say to him. I had been
talking a great deal to him of the power of God, His omnipotence, His aversion
to sin, His being a consuming fire to the workers of iniquity; how, as He had
made us all, He could destroy us and all the world in a moment; and he listened
with great seriousness to me all the while. After this I had been telling him
how the devil was God’s enemy in the hearts of men, and used all his
malice and skill to defeat the good designs of Providence, and to ruin the
kingdom of Christ in the world, and the like. “Well,” says Friday,
“but you say God is so strong, so great; is He not much strong, much
might as the devil?” “Yes, yes,” says I, “Friday; God
is stronger than the devil—God is above the devil, and therefore we pray
to God to tread him down under our feet, and enable us to resist his
temptations and quench his fiery darts.” “But,” says he
again, “if God much stronger, much might as the wicked devil, why God no
kill the devil, so make him no more do wicked?” I was strangely surprised
at this question; and, after all, though I was now an old man, yet I was but a
young doctor, and ill qualified for a casuist or a solver of difficulties; and
at first I could not tell what to say; so I pretended not to hear him, and
asked him what he said; but he was too earnest for an answer to forget his
question, so that he repeated it in the very same broken words as above. By
this time I had recovered myself a little, and I said, “God will at last
punish him severely; he is reserved for the judgment, and is to be cast into
the bottomless pit, to dwell with everlasting fire.” This did not satisfy
Friday; but he returns upon me, repeating my words, “‘!’ me no understand—but why not kill the devil now; not
kill great ago?” “You may as well ask me,” said I, “why
God does not kill you or me, when we do wicked things here that offend
Him—we are preserved to repent and be pardoned.” He mused some time
on this. “Well, well,” says he, mighty affectionately, “that
well—so you, I, devil, all wicked, all preserve, repent, God pardon
all.” Here I was run down again by him to the last degree; and it was a
testimony to me, how the mere notions of nature, though they will guide
reasonable creatures to the knowledge of a God, and of a worship or homage due
to the supreme being of God, as the consequence of our nature, yet nothing but
divine revelation can form the knowledge of Jesus Christ, and of redemption
purchased for us; of a Mediator of the new covenant, and of an Intercessor at
the footstool of God’s throne; I say, nothing but a revelation from
Heaven can form these in the soul; and that, therefore, the gospel of our Lord
and Saviour Jesus Christ, I mean the Word of God, and the Spirit of God,
promised for the guide and sanctifier of His people, are the absolutely
necessary instructors of the souls of men in the saving knowledge of God and
the means of salvation.
I therefore diverted the present discourse between me and my man, rising up
hastily, as upon some sudden occasion of going out; then sending him for
something a good way off, I seriously prayed to God that He would enable me to
instruct savingly this poor savage; assisting, by His Spirit, the heart of the
poor ignorant creature to receive the light of the knowledge of God in Christ,
reconciling him to Himself, and would guide me so to speak to him from the Word
of God that his conscience might be convinced, his eyes opened, and his soul
saved. When he came again to me, I entered into a long discourse with him upon
the subject of the redemption of man by the Saviour of the world, and of the
doctrine of the gospel preached from Heaven, viz. of repentance towards God,
and faith in our blessed Lord Jesus. I then explained to him as well as I could
why our blessed Redeemer took not on Him the nature of angels but the seed of
Abraham; and how, for that reason, the fallen angels had no share in the
redemption; that He came only to the lost sheep of the house of Israel, and the
like.
I had, God knows, more sincerity than knowledge in all the methods I took for
this poor creature’s instruction, and must acknowledge, what I believe
all that act upon the same principle will find, that in laying things open to
him, I really informed and instructed myself in many things that either I did
not know or had not fully considered before, but which occurred naturally to my
mind upon searching into them, for the information of this poor savage; and I
had more affection in my inquiry after things upon this occasion than ever I
felt before: so that, whether this poor wild wretch was better for me or no, I
had great reason to be thankful that ever he came to me; my grief sat lighter,
upon me; my habitation grew comfortable to me beyond measure: and when I
reflected that in this solitary life which I have been confined to, I had not
only been moved to look up to heaven myself, and to seek the Hand that had
brought me here, but was now to be made an instrument, under Providence, to
save the life, and, for aught I knew, the soul of a poor savage, and bring him
to the true knowledge of religion and of the Christian doctrine, that he might
know Christ Jesus, in whom is life eternal; I say, when I reflected upon all
these things, a secret joy ran through every part of My soul, and I frequently
rejoiced that ever I was brought to this place, which I had so often thought
the most dreadful of all afflictions that could possibly have befallen me.
I continued in this thankful frame all the remainder of my time; and the
conversation which employed the hours between Friday and me was such as made
the three years which we lived there together perfectly and completely happy,
if any such thing as complete happiness can be formed in a sublunary state.
This savage was now a good Christian, a much better than I; though I have
reason to hope, and bless God for it, that we were equally penitent, and
comforted, restored penitents. We had here the Word of God to read, and no
farther off from His Spirit to instruct than if we had been in England. I
always applied myself, in reading the Scripture, to let him know, as well as I
could, the meaning of what I read; and he again, by his serious inquiries and
questionings, made me, as I said before, a much better scholar in the Scripture
knowledge than I should ever have been by my own mere private reading. Another
thing I cannot refrain from observing here also, from experience in this
retired part of my life, viz. how infinite and inexpressible a blessing it is
that the knowledge of God, and of the doctrine of salvation by Christ Jesus, is
so plainly laid down in the Word of God, so easy to be received and understood,
that, as the bare reading the Scripture made me capable of understanding enough
of my duty to carry me directly on to the great work of sincere repentance for
my sins, and laying hold of a Saviour for life and salvation, to a stated
reformation in practice, and obedience to all God’s commands, and this
without any teacher or instructor, I mean human; so the same plain instruction
sufficiently served to the enlightening this savage creature, and bringing him
to be such a Christian as I have known few equal to him in my life.
As to all the disputes, wrangling, strife, and contention which have happened
in the world about religion, whether niceties in doctrines or schemes of church
government, they were all perfectly useless to us, and, for aught I can yet
see, they have been so to the rest of the world. We had the sure guide to
heaven, viz. the Word of God; and we had, blessed be God, comfortable views of
the Spirit of God teaching and instructing by His word, leading us into all
truth, and making us both willing and obedient to the instruction of His word.
And I cannot see the least use that the greatest knowledge of the disputed
points of religion, which have made such confusion in the world, would have
been to us, if we could have obtained it. But I must go on with the historical
part of things, and take every part in its order.
After Friday and I became more intimately acquainted, and that he could
understand almost all I said to him, and speak pretty fluently, though in
broken English, to me, I acquainted him with my own history, or at least so
much of it as related to my coming to this place: how I had lived there, and
how long; I let him into the mystery, for such it was to him, of gunpowder and
bullet, and taught him how to shoot. I gave him a knife, which he was
wonderfully delighted with; and I made him a belt, with a frog hanging to it,
such as in England we wear hangers in; and in the frog, instead of a hanger, I
gave him a hatchet, which was not only as good a weapon in some cases, but much
more useful upon other occasions.
I described to him the country of Europe, particularly England, which I came
from; how we lived, how we worshipped God, how we behaved to one another, and
how we traded in ships to all parts of the world. I gave him an account of the
wreck which I had been on board of, and showed him, as near as I could, the
place where she lay; but she was all beaten in pieces before, and gone. I
showed him the ruins of our boat, which we lost when we escaped, and which I
could not stir with my whole strength then; but was now fallen almost all to
pieces. Upon seeing this boat, Friday stood, musing a great while, and said
nothing. I asked him what it was he studied upon. At last says he, “Me
see such boat like come to place at my nation.” I did not understand him
a good while; but at last, when I had examined further into it, I understood by
him that a boat, such as that had been, came on shore upon the country where he
lived: that is, as he explained it, was driven thither by stress of weather. I
presently imagined that some European ship must have been cast away upon their
coast, and the boat might get loose and drive ashore; but was so dull that I
never once thought of men making their escape from a wreck thither, much less
whence they might come: so I only inquired after a description of the boat.
Friday described the boat to me well enough; but brought me better to
understand him when he added with some warmth, “We save the white mans
from drown.” Then I presently asked if there were any white mans, as he
called them, in the boat. “Yes,” he said; “the boat full of
white mans.” I asked him how many. He told upon his fingers seventeen. I
asked him then what became of them. He told me, “They live, they dwell at
my nation.”
This put new thoughts into my head; for I presently imagined that these might
be the men belonging to the ship that was cast away in the sight of my island,
as I now called it; and who, after the ship was struck on the rock, and they
saw her inevitably lost, had saved themselves in their boat, and were landed
upon that wild shore among the savages. Upon this I inquired of him more
critically what was become of them. He assured me they lived still there; that
they had been there about four years; that the savages left them alone, and
gave them victuals to live on. I asked him how it came to pass they did not
kill them and eat them. He said, “No, they make brother with them;”
that is, as I understood him, a truce; and then he added, “They no eat
mans but when make the war fight;” that is to say, they never eat any men
but such as come to fight with them and are taken in battle.
It was after this some considerable time, that being upon the top of the hill
at the east side of the island, from whence, as I have said, I had, in a clear
day, discovered the main or continent of America, Friday, the weather being
very serene, looks very earnestly towards the mainland, and, in a kind of
surprise, falls a jumping and dancing, and calls out to me, for I was at some
distance from him. I asked him what was the matter. “Oh, joy!” says
he; “Oh, glad! there see my country, there my nation!” I observed
an extraordinary sense of pleasure appeared in his face, and his eyes sparkled,
and his countenance discovered a strange eagerness, as if he had a mind to be
in his own country again. This observation of mine put a great many thoughts
into me, which made me at first not so easy about my new man Friday as I was
before; and I made no doubt but that, if Friday could get back to his own
nation again, he would not only forget all his religion but all his obligation
to me, and would be forward enough to give his countrymen an account of me, and
come back, perhaps with a hundred or two of them, and make a feast upon me, at
which he might be as merry as he used to be with those of his enemies when they
were taken in war. But I wronged the poor honest creature very much, for which
I was very sorry afterwards. However, as my jealousy increased, and held some
weeks, I was a little more circumspect, and not so familiar and kind to him as
before: in which I was certainly wrong too; the honest, grateful creature
having no thought about it but what consisted with the best principles, both as
a religious Christian and as a grateful friend, as appeared afterwards to my
full satisfaction.
While my jealousy of him lasted, you may be sure I was every day pumping him to
see if he would discover any of the new thoughts which I suspected were in him;
but I found everything he said was so honest and so innocent, that I could find
nothing to nourish my suspicion; and in spite of all my uneasiness, he made me
at last entirely his own again; nor did he in the least perceive that I was
uneasy, and therefore I could not suspect him of deceit.
One day, walking up the same hill, but the weather being hazy at sea, so that
we could not see the continent, I called to him, and said, “Friday, do
not you wish yourself in your own country, your own nation?”
“Yes,” he said, “I be much O glad to be at my own
nation.” “What would you do there?” said I. “Would you
turn wild again, eat men’s flesh again, and be a savage as you were
before?” He looked full of concern, and shaking his head, said,
“No, no, Friday tell them to live good; tell them to pray God; tell them
to eat corn-bread, cattle flesh, milk; no eat man again.” “Why,
then,” said I to him, “they will kill you.” He looked grave
at that, and then said, “No, no, they no kill me, they willing love
learn.” He meant by this, they would be willing to learn. He added, they
learned much of the bearded mans that came in the boat. Then I asked him if he
would go back to them. He smiled at that, and told me that he could not swim so
far. I told him I would make a canoe for him. He told me he would go if I would
go with him. “I go!” says I; “why, they will eat me if I come
there.” “No, no,” says he, “me make they no eat you; me
make they much love you.” He meant, he would tell them how I had killed
his enemies, and saved his life, and so he would make them love me. Then he
told me, as well as he could, how kind they were to seventeen white men, or
bearded men, as he called them who came on shore there in distress.
From this time, I confess, I had a mind to venture over, and see if I could
possibly join with those bearded men, who I made no doubt were Spaniards and
Portuguese; not doubting but, if I could, we might find some method to escape
from thence, being upon the continent, and a good company together, better than
I could from an island forty miles off the shore, alone and without help. So,
after some days, I took Friday to work again by way of discourse, and told him
I would give him a boat to go back to his own nation; and, accordingly, I
carried him to my frigate, which lay on the other side of the island, and
having cleared it of water (for I always kept it sunk in water), I brought it
out, showed it him, and we both went into it. I found he was a most dexterous
fellow at managing it, and would make it go almost as swift again as I could.
So when he was in, I said to him, “Well, now, Friday, shall we go to your
nation?” He looked very dull at my saying so; which it seems was because
he thought the boat was too small to go so far. I then told him I had a bigger;
so the next day I went to the place where the first boat lay which I had made,
but which I could not get into the water. He said that was big enough; but
then, as I had taken no care of it, and it had lain two or three and twenty
years there, the sun had so split and dried it, that it was rotten. Friday told
me such a boat would do very well, and would carry “much enough vittle,
drink, bread;” this was his way of talking.
CHAPTER XVI.
RESCUE OF PRISONERS FROM CANNIBALS
Upon the whole, I was by this time so fixed upon my design of going over with
him to the continent that I told him we would go and make one as big as that,
and he should go home in it. He answered not one word, but looked very grave
and sad. I asked him what was the matter with him. He asked me again,
“Why you angry mad with Friday?—what me done?” I asked him
what he meant. I told him I was not angry with him at all. “No
angry!” says he, repeating the words several times; “why send
Friday home away to my nation?” “Why,” says I, “Friday,
did not you say you wished you were there?” “Yes, yes,” says
he, “wish we both there; no wish Friday there, no master there.” In
a word, he would not think of going there without me. “I go there,
Friday?” says I; “what shall I do there?” He turned very
quick upon me at this. “You do great deal much good,” says he;
“you teach wild mans be good, sober, tame mans; you tell them know God,
pray God, and live new life.” “Alas, Friday!” says I,
“thou knowest not what thou sayest; I am but an ignorant man
myself.” “Yes, yes,” says he, “you teachee me good, you
teachee them good.” “No, no, Friday,” says I, “you
shall go without me; leave me here to live by myself, as I did before.”
He looked confused again at that word; and running to one of the hatchets which
he used to wear, he takes it up hastily, and gives it to me. “What must I
do with this?” says I to him. “You take kill Friday,” says
he. “What must kill you for?” said I again. He returns very
quick—“What you send Friday away for? Take kill Friday, no send
Friday away.” This he spoke so earnestly that I saw tears stand in his
eyes. In a word, I so plainly discovered the utmost affection in him to me, and
a firm resolution in him, that I told him then and often after, that I would
never send him away from me if he was willing to stay with me.
Upon the whole, as I found by all his discourse a settled affection to me, and
that nothing could part him from me, so I found all the foundation of his
desire to go to his own country was laid in his ardent affection to the people,
and his hopes of my doing them good; a thing which, as I had no notion of
myself, so I had not the least thought or intention, or desire of undertaking
it. But still I found a strong inclination to attempting my escape, founded on
the supposition gathered from the discourse, that there were seventeen bearded
men there; and therefore, without any more delay, I went to work with Friday to
find out a great tree proper to fell, and make a large periagua, or canoe, to
undertake the voyage. There were trees enough in the island to have built a
little fleet, not of periaguas or canoes, but even of good, large vessels; but
the main thing I looked at was, to get one so near the water that we might
launch it when it was made, to avoid the mistake I committed at first. At last
Friday pitched upon a tree; for I found he knew much better than I what kind of
wood was fittest for it; nor can I tell to this day what wood to call the tree
we cut down, except that it was very like the tree we call fustic, or between
that and the Nicaragua wood, for it was much of the same colour and smell.
Friday wished to burn the hollow or cavity of this tree out, to make it for a
boat, but I showed him how to cut it with tools; which, after I had showed him
how to use, he did very handily; and in about a month’s hard labour we
finished it and made it very handsome; especially when, with our axes, which I
showed him how to handle, we cut and hewed the outside into the true shape of a
boat. After this, however, it cost us near a fortnight’s time to get her
along, as it were inch by inch, upon great rollers into the water; but when she
was in, she would have carried twenty men with great ease.
When she was in the water, though she was so big, it amazed me to see with what
dexterity and how swift my man Friday could manage her, turn her, and paddle
her along. So I asked him if he would, and if we might venture over in her.
“Yes,” he said, “we venture over in her very well, though
great blow wind.” However I had a further design that he knew nothing of,
and that was, to make a mast and a sail, and to fit her with an anchor and
cable. As to a mast, that was easy enough to get; so I pitched upon a straight
young cedar-tree, which I found near the place, and which there were great
plenty of in the island, and I set Friday to work to cut it down, and gave him
directions how to shape and order it. But as to the sail, that was my
particular care. I knew I had old sails, or rather pieces of old sails, enough;
but as I had had them now six-and-twenty years by me, and had not been very
careful to preserve them, not imagining that I should ever have this kind of
use for them, I did not doubt but they were all rotten; and, indeed, most of
them were so. However, I found two pieces which appeared pretty good, and with
these I went to work; and with a great deal of pains, and awkward stitching,
you may be sure, for want of needles, I at length made a three-cornered ugly
thing, like what we call in England a shoulder-of-mutton sail, to go with a
boom at bottom, and a little short sprit at the top, such as usually our
ships’ long-boats sail with, and such as I best knew how to manage, as it
was such a one as I had to the boat in which I made my escape from Barbary, as
related in the first part of my story.
I was near two months performing this last work, viz. rigging and fitting my
masts and sails; for I finished them very complete, making a small stay, and a
sail, or foresail, to it, to assist if we should turn to windward; and, what
was more than all, I fixed a rudder to the stern of her to steer with. I was
but a bungling shipwright, yet as I knew the usefulness and even necessity of
such a thing, I applied myself with so much pains to do it, that at last I
brought it to pass; though, considering the many dull contrivances I had for it
that failed, I think it cost me almost as much labour as making the boat.
After all this was done, I had my man Friday to teach as to what belonged to
the navigation of my boat; though he knew very well how to paddle a canoe, he
knew nothing of what belonged to a sail and a rudder; and was the most amazed
when he saw me work the boat to and again in the sea by the rudder, and how the
sail jibed, and filled this way or that way as the course we sailed changed; I
say when he saw this he stood like one astonished and amazed. However, with a
little use, I made all these things familiar to him, and he became an expert
sailor, except that of the compass I could make him understand very little. On
the other hand, as there was very little cloudy weather, and seldom or never
any fogs in those parts, there was the less occasion for a compass, seeing the
stars were always to be seen by night, and the shore by day, except in the
rainy seasons, and then nobody cared to stir abroad either by land or sea.
I was now entered on the seven-and-twentieth year of my captivity in this
place; though the three last years that I had this creature with me ought
rather to be left out of the account, my habitation being quite of another kind
than in all the rest of the time. I kept the anniversary of my landing here
with the same thankfulness to God for His mercies as at first: and if I had
such cause of acknowledgment at first, I had much more so now, having such
additional testimonies of the care of Providence over me, and the great hopes I
had of being effectually and speedily delivered; for I had an invincible
impression upon my thoughts that my deliverance was at hand, and that I should
not be another year in this place. I went on, however, with my husbandry;
digging, planting, and fencing as usual. I gathered and cured my grapes, and
did every necessary thing as before.
The rainy season was in the meantime upon me, when I kept more within doors
than at other times. We had stowed our new vessel as secure as we could,
bringing her up into the creek, where, as I said in the beginning, I landed my
rafts from the ship; and hauling her up to the shore at high-water mark, I made
my man Friday dig a little dock, just big enough to hold her, and just deep
enough to give her water enough to float in; and then, when the tide was out,
we made a strong dam across the end of it, to keep the water out; and so she
lay, dry as to the tide from the sea: and to keep the rain off we laid a great
many boughs of trees, so thick that she was as well thatched as a house; and
thus we waited for the months of November and December, in which I designed to
make my adventure.
When the settled season began to come in, as the thought of my design returned
with the fair weather, I was preparing daily for the voyage. And the first
thing I did was to lay by a certain quantity of provisions, being the stores
for our voyage; and intended in a week or a fortnight’s time to open the
dock, and launch out our boat. I was busy one morning upon something of this
kind, when I called to Friday, and bid him to go to the sea-shore and see if he
could find a turtle or a tortoise, a thing which we generally got once a week,
for the sake of the eggs as well as the flesh. Friday had not been long gone
when he came running back, and flew over my outer wall or fence, like one that
felt not the ground or the steps he set his foot on; and before I had time to
speak to him he cries out to me, “O master! O master! O sorrow! O
bad!”—“What’s the matter, Friday?” says I.
“O yonder there,” says he, “one, two, three canoes; one, two,
three!” By this way of speaking I concluded there were six; but on
inquiry I found there were but three. “Well, Friday,” says I,
“do not be frightened.” So I heartened him up as well as I could.
However, I saw the poor fellow was most terribly scared, for nothing ran in his
head but that they were come to look for him, and would cut him in pieces and
eat him; and the poor fellow trembled so that I scarcely knew what to do with
him. I comforted him as well as I could, and told him I was in as much danger
as he, and that they would eat me as well as him. “But,” says I,
“Friday, we must resolve to fight them. Can you fight, Friday?”
“Me shoot,” says he, “but there come many great
number.” “No matter for that,” said I again; “our guns
will fright them that we do not kill.” So I asked him whether, if I
resolved to defend him, he would defend me, and stand by me, and do just as I
bid him. He said, “Me die when you bid die, master.” So I went and
fetched a good dram of rum and gave him; for I had been so good a husband of my
rum that I had a great deal left. When we had drunk it, I made him take the two
fowling-pieces, which we always carried, and loaded them with large swan-shot,
as big as small pistol-bullets. Then I took four muskets, and loaded them with
two slugs and five small bullets each; and my two pistols I loaded with a brace
of bullets each. I hung my great sword, as usual, naked by my side, and gave
Friday his hatchet. When I had thus prepared myself, I took my perspective
glass, and went up to the side of the hill, to see what I could discover; and I
found quickly by my glass that there were one-and-twenty savages, three
prisoners, and three canoes; and that their whole business seemed to be the
triumphant banquet upon these three human bodies: a barbarous feast, indeed!
but nothing more than, as I had observed, was usual with them. I observed also
that they had landed, not where they had done when Friday made his escape, but
nearer to my creek, where the shore was low, and where a thick wood came almost
close down to the sea. This, with the abhorrence of the inhuman errand these
wretches came about, filled me with such indignation that I came down again to
Friday, and told him I was resolved to go down to them and kill them all; and
asked him if he would stand by me. He had now got over his fright, and his
spirits being a little raised with the dram I had given him, he was very
cheerful, and told me, as before, he would die when I bid die.
In this fit of fury I divided the arms which I had charged, as before, between
us; I gave Friday one pistol to stick in his girdle, and three guns upon his
shoulder, and I took one pistol and the other three guns myself; and in this
posture we marched out. I took a small bottle of rum in my pocket, and gave
Friday a large bag with more powder and bullets; and as to orders, I charged
him to keep close behind me, and not to stir, or shoot, or do anything till I
bid him, and in the meantime not to speak a word. In this posture I fetched a
compass to my right hand of near a mile, as well to get over the creek as to
get into the wood, so that I could come within shot of them before I should be
discovered, which I had seen by my glass it was easy to do.
While I was making this march, my former thoughts returning, I began to abate
my resolution: I do not mean that I entertained any fear of their number, for
as they were naked, unarmed wretches, it is certain I was superior to
them—nay, though I had been alone. But it occurred to my thoughts, what
call, what occasion, much less what necessity I was in to go and dip my hands
in blood, to attack people who had neither done or intended me any wrong? who,
as to me, were innocent, and whose barbarous customs were their own disaster,
being in them a token, indeed, of God’s having left them, with the other
nations of that part of the world, to such stupidity, and to such inhuman
courses, but did not call me to take upon me to be a judge of their actions,
much less an executioner of His justice—that whenever He thought fit He
would take the cause into His own hands, and by national vengeance punish them
as a people for national crimes, but that, in the meantime, it was none of my
business—that it was true Friday might justify it, because he was a
declared enemy and in a state of war with those very particular people, and it
was lawful for him to attack them—but I could not say the same with
regard to myself. These things were so warmly pressed upon my thoughts all the
way as I went, that I resolved I would only go and place myself near them that
I might observe their barbarous feast, and that I would act then as God should
direct; but that unless something offered that was more a call to me than yet I
knew of, I would not meddle with them.
With this resolution I entered the wood, and, with all possible wariness and
silence, Friday following close at my heels, I marched till I came to the
skirts of the wood on the side which was next to them, only that one corner of
the wood lay between me and them. Here I called softly to Friday, and showing
him a great tree which was just at the corner of the wood, I bade him go to the
tree, and bring me word if he could see there plainly what they were doing. He
did so, and came immediately back to me, and told me they might be plainly
viewed there—that they were all about their fire, eating the flesh of one
of their prisoners, and that another lay bound upon the sand a little from
them, whom he said they would kill next; and this fired the very soul within
me. He told me it was not one of their nation, but one of the bearded men he
had told me of, that came to their country in the boat. I was filled with
horror at the very naming of the white bearded man; and going to the tree, I
saw plainly by my glass a white man, who lay upon the beach of the sea with his
hands and his feet tied with flags, or things like rushes, and that he was an
European, and had clothes on.
There was another tree and a little thicket beyond it, about fifty yards nearer
to them than the place where I was, which, by going a little way about, I saw I
might come at undiscovered, and that then I should be within half a shot of
them; so I withheld my passion, though I was indeed enraged to the highest
degree; and going back about twenty paces, I got behind some bushes, which held
all the way till I came to the other tree, and then came to a little rising
ground, which gave me a full view of them at the distance of about eighty
yards.
I had now not a moment to lose, for nineteen of the dreadful wretches sat upon
the ground, all close huddled together, and had just sent the other two to
butcher the poor Christian, and bring him perhaps limb by limb to their fire,
and they were stooping down to untie the bands at his feet. I turned to Friday.
“Now, Friday,” said I, “do as I bid thee.” Friday said
he would. “Then, Friday,” says I, “do exactly as you see me
do; fail in nothing.” So I set down one of the muskets and the
fowling-piece upon the ground, and Friday did the like by his, and with the
other musket I took my aim at the savages, bidding him to do the like; then
asking him if he was ready, he said, “Yes.” “Then fire at
them,” said I; and at the same moment I fired also.
Friday took his aim so much better than I, that on the side that he shot he
killed two of them, and wounded three more; and on my side I killed one, and
wounded two. They were, you may be sure, in a dreadful consternation: and all
of them that were not hurt jumped upon their feet, but did not immediately know
which way to run, or which way to look, for they knew not from whence their
destruction came. Friday kept his eyes close upon me, that, as I had bid him,
he might observe what I did; so, as soon as the first shot was made, I threw
down the piece, and took up the fowling-piece, and Friday did the like; he saw
me cock and present; he did the same again. “Are you ready,
Friday?” said I. “Yes,” says he. “Let fly, then,”
says I, “in the name of God!” and with that I fired again among the
amazed wretches, and so did Friday; and as our pieces were now loaded with what
I call swan-shot, or small pistol-bullets, we found only two drop; but so many
were wounded that they ran about yelling and screaming like mad creatures, all
bloody, and most of them miserably wounded; whereof three more fell quickly
after, though not quite dead.
“Now, Friday,” says I, laying down the discharged pieces, and
taking up the musket which was yet loaded, “follow me,” which he
did with a great deal of courage; upon which I rushed out of the wood and
showed myself, and Friday close at my foot. As soon as I perceived they saw me,
I shouted as loud as I could, and bade Friday do so too, and running as fast as
I could, which, by the way, was not very fast, being loaded with arms as I was,
I made directly towards the poor victim, who was, as I said, lying upon the
beach or shore, between the place where they sat and the sea. The two butchers
who were just going to work with him had left him at the surprise of our first
fire, and fled in a terrible fright to the seaside, and had jumped into a
canoe, and three more of the rest made the same way. I turned to Friday, and
bade him step forwards and fire at them; he understood me immediately, and
running about forty yards, to be nearer them, he shot at them; and I thought he
had killed them all, for I saw them all fall of a heap into the boat, though I
saw two of them up again quickly; however, he killed two of them, and wounded
the third, so that he lay down in the bottom of the boat as if he had been
dead.
While my man Friday fired at them, I pulled out my knife and cut the flags that
bound the poor victim; and loosing his hands and feet, I lifted him up, and
asked him in the Portuguese tongue what he was. He answered in Latin,
Christianus; but was so weak and faint that he could scarce stand or speak. I
took my bottle out of my pocket and gave it him, making signs that he should
drink, which he did; and I gave him a piece of bread, which he ate. Then I
asked him what countryman he was: and he said, Espagniole; and being a little
recovered, let me know, by all the signs he could possibly make, how much he
was in my debt for his deliverance. “Seignior,” said I, with as
much Spanish as I could make up, “we will talk afterwards, but we must
fight now: if you have any strength left, take this pistol and sword, and lay
about you.” He took them very thankfully; and no sooner had he the arms
in his hands, but, as if they had put new vigour into him, he flew upon his
murderers like a fury, and had cut two of them in pieces in an instant; for the
truth is, as the whole was a surprise to them, so the poor creatures were so
much frightened with the noise of our pieces that they fell down for mere
amazement and fear, and had no more power to attempt their own escape than
their flesh had to resist our shot; and that was the case of those five that
Friday shot at in the boat; for as three of them fell with the hurt they
received, so the other two fell with the fright.
I kept my piece in my hand still without firing, being willing to keep my
charge ready, because I had given the Spaniard my pistol and sword: so I called
to Friday, and bade him run up to the tree from whence we first fired, and
fetch the arms which lay there that had been discharged, which he did with
great swiftness; and then giving him my musket, I sat down myself to load all
the rest again, and bade them come to me when they wanted. While I was loading
these pieces, there happened a fierce engagement between the Spaniard and one
of the savages, who made at him with one of their great wooden swords, the
weapon that was to have killed him before, if I had not prevented it. The
Spaniard, who was as bold and brave as could be imagined, though weak, had
fought the Indian a good while, and had cut two great wounds on his head; but
the savage being a stout, lusty fellow, closing in with him, had thrown him
down, being faint, and was wringing my sword out of his hand; when the
Spaniard, though undermost, wisely quitting the sword, drew the pistol from his
girdle, shot the savage through the body, and killed him upon the spot, before
I, who was running to help him, could come near him.
Friday, being now left to his liberty, pursued the flying wretches, with no
weapon in his hand but his hatchet: and with that he despatched those three who
as I said before, were wounded at first, and fallen, and all the rest he could
come up with: and the Spaniard coming to me for a gun, I gave him one of the
fowling-pieces, with which he pursued two of the savages, and wounded them
both; but as he was not able to run, they both got from him into the wood,
where Friday pursued them, and killed one of them, but the other was too nimble
for him; and though he was wounded, yet had plunged himself into the sea, and
swam with all his might off to those two who were left in the canoe; which
three in the canoe, with one wounded, that we knew not whether he died or no,
were all that escaped our hands of one-and-twenty. The account of the whole is
as follows: Three killed at our first shot from the tree; two killed at the
next shot; two killed by Friday in the boat; two killed by Friday of those at
first wounded; one killed by Friday in the wood; three killed by the Spaniard;
four killed, being found dropped here and there, of the wounds, or killed by
Friday in his chase of them; four escaped in the boat, whereof one wounded, if
not dead—twenty-one in all.
Those that were in the canoe worked hard to get out of gun-shot, and though
Friday made two or three shots at them, I did not find that he hit any of them.
Friday would fain have had me take one of their canoes, and pursue them; and
indeed I was very anxious about their escape, lest, carrying the news home to
their people, they should come back perhaps with two or three hundred of the
canoes and devour us by mere multitude; so I consented to pursue them by sea,
and running to one of their canoes, I jumped in and bade Friday follow me: but
when I was in the canoe I was surprised to find another poor creature lie
there, bound hand and foot, as the Spaniard was, for the slaughter, and almost
dead with fear, not knowing what was the matter; for he had not been able to
look up over the side of the boat, he was tied so hard neck and heels, and had
been tied so long that he had really but little life in him.
I immediately cut the twisted flags or rushes which they had bound him with,
and would have helped him up; but he could not stand or speak, but groaned most
piteously, believing, it seems, still, that he was only unbound in order to be
killed. When Friday came to him I bade him speak to him, and tell him of his
deliverance; and pulling out my bottle, made him give the poor wretch a dram,
which, with the news of his being delivered, revived him, and he sat up in the
boat. But when Friday came to hear him speak, and look in his face, it would
have moved any one to tears to have seen how Friday kissed him, embraced him,
hugged him, cried, laughed, hallooed, jumped about, danced, sang; then cried
again, wrung his hands, beat his own face and head; and then sang and jumped
about again like a distracted creature. It was a good while before I could make
him speak to me or tell me what was the matter; but when he came a little to
himself he told me that it was his father.
It is not easy for me to express how it moved me to see what ecstasy and filial
affection had worked in this poor savage at the sight of his father, and of his
being delivered from death; nor indeed can I describe half the extravagances of
his affection after this: for he went into the boat and out of the boat a great
many times: when he went in to him he would sit down by him, open his breast,
and hold his father’s head close to his bosom for many minutes together,
to nourish it; then he took his arms and ankles, which were numbed and stiff
with the binding, and chafed and rubbed them with his hands; and I, perceiving
what the case was, gave him some rum out of my bottle to rub them with, which
did them a great deal of good.
This affair put an end to our pursuit of the canoe with the other savages, who
were now almost out of sight; and it was happy for us that we did not, for it
blew so hard within two hours after, and before they could be got a quarter of
their way, and continued blowing so hard all night, and that from the
north-west, which was against them, that I could not suppose their boat could
live, or that they ever reached their own coast.
But to return to Friday; he was so busy about his father that I could not find
in my heart to take him off for some time; but after I thought he could leave
him a little, I called him to me, and he came jumping and laughing, and pleased
to the highest extreme: then I asked him if he had given his father any bread.
He shook his head, and said, “None; ugly dog eat all up self.” I
then gave him a cake of bread out of a little pouch I carried on purpose; I
also gave him a dram for himself; but he would not taste it, but carried it to
his father. I had in my pocket two or three bunches of raisins, so I gave him a
handful of them for his father. He had no sooner given his father these raisins
but I saw him come out of the boat, and run away as if he had been bewitched,
for he was the swiftest fellow on his feet that ever I saw: I say, he ran at
such a rate that he was out of sight, as it were, in an instant; and though I
called, and hallooed out too after him, it was all one—away he went; and
in a quarter of an hour I saw him come back again, though not so fast as he
went; and as he came nearer I found his pace slacker, because he had something
in his hand. When he came up to me I found he had been quite home for an
earthen jug or pot, to bring his father some fresh water, and that he had got
two more cakes or loaves of bread: the bread he gave me, but the water he
carried to his father; however, as I was very thirsty too, I took a little of
it. The water revived his father more than all the rum or spirits I had given
him, for he was fainting with thirst.
When his father had drunk, I called to him to know if there was any water left.
He said, “Yes”; and I bade him give it to the poor Spaniard, who
was in as much want of it as his father; and I sent one of the cakes that
Friday brought to the Spaniard too, who was indeed very weak, and was reposing
himself upon a green place under the shade of a tree; and whose limbs were also
very stiff, and very much swelled with the rude bandage he had been tied with.
When I saw that upon Friday’s coming to him with the water he sat up and
drank, and took the bread and began to eat, I went to him and gave him a
handful of raisins. He looked up in my face with all the tokens of gratitude
and thankfulness that could appear in any countenance; but was so weak,
notwithstanding he had so exerted himself in the fight, that he could not stand
up upon his feet—he tried to do it two or three times, but was really not
able, his ankles were so swelled and so painful to him; so I bade him sit
still, and caused Friday to rub his ankles, and bathe them with rum, as he had
done his father’s.
I observed the poor affectionate creature, every two minutes, or perhaps less,
all the while he was here, turn his head about to see if his father was in the
same place and posture as he left him sitting; and at last he found he was not
to be seen; at which he started up, and, without speaking a word, flew with
that swiftness to him that one could scarce perceive his feet to touch the
ground as he went; but when he came, he only found he had laid himself down to
ease his limbs, so Friday came back to me presently; and then I spoke to the
Spaniard to let Friday help him up if he could, and lead him to the boat, and
then he should carry him to our dwelling, where I would take care of him. But
Friday, a lusty, strong fellow, took the Spaniard upon his back, and carried
him away to the boat, and set him down softly upon the side or gunnel of the
canoe, with his feet in the inside of it; and then lifting him quite in, he set
him close to his father; and presently stepping out again, launched the boat
off, and paddled it along the shore faster than I could walk, though the wind
blew pretty hard too; so he brought them both safe into our creek, and leaving
them in the boat, ran away to fetch the other canoe. As he passed me I spoke to
him, and asked him whither he went. He told me, “Go fetch more
boat;” so away he went like the wind, for sure never man or horse ran
like him; and he had the other canoe in the creek almost as soon as I got to it
by land; so he wafted me over, and then went to help our new guests out of the
boat, which he did; but they were neither of them able to walk; so that poor
Friday knew not what to do.
To remedy this, I went to work in my thought, and calling to Friday to bid them
sit down on the bank while he came to me, I soon made a kind of hand-barrow to
lay them on, and Friday and I carried them both up together upon it between us.
But when we got them to the outside of our wall, or fortification, we were at a
worse loss than before, for it was impossible to get them over, and I was
resolved not to break it down; so I set to work again, and Friday and I, in
about two hours’ time, made a very handsome tent, covered with old sails,
and above that with boughs of trees, being in the space without our outward
fence and between that and the grove of young wood which I had planted; and
here we made them two beds of such things as I had—viz. of good
rice-straw, with blankets laid upon it to lie on, and another to cover them, on
each bed.
My island was now peopled, and I thought myself very rich in subjects; and it
was a merry reflection, which I frequently made, how like a king I looked.
First of all, the whole country was my own property, so that I had an undoubted
right of dominion. Secondly, my people were perfectly subjected—I was
absolutely lord and lawgiver—they all owed their lives to me, and were
ready to lay down their lives, if there had been occasion for it, for me. It
was remarkable, too, I had but three subjects, and they were of three different
religions—my man Friday was a Protestant, his father was a Pagan and a
cannibal, and the Spaniard was a Papist. However, I allowed liberty of
conscience throughout my dominions. But this is by the way.
As soon as I had secured my two weak, rescued prisoners, and given them
shelter, and a place to rest them upon, I began to think of making some
provision for them; and the first thing I did, I ordered Friday to take a
yearling goat, betwixt a kid and a goat, out of my particular flock, to be
killed; when I cut off the hinder-quarter, and chopping it into small pieces, I
set Friday to work to boiling and stewing, and made them a very good dish, I
assure you, of flesh and broth; and as I cooked it without doors, for I made no
fire within my inner wall, so I carried it all into the new tent, and having
set a table there for them, I sat down, and ate my own dinner also with them,
and, as well as I could, cheered them and encouraged them. Friday was my
interpreter, especially to his father, and, indeed, to the Spaniard too; for
the Spaniard spoke the language of the savages pretty well.
After we had dined, or rather supped, I ordered Friday to take one of the
canoes, and go and fetch our muskets and other firearms, which, for want of
time, we had left upon the place of battle; and the next day I ordered him to
go and bury the dead bodies of the savages, which lay open to the sun, and
would presently be offensive. I also ordered him to bury the horrid remains of
their barbarous feast, which I could not think of doing myself; nay, I could
not bear to see them if I went that way; all which he punctually performed, and
effaced the very appearance of the savages being there; so that when I went
again, I could scarce know where it was, otherwise than by the corner of the
wood pointing to the place.
I then began to enter into a little conversation with my two new subjects; and,
first, I set Friday to inquire of his father what he thought of the escape of
the savages in that canoe, and whether we might expect a return of them, with a
power too great for us to resist. His first opinion was, that the savages in
the boat never could live out the storm which blew that night they went off,
but must of necessity be drowned, or driven south to those other shores, where
they were as sure to be devoured as they were to be drowned if they were cast
away; but, as to what they would do if they came safe on shore, he said he knew
not; but it was his opinion that they were so dreadfully frightened with the
manner of their being attacked, the noise, and the fire, that he believed they
would tell the people they were all killed by thunder and lightning, not by the
hand of man; and that the two which appeared—viz. Friday and I—were
two heavenly spirits, or furies, come down to destroy them, and not men with
weapons. This, he said, he knew; because he heard them all cry out so, in their
language, one to another; for it was impossible for them to conceive that a man
could dart fire, and speak thunder, and kill at a distance, without lifting up
the hand, as was done now: and this old savage was in the right; for, as I
understood since, by other hands, the savages never attempted to go over to the
island afterwards, they were so terrified with the accounts given by those four
men (for it seems they did escape the sea), that they believed whoever went to
that enchanted island would be destroyed with fire from the gods. This,
however, I knew not; and therefore was under continual apprehensions for a good
while, and kept always upon my guard, with all my army: for, as there were now
four of us, I would have ventured upon a hundred of them, fairly in the open
field, at any time.
CHAPTER XVII.
VISIT OF MUTINEERS
In a little time, however, no more canoes appearing, the fear of their coming
wore off; and I began to take my former thoughts of a voyage to the main into
consideration; being likewise assured by Friday’s father that I might
depend upon good usage from their nation, on his account, if I would go. But my
thoughts were a little suspended when I had a serious discourse with the
Spaniard, and when I understood that there were sixteen more of his countrymen
and Portuguese, who having been cast away and made their escape to that side,
lived there at peace, indeed, with the savages, but were very sore put to it
for necessaries, and, indeed, for life. I asked him all the particulars of
their voyage, and found they were a Spanish ship, bound from the Rio de la
Plata to the Havanna, being directed to leave their loading there, which was
chiefly hides and silver, and to bring back what European goods they could meet
with there; that they had five Portuguese seamen on board, whom they took out
of another wreck; that five of their own men were drowned when first the ship
was lost, and that these escaped through infinite dangers and hazards, and
arrived, almost starved, on the cannibal coast, where they expected to have
been devoured every moment. He told me they had some arms with them, but they
were perfectly useless, for that they had neither powder nor ball, the washing
of the sea having spoiled all their powder but a little, which they used at
their first landing to provide themselves with some food.
I asked him what he thought would become of them there, and if they had formed
any design of making their escape. He said they had many consultations about
it; but that having neither vessel nor tools to build one, nor provisions of
any kind, their councils always ended in tears and despair. I asked him how he
thought they would receive a proposal from me, which might tend towards an
escape; and whether, if they were all here, it might not be done. I told him
with freedom, I feared mostly their treachery and ill-usage of me, if I put my
life in their hands; for that gratitude was no inherent virtue in the nature of
man, nor did men always square their dealings by the obligations they had
received so much as they did by the advantages they expected. I told him it
would be very hard that I should be made the instrument of their deliverance,
and that they should afterwards make me their prisoner in New Spain, where an
Englishman was certain to be made a sacrifice, what necessity or what accident
soever brought him thither; and that I had rather be delivered up to the
savages, and be devoured alive, than fall into the merciless claws of the
priests, and be carried into the Inquisition. I added that, otherwise, I was
persuaded, if they were all here, we might, with so many hands, build a barque
large enough to carry us all away, either to the Brazils southward, or to the
islands or Spanish coast northward; but that if, in requital, they should, when
I had put weapons into their hands, carry me by force among their own people, I
might be ill-used for my kindness to them, and make my case worse than it was
before.
He answered, with a great deal of candour and ingenuousness, that their
condition was so miserable, and that they were so sensible of it, that he
believed they would abhor the thought of using any man unkindly that should
contribute to their deliverance; and that, if I pleased, he would go to them
with the old man, and discourse with them about it, and return again and bring
me their answer; that he would make conditions with them upon their solemn
oath, that they should be absolutely under my direction as their commander and
captain; and they should swear upon the holy sacraments and gospel to be true
to me, and go to such Christian country as I should agree to, and no other; and
to be directed wholly and absolutely by my orders till they were landed safely
in such country as I intended, and that he would bring a contract from them,
under their hands, for that purpose. Then he told me he would first swear to me
himself that he would never stir from me as long as he lived till I gave him
orders; and that he would take my side to the last drop of his blood, if there
should happen the least breach of faith among his countrymen. He told me they
were all of them very civil, honest men, and they were under the greatest
distress imaginable, having neither weapons nor clothes, nor any food, but at
the mercy and discretion of the savages; out of all hopes of ever returning to
their own country; and that he was sure, if I would undertake their relief,
they would live and die by me.
Upon these assurances, I resolved to venture to relieve them, if possible, and
to send the old savage and this Spaniard over to them to treat. But when we had
got all things in readiness to go, the Spaniard himself started an objection,
which had so much prudence in it on one hand, and so much sincerity on the
other hand, that I could not but be very well satisfied in it; and, by his
advice, put off the deliverance of his comrades for at least half a year. The
case was thus: he had been with us now about a month, during which time I had
let him see in what manner I had provided, with the assistance of Providence,
for my support; and he saw evidently what stock of corn and rice I had laid up;
which, though it was more than sufficient for myself, yet it was not
sufficient, without good husbandry, for my family, now it was increased to
four; but much less would it be sufficient if his countrymen, who were, as he
said, sixteen, still alive, should come over; and least of all would it be
sufficient to victual our vessel, if we should build one, for a voyage to any
of the Christian colonies of America; so he told me he thought it would be more
advisable to let him and the other two dig and cultivate some more land, as
much as I could spare seed to sow, and that we should wait another harvest,
that we might have a supply of corn for his countrymen, when they should come;
for want might be a temptation to them to disagree, or not to think themselves
delivered, otherwise than out of one difficulty into another. “You
know,” says he, “the children of Israel, though they rejoiced at
first for their being delivered out of Egypt, yet rebelled even against God
Himself, that delivered them, when they came to want bread in the
wilderness.”
His caution was so seasonable, and his advice so good, that I could not but be
very well pleased with his proposal, as well as I was satisfied with his
fidelity; so we fell to digging, all four of us, as well as the wooden tools we
were furnished with permitted; and in about a month’s time, by the end of
which it was seed-time, we had got as much land cured and trimmed up as we
sowed two-and-twenty bushels of barley on, and sixteen jars of rice, which was,
in short, all the seed we had to spare: indeed, we left ourselves barely
sufficient, for our own food for the six months that we had to expect our crop;
that is to say reckoning from the time we set our seed aside for sowing; for it
is not to be supposed it is six months in the ground in that country.
Having now society enough, and our numbers being sufficient to put us out of
fear of the savages, if they had come, unless their number had been very great,
we went freely all over the island, whenever we found occasion; and as we had
our escape or deliverance upon our thoughts, it was impossible, at least for
me, to have the means of it out of mine. For this purpose I marked out several
trees, which I thought fit for our work, and I set Friday and his father to cut
them down; and then I caused the Spaniard, to whom I imparted my thoughts on
that affair, to oversee and direct their work. I showed them with what
indefatigable pains I had hewed a large tree into single planks, and I caused
them to do the like, till they made about a dozen large planks, of good oak,
near two feet broad, thirty-five feet long, and from two inches to four inches
thick: what prodigious labour it took up any one may imagine.
At the same time I contrived to increase my little flock of tame goats as much
as I could; and for this purpose I made Friday and the Spaniard go out one day,
and myself with Friday the next day (for we took our turns), and by this means
we got about twenty young kids to breed up with the rest; for whenever we shot
the dam, we saved the kids, and added them to our flock. But above all, the
season for curing the grapes coming on, I caused such a prodigious quantity to
be hung up in the sun, that, I believe, had we been at Alicant, where the
raisins of the sun are cured, we could have filled sixty or eighty barrels; and
these, with our bread, formed a great part of our food—very good living
too, I assure you, for they are exceedingly nourishing.
It was now harvest, and our crop in good order: it was not the most plentiful
increase I had seen in the island, but, however, it was enough to answer our
end; for from twenty-two bushels of barley we brought in and thrashed out above
two hundred and twenty bushels; and the like in proportion of the rice; which
was store enough for our food to the next harvest, though all the sixteen
Spaniards had been on shore with me; or, if we had been ready for a voyage, it
would very plentifully have victualled our ship to have carried us to any part
of the world; that is to say, any part of America. When we had thus housed and
secured our magazine of corn, we fell to work to make more wicker-ware, viz.
great baskets, in which we kept it; and the Spaniard was very handy and
dexterous at this part, and often blamed me that I did not make some things for
defence of this kind of work; but I saw no need of it.
And now, having a full supply of food for all the guests I expected, I gave the
Spaniard leave to go over to the main, to see what he could do with those he
had left behind him there. I gave him a strict charge not to bring any man who
would not first swear in the presence of himself and the old savage that he
would in no way injure, fight with, or attack the person he should find in the
island, who was so kind as to send for them in order to their deliverance; but
that they would stand by him and defend him against all such attempts, and
wherever they went would be entirely under and subjected to his command; and
that this should be put in writing, and signed in their hands. How they were to
have done this, when I knew they had neither pen nor ink, was a question which
we never asked. Under these instructions, the Spaniard and the old savage, the
father of Friday, went away in one of the canoes which they might be said to
have come in, or rather were brought in, when they came as prisoners to be
devoured by the savages. I gave each of them a musket, with a firelock on it,
and about eight charges of powder and ball, charging them to be very good
husbands of both, and not to use either of them but upon urgent occasions.
This was a cheerful work, being the first measures used by me in view of my
deliverance for now twenty-seven years and some days. I gave them provisions of
bread and of dried grapes, sufficient for themselves for many days, and
sufficient for all the Spaniards—for about eight days’ time; and
wishing them a good voyage, I saw them go, agreeing with them about a signal
they should hang out at their return, by which I should know them again when
they came back, at a distance, before they came on shore. They went away with a
fair gale on the day that the moon was at full, by my account in the month of
October; but as for an exact reckoning of days, after I had once lost it I
could never recover it again; nor had I kept even the number of years so
punctually as to be sure I was right; though, as it proved when I afterwards
examined my account, I found I had kept a true reckoning of years.
It was no less than eight days I had waited for them, when a strange and
unforeseen accident intervened, of which the like has not, perhaps, been heard
of in history. I was fast asleep in my hutch one morning, when my man Friday
came running in to me, and called aloud, “Master, master, they are come,
they are come!” I jumped up, and regardless of danger I went, as soon as
I could get my clothes on, through my little grove, which, by the way, was by
this time grown to be a very thick wood; I say, regardless of danger I went
without my arms, which was not my custom to do; but I was surprised when,
turning my eyes to the sea, I presently saw a boat at about a league and a half
distance, standing in for the shore, with a shoulder-of-mutton sail, as they
call it, and the wind blowing pretty fair to bring them in: also I observed,
presently, that they did not come from that side which the shore lay on, but
from the southernmost end of the island. Upon this I called Friday in, and bade
him lie close, for these were not the people we looked for, and that we might
not know yet whether they were friends or enemies. In the next place I went in
to fetch my perspective glass to see what I could make of them; and having
taken the ladder out, I climbed up to the top of the hill, as I used to do when
I was apprehensive of anything, and to take my view the plainer without being
discovered. I had scarce set my foot upon the hill when my eye plainly
discovered a ship lying at anchor, at about two leagues and a half distance
from me, SSE., but not above a league and a half from the shore. By my
observation it appeared plainly to be an English ship, and the boat appeared to
be an English long-boat.
I cannot express the confusion I was in, though the joy of seeing a ship, and
one that I had reason to believe was manned by my own countrymen, and
consequently friends, was such as I cannot describe; but yet I had some secret
doubts hung about me—I cannot tell from whence they came—bidding me
keep upon my guard. In the first place, it occurred to me to consider what
business an English ship could have in that part of the world, since it was not
the way to or from any part of the world where the English had any traffic; and
I knew there had been no storms to drive them in there in distress; and that if
they were really English it was most probable that they were here upon no good
design; and that I had better continue as I was than fall into the hands of
thieves and murderers.
Let no man despise the secret hints and notices of danger which sometimes are
given him when he may think there is no possibility of its being real. That
such hints and notices are given us I believe few that have made any
observation of things can deny; that they are certain discoveries of an
invisible world, and a converse of spirits, we cannot doubt; and if the
tendency of them seems to be to warn us of danger, why should we not suppose
they are from some friendly agent (whether supreme, or inferior and
subordinate, is not the question), and that they are given for our good?
The present question abundantly confirms me in the justice of this reasoning;
for had I not been made cautious by this secret admonition, come it from whence
it will, I had been done inevitably, and in a far worse condition than before,
as you will see presently. I had not kept myself long in this posture till I
saw the boat draw near the shore, as if they looked for a creek to thrust in
at, for the convenience of landing; however, as they did not come quite far
enough, they did not see the little inlet where I formerly landed my rafts, but
ran their boat on shore upon the beach, at about half a mile from me, which was
very happy for me; for otherwise they would have landed just at my door, as I
may say, and would soon have beaten me out of my castle, and perhaps have
plundered me of all I had. When they were on shore I was fully satisfied they
were Englishmen, at least most of them; one or two I thought were Dutch, but it
did not prove so; there were in all eleven men, whereof three of them I found
were unarmed and, as I thought, bound; and when the first four or five of them
were jumped on shore, they took those three out of the boat as prisoners: one
of the three I could perceive using the most passionate gestures of entreaty,
affliction, and despair, even to a kind of extravagance; the other two, I could
perceive, lifted up their hands sometimes, and appeared concerned indeed, but
not to such a degree as the first. I was perfectly confounded at the sight, and
knew not what the meaning of it should be. Friday called out to me in English,
as well as he could, “O master! you see English mans eat prisoner as well
as savage mans.” “Why, Friday,” says I, “do you think
they are going to eat them, then?” “Yes,” says Friday,
“they will eat them.” “No no,” says I, “Friday; I
am afraid they will murder them, indeed; but you may be sure they will not eat
them.”
All this while I had no thought of what the matter really was, but stood
trembling with the horror of the sight, expecting every moment when the three
prisoners should be killed; nay, once I saw one of the villains lift up his arm
with a great cutlass, as the seamen call it, or sword, to strike one of the
poor men; and I expected to see him fall every moment; at which all the blood
in my body seemed to run chill in my veins. I wished heartily now for the
Spaniard, and the savage that had gone with him, or that I had any way to have
come undiscovered within shot of them, that I might have secured the three men,
for I saw no firearms they had among them; but it fell out to my mind another
way. After I had observed the outrageous usage of the three men by the insolent
seamen, I observed the fellows run scattering about the island, as if they
wanted to see the country. I observed that the three other men had liberty to
go also where they pleased; but they sat down all three upon the ground, very
pensive, and looked like men in despair. This put me in mind of the first time
when I came on shore, and began to look about me; how I gave myself over for
lost; how wildly I looked round me; what dreadful apprehensions I had; and how
I lodged in the tree all night for fear of being devoured by wild beasts. As I
knew nothing that night of the supply I was to receive by the providential
driving of the ship nearer the land by the storms and tide, by which I have
since been so long nourished and supported; so these three poor desolate men
knew nothing how certain of deliverance and supply they were, how near it was
to them, and how effectually and really they were in a condition of safety, at
the same time that they thought themselves lost and their case desperate. So
little do we see before us in the world, and so much reason have we to depend
cheerfully upon the great Maker of the world, that He does not leave His
creatures so absolutely destitute, but that in the worst circumstances they
have always something to be thankful for, and sometimes are nearer deliverance
than they imagine; nay, are even brought to their deliverance by the means by
which they seem to be brought to their destruction.
It was just at high-water when these people came on shore; and while they
rambled about to see what kind of a place they were in, they had carelessly
stayed till the tide was spent, and the water was ebbed considerably away,
leaving their boat aground. They had left two men in the boat, who, as I found
afterwards, having drunk a little too much brandy, fell asleep; however, one of
them waking a little sooner than the other and finding the boat too fast
aground for him to stir it, hallooed out for the rest, who were straggling
about: upon which they all soon came to the boat: but it was past all their
strength to launch her, the boat being very heavy, and the shore on that side
being a soft oozy sand, almost like a quicksand. In this condition, like true
seamen, who are, perhaps, the least of all mankind given to forethought, they
gave it over, and away they strolled about the country again; and I heard one
of them say aloud to another, calling them off from the boat, “Why, let
her alone, Jack, can’t you? she’ll float next tide;” by which
I was fully confirmed in the main inquiry of what countrymen they were. All
this while I kept myself very close, not once daring to stir out of my castle
any farther than to my place of observation near the top of the hill: and very
glad I was to think how well it was fortified. I knew it was no less than ten
hours before the boat could float again, and by that time it would be dark, and
I might be at more liberty to see their motions, and to hear their discourse,
if they had any. In the meantime I fitted myself up for a battle as before,
though with more caution, knowing I had to do with another kind of enemy than I
had at first. I ordered Friday also, whom I had made an excellent marksman with
his gun, to load himself with arms. I took myself two fowling-pieces, and I
gave him three muskets. My figure, indeed, was very fierce; I had my formidable
goat-skin coat on, with the great cap I have mentioned, a naked sword by my
side, two pistols in my belt, and a gun upon each shoulder.
It was my design, as I said above, not to have made any attempt till it was
dark; but about two o’clock, being the heat of the day, I found that they
were all gone straggling into the woods, and, as I thought, laid down to sleep.
The three poor distressed men, too anxious for their condition to get any
sleep, had, however, sat down under the shelter of a great tree, at about a
quarter of a mile from me, and, as I thought, out of sight of any of the rest.
Upon this I resolved to discover myself to them, and learn something of their
condition; immediately I marched as above, my man Friday at a good distance
behind me, as formidable for his arms as I, but not making quite so staring a
spectre-like figure as I did. I came as near them undiscovered as I could, and
then, before any of them saw me, I called aloud to them in Spanish, “What
are ye, gentlemen?” They started up at the noise, but were ten times more
confounded when they saw me, and the uncouth figure that I made. They made no
answer at all, but I thought I perceived them just going to fly from me, when I
spoke to them in English. “Gentlemen,” said I, “do not be
surprised at me; perhaps you may have a friend near when you did not expect
it.” “He must be sent directly from heaven then,” said one of
them very gravely to me, and pulling off his hat at the same time to me;
“for our condition is past the help of man.” “All help is
from heaven, sir,” said I, “but can you put a stranger in the way
to help you? for you seem to be in some great distress. I saw you when you
landed; and when you seemed to make application to the brutes that came with
you, I saw one of them lift up his sword to kill you.”
The poor man, with tears running down his face, and trembling, looking like one
astonished, returned, “Am I talking to God or man? Is it a real man or an
angel?” “Be in no fear about that, sir,” said I; “if
God had sent an angel to relieve you, he would have come better clothed, and
armed after another manner than you see me; pray lay aside your fears; I am a
man, an Englishman, and disposed to assist you; you see I have one servant
only; we have arms and ammunition; tell us freely, can we serve you? What is
your case?” “Our case, sir,” said he, “is too long to
tell you while our murderers are so near us; but, in short, sir, I was
commander of that ship—my men have mutinied against me; they have been
hardly prevailed on not to murder me, and, at last, have set me on shore in
this desolate place, with these two men with me—one my mate, the other a
passenger—where we expected to perish, believing the place to be
uninhabited, and know not yet what to think of it.” “Where are
these brutes, your enemies?” said I; “do you know where they are
gone?” “There they lie, sir,” said he, pointing to a thicket
of trees; “my heart trembles for fear they have seen us and heard you
speak; if they have, they will certainly murder us all.” “Have they
any firearms?” said I. He answered, “They had only two pieces, one
of which they left in the boat.” “Well, then,” said I,
“leave the rest to me; I see they are all asleep; it is an easy thing to
kill them all; but shall we rather take them prisoners?” He told me there
were two desperate villains among them that it was scarce safe to show any
mercy to; but if they were secured, he believed all the rest would return to
their duty. I asked him which they were. He told me he could not at that
distance distinguish them, but he would obey my orders in anything I would
direct. “Well,” says I, “let us retreat out of their view or
hearing, lest they awake, and we will resolve further.” So they willingly
went back with me, till the woods covered us from them.
“Look you, sir,” said I, “if I venture upon your deliverance,
are you willing to make two conditions with me?” He anticipated my
proposals by telling me that both he and the ship, if recovered, should be
wholly directed and commanded by me in everything; and if the ship was not
recovered, he would live and die with me in what part of the world soever I
would send him; and the two other men said the same. “Well,” says
I, “my conditions are but two; first, that while you stay in this island
with me, you will not pretend to any authority here; and if I put arms in your
hands, you will, upon all occasions, give them up to me, and do no prejudice to
me or mine upon this island, and in the meantime be governed by my orders;
secondly, that if the ship is or may be recovered, you will carry me and my man
to England passage free.”
He gave me all the assurances that the invention or faith of man could devise
that he would comply with these most reasonable demands, and besides would owe
his life to me, and acknowledge it upon all occasions as long as he lived.
“Well, then,” said I, “here are three muskets for you, with
powder and ball; tell me next what you think is proper to be done.” He
showed all the testimonies of his gratitude that he was able, but offered to be
wholly guided by me. I told him I thought it was very hard venturing anything;
but the best method I could think of was to fire on them at once as they lay,
and if any were not killed at the first volley, and offered to submit, we might
save them, and so put it wholly upon God’s providence to direct the shot.
He said, very modestly, that he was loath to kill them if he could help it; but
that those two were incorrigible villains, and had been the authors of all the
mutiny in the ship, and if they escaped, we should be undone still, for they
would go on board and bring the whole ship’s company, and destroy us all.
“Well, then,” says I, “necessity legitimates my advice, for
it is the only way to save our lives.” However, seeing him still cautious
of shedding blood, I told him they should go themselves, and manage as they
found convenient.
In the middle of this discourse we heard some of them awake, and soon after we
saw two of them on their feet. I asked him if either of them were the heads of
the mutiny? He said, “No.” “Well, then,” said I,
“you may let them escape; and Providence seems to have awakened them on
purpose to save themselves. Now,” says I, “if the rest escape you,
it is your fault.” Animated with this, he took the musket I had given him
in his hand, and a pistol in his belt, and his two comrades with him, with each
a piece in his hand; the two men who were with him going first made some noise,
at which one of the seamen who was awake turned about, and seeing them coming,
cried out to the rest; but was too late then, for the moment he cried out they
fired—I mean the two men, the captain wisely reserving his own piece.
They had so well aimed their shot at the men they knew, that one of them was
killed on the spot, and the other very much wounded; but not being dead, he
started up on his feet, and called eagerly for help to the other; but the
captain stepping to him, told him it was too late to cry for help, he should
call upon God to forgive his villainy, and with that word knocked him down with
the stock of his musket, so that he never spoke more; there were three more in
the company, and one of them was slightly wounded. By this time I was come; and
when they saw their danger, and that it was in vain to resist, they begged for
mercy. The captain told them he would spare their lives if they would give him
an assurance of their abhorrence of the treachery they had been guilty of, and
would swear to be faithful to him in recovering the ship, and afterwards in
carrying her back to Jamaica, from whence they came. They gave him all the
protestations of their sincerity that could be desired; and he was willing to
believe them, and spare their lives, which I was not against, only that I
obliged him to keep them bound hand and foot while they were on the island.
While this was doing, I sent Friday with the captain’s mate to the boat
with orders to secure her, and bring away the oars and sails, which they did;
and by-and-by three straggling men, that were (happily for them) parted from
the rest, came back upon hearing the guns fired; and seeing the captain, who
was before their prisoner, now their conqueror, they submitted to be bound
also; and so our victory was complete.
It now remained that the captain and I should inquire into one another’s
circumstances. I began first, and told him my whole history, which he heard
with an attention even to amazement—and particularly at the wonderful
manner of my being furnished with provisions and ammunition; and, indeed, as my
story is a whole collection of wonders, it affected him deeply. But when he
reflected from thence upon himself, and how I seemed to have been preserved
there on purpose to save his life, the tears ran down his face, and he could
not speak a word more. After this communication was at an end, I carried him
and his two men into my apartment, leading them in just where I came out, viz.
at the top of the house, where I refreshed them with such provisions as I had,
and showed them all the contrivances I had made during my long, long inhabiting
that place.
All I showed them, all I said to them, was perfectly amazing; but above all,
the captain admired my fortification, and how perfectly I had concealed my
retreat with a grove of trees, which having been now planted nearly twenty
years, and the trees growing much faster than in England, was become a little
wood, so thick that it was impassable in any part of it but at that one side
where I had reserved my little winding passage into it. I told him this was my
castle and my residence, but that I had a seat in the country, as most princes
have, whither I could retreat upon occasion, and I would show him that too
another time; but at present our business was to consider how to recover the
ship. He agreed with me as to that, but told me he was perfectly at a loss what
measures to take, for that there were still six-and-twenty hands on board, who,
having entered into a cursed conspiracy, by which they had all forfeited their
lives to the law, would be hardened in it now by desperation, and would carry
it on, knowing that if they were subdued they would be brought to the gallows
as soon as they came to England, or to any of the English colonies, and that,
therefore, there would be no attacking them with so small a number as we were.
I mused for some time on what he had said, and found it was a very rational
conclusion, and that therefore something was to be resolved on speedily, as
well to draw the men on board into some snare for their surprise as to prevent
their landing upon us, and destroying us. Upon this, it presently occurred to
me that in a little while the ship’s crew, wondering what was become of
their comrades and of the boat, would certainly come on shore in their other
boat to look for them, and that then, perhaps, they might come armed, and be
too strong for us: this he allowed to be rational. Upon this, I told him the
first thing we had to do was to stave the boat which lay upon the beach, so
that they might not carry her off, and taking everything out of her, leave her
so far useless as not to be fit to swim. Accordingly, we went on board, took
the arms which were left on board out of her, and whatever else we found
there—which was a bottle of brandy, and another of rum, a few
biscuit-cakes, a horn of powder, and a great lump of sugar in a piece of canvas
(the sugar was five or six pounds): all which was very welcome to me,
especially the brandy and sugar, of which I had had none left for many years.
When we had carried all these things on shore (the oars, mast, sail, and rudder
of the boat were carried away before), we knocked a great hole in her bottom,
that if they had come strong enough to master us, yet they could not carry off
the boat. Indeed, it was not much in my thoughts that we could be able to
recover the ship; but my view was, that if they went away without the boat, I
did not much question to make her again fit to carry as to the Leeward Islands,
and call upon our friends the Spaniards in my way, for I had them still in my
thoughts.
CHAPTER XVIII.
THE SHIP RECOVERED
While we were thus preparing our designs, and had first, by main strength,
heaved the boat upon the beach, so high that the tide would not float her off
at high-water mark, and besides, had broke a hole in her bottom too big to be
quickly stopped, and were set down musing what we should do, we heard the ship
fire a gun, and make a waft with her ensign as a signal for the boat to come on
board—but no boat stirred; and they fired several times, making other
signals for the boat. At last, when all their signals and firing proved
fruitless, and they found the boat did not stir, we saw them, by the help of my
glasses, hoist another boat out and row towards the shore; and we found, as
they approached, that there were no less than ten men in her, and that they had
firearms with them.
As the ship lay almost two leagues from the shore, we had a full view of them
as they came, and a plain sight even of their faces; because the tide having
set them a little to the east of the other boat, they rowed up under shore, to
come to the same place where the other had landed, and where the boat lay; by
this means, I say, we had a full view of them, and the captain knew the persons
and characters of all the men in the boat, of whom, he said, there were three
very honest fellows, who, he was sure, were led into this conspiracy by the
rest, being over-powered and frightened; but that as for the boatswain, who it
seems was the chief officer among them, and all the rest, they were as
outrageous as any of the ship’s crew, and were no doubt made desperate in
their new enterprise; and terribly apprehensive he was that they would be too
powerful for us. I smiled at him, and told him that men in our circumstances
were past the operation of fear; that seeing almost every condition that could
be was better than that which we were supposed to be in, we ought to expect
that the consequence, whether death or life, would be sure to be a deliverance.
I asked him what he thought of the circumstances of my life, and whether a
deliverance were not worth venturing for? “And where, sir,” said I,
“is your belief of my being preserved here on purpose to save your life,
which elevated you a little while ago? For my part,” said I, “there
seems to be but one thing amiss in all the prospect of it.” “What
is that?” say he. “Why,” said I, “it is, that as you
say there are three or four honest fellows among them which should be spared,
had they been all of the wicked part of the crew I should have thought
God’s providence had singled them out to deliver them into your hands;
for depend upon it, every man that comes ashore is our own, and shall die or
live as they behave to us.” As I spoke this with a raised voice and
cheerful countenance, I found it greatly encouraged him; so we set vigorously
to our business.
We had, upon the first appearance of the boat’s coming from the ship,
considered of separating our prisoners; and we had, indeed, secured them
effectually. Two of them, of whom the captain was less assured than ordinary, I
sent with Friday, and one of the three delivered men, to my cave, where they
were remote enough, and out of danger of being heard or discovered, or of
finding their way out of the woods if they could have delivered themselves.
Here they left them bound, but gave them provisions; and promised them, if they
continued there quietly, to give them their liberty in a day or two; but that
if they attempted their escape they should be put to death without mercy. They
promised faithfully to bear their confinement with patience, and were very
thankful that they had such good usage as to have provisions and light left
them; for Friday gave them candles (such as we made ourselves) for their
comfort; and they did not know but that he stood sentinel over them at the
entrance.
The other prisoners had better usage; two of them were kept pinioned, indeed,
because the captain was not able to trust them; but the other two were taken
into my service, upon the captain’s recommendation, and upon their
solemnly engaging to live and die with us; so with them and the three honest
men we were seven men, well armed; and I made no doubt we should be able to
deal well enough with the ten that were coming, considering that the captain
had said there were three or four honest men among them also. As soon as they
got to the place where their other boat lay, they ran their boat into the beach
and came all on shore, hauling the boat up after them, which I was glad to see,
for I was afraid they would rather have left the boat at an anchor some
distance from the shore, with some hands in her to guard her, and so we should
not be able to seize the boat. Being on shore, the first thing they did, they
ran all to their other boat; and it was easy to see they were under a great
surprise to find her stripped, as above, of all that was in her, and a great
hole in her bottom. After they had mused a while upon this, they set up two or
three great shouts, hallooing with all their might, to try if they could make
their companions hear; but all was to no purpose. Then they came all close in a
ring, and fired a volley of their small arms, which indeed we heard, and the
echoes made the woods ring. But it was all one; those in the cave, we were
sure, could not hear; and those in our keeping, though they heard it well
enough, yet durst give no answer to them. They were so astonished at the
surprise of this, that, as they told us afterwards, they resolved to go all on
board again to their ship, and let them know that the men were all murdered,
and the long-boat staved; accordingly, they immediately launched their boat
again, and got all of them on board.
The captain was terribly amazed, and even confounded, at this, believing they
would go on board the ship again and set sail, giving their comrades over for
lost, and so he should still lose the ship, which he was in hopes we should
have recovered; but he was quickly as much frightened the other way.
They had not been long put off with the boat, when we perceived them all coming
on shore again; but with this new measure in their conduct, which it seems they
consulted together upon, viz. to leave three men in the boat, and the rest to
go on shore, and go up into the country to look for their fellows. This was a
great disappointment to us, for now we were at a loss what to do, as our
seizing those seven men on shore would be no advantage to us if we let the boat
escape; because they would row away to the ship, and then the rest of them
would be sure to weigh and set sail, and so our recovering the ship would be
lost. However we had no remedy but to wait and see what the issue of things
might present. The seven men came on shore, and the three who remained in the
boat put her off to a good distance from the shore, and came to an anchor to
wait for them; so that it was impossible for us to come at them in the boat.
Those that came on shore kept close together, marching towards the top of the
little hill under which my habitation lay; and we could see them plainly,
though they could not perceive us. We should have been very glad if they would
have come nearer us, so that we might have fired at them, or that they would
have gone farther off, that we might come abroad. But when they were come to
the brow of the hill where they could see a great way into the valleys and
woods, which lay towards the north-east part, and where the island lay lowest,
they shouted and hallooed till they were weary; and not caring, it seems, to
venture far from the shore, nor far from one another, they sat down together
under a tree to consider it. Had they thought fit to have gone to sleep there,
as the other part of them had done, they had done the job for us; but they were
too full of apprehensions of danger to venture to go to sleep, though they
could not tell what the danger was they had to fear.
The captain made a very just proposal to me upon this consultation of theirs,
viz. that perhaps they would all fire a volley again, to endeavour to make
their fellows hear, and that we should all sally upon them just at the juncture
when their pieces were all discharged, and they would certainly yield, and we
should have them without bloodshed. I liked this proposal, provided it was done
while we were near enough to come up to them before they could load their
pieces again. But this event did not happen; and we lay still a long time, very
irresolute what course to take. At length I told them there would be nothing
done, in my opinion, till night; and then, if they did not return to the boat,
perhaps we might find a way to get between them and the shore, and so might use
some stratagem with them in the boat to get them on shore. We waited a great
while, though very impatient for their removing; and were very uneasy when,
after long consultation, we saw them all start up and march down towards the
sea; it seems they had such dreadful apprehensions of the danger of the place
that they resolved to go on board the ship again, give their companions over
for lost, and so go on with their intended voyage with the ship.
As soon as I perceived them go towards the shore, I imagined it to be as it
really was that they had given over their search, and were going back again;
and the captain, as soon as I told him my thoughts, was ready to sink at the
apprehensions of it; but I presently thought of a stratagem to fetch them back
again, and which answered my end to a tittle. I ordered Friday and the
captain’s mate to go over the little creek westward, towards the place
where the savages came on shore, when Friday was rescued, and so soon as they
came to a little rising round, at about half a mile distant, I bid them halloo
out, as loud as they could, and wait till they found the seamen heard them;
that as soon as ever they heard the seamen answer them, they should return it
again; and then, keeping out of sight, take a round, always answering when the
others hallooed, to draw them as far into the island and among the woods as
possible, and then wheel about again to me by such ways as I directed them.
They were just going into the boat when Friday and the mate hallooed; and they
presently heard them, and answering, ran along the shore westward, towards the
voice they heard, when they were stopped by the creek, where the water being
up, they could not get over, and called for the boat to come up and set them
over; as, indeed, I expected. When they had set themselves over, I observed
that the boat being gone a good way into the creek, and, as it were, in a
harbour within the land, they took one of the three men out of her, to go along
with them, and left only two in the boat, having fastened her to the stump of a
little tree on the shore. This was what I wished for; and immediately leaving
Friday and the captain’s mate to their business, I took the rest with me;
and, crossing the creek out of their sight, we surprised the two men before
they were aware—one of them lying on the shore, and the other being in
the boat. The fellow on shore was between sleeping and waking, and going to
start up; the captain, who was foremost, ran in upon him, and knocked him down;
and then called out to him in the boat to yield, or he was a dead man. They
needed very few arguments to persuade a single man to yield, when he saw five
men upon him and his comrade knocked down: besides, this was, it seems, one of
the three who were not so hearty in the mutiny as the rest of the crew, and
therefore was easily persuaded not only to yield, but afterwards to join very
sincerely with us. In the meantime, Friday and the captain’s mate so well
managed their business with the rest that they drew them, by hallooing and
answering, from one hill to another, and from one wood to another, till they
not only heartily tired them, but left them where they were, very sure they
could not reach back to the boat before it was dark; and, indeed, they were
heartily tired themselves also, by the time they came back to us.
We had nothing now to do but to watch for them in the dark, and to fall upon
them, so as to make sure work with them. It was several hours after Friday came
back to me before they came back to their boat; and we could hear the foremost
of them, long before they came quite up, calling to those behind to come along;
and could also hear them answer, and complain how lame and tired they were, and
not able to come any faster: which was very welcome news to us. At length they
came up to the boat: but it is impossible to express their confusion when they
found the boat fast aground in the creek, the tide ebbed out, and their two men
gone. We could hear them call one to another in a most lamentable manner,
telling one another they were got into an enchanted island; that either there
were inhabitants in it, and they should all be murdered, or else there were
devils and spirits in it, and they should be all carried away and devoured.
They hallooed again, and called their two comrades by their names a great many
times; but no answer. After some time we could see them, by the little light
there was, run about, wringing their hands like men in despair, and sometimes
they would go and sit down in the boat to rest themselves: then come ashore
again, and walk about again, and so the same thing over again. My men would
fain have had me give them leave to fall upon them at once in the dark; but I
was willing to take them at some advantage, so as to spare them, and kill as
few of them as I could; and especially I was unwilling to hazard the killing of
any of our men, knowing the others were very well armed. I resolved to wait, to
see if they did not separate; and therefore, to make sure of them, I drew my
ambuscade nearer, and ordered Friday and the captain to creep upon their hands
and feet, as close to the ground as they could, that they might not be
discovered, and get as near them as they could possibly before they offered to
fire.
They had not been long in that posture when the boatswain, who was the
principal ringleader of the mutiny, and had now shown himself the most dejected
and dispirited of all the rest, came walking towards them, with two more of the
crew; the captain was so eager at having this principal rogue so much in his
power, that he could hardly have patience to let him come so near as to be sure
of him, for they only heard his tongue before: but when they came nearer, the
captain and Friday, starting up on their feet, let fly at them. The boatswain
was killed upon the spot: the next man was shot in the body, and fell just by
him, though he did not die till an hour or two after; and the third ran for it.
At the noise of the fire I immediately advanced with my whole army, which was
now eight men, viz. myself, generalissimo; Friday, my lieutenant-general; the
captain and his two men, and the three prisoners of war whom we had trusted
with arms. We came upon them, indeed, in the dark, so that they could not see
our number; and I made the man they had left in the boat, who was now one of
us, to call them by name, to try if I could bring them to a parley, and so
perhaps might reduce them to terms; which fell out just as we desired: for
indeed it was easy to think, as their condition then was, they would be very
willing to capitulate. So he calls out as loud as he could to one of them,
“Tom Smith! Tom Smith!” Tom Smith answered immediately, “Is
that Robinson?” for it seems he knew the voice. The other answered,
“Ay, ay; for God’s sake, Tom Smith, throw down your arms and yield,
or you are all dead men this moment.” “Who must we yield to? Where
are they?” says Smith again. “Here they are,” says he;
“here’s our captain and fifty men with him, have been hunting you
these two hours; the boatswain is killed; Will Fry is wounded, and I am a
prisoner; and if you do not yield you are all lost.” “Will they
give us quarter, then?” says Tom Smith, “and we will yield.”
“I’ll go and ask, if you promise to yield,” said Robinson: so
he asked the captain, and the captain himself then calls out, “You,
Smith, you know my voice; if you lay down your arms immediately and submit, you
shall have your lives, all but Will Atkins.”
Upon this Will Atkins cried out, “For God’s sake, captain, give me
quarter; what have I done? They have all been as bad as I:” which, by the
way, was not true; for it seems this Will Atkins was the first man that laid
hold of the captain when they first mutinied, and used him barbarously in tying
his hands and giving him injurious language. However, the captain told him he
must lay down his arms at discretion, and trust to the governor’s mercy:
by which he meant me, for they all called me governor. In a word, they all laid
down their arms and begged their lives; and I sent the man that had parleyed
with them, and two more, who bound them all; and then my great army of fifty
men, which, with those three, were in all but eight, came up and seized upon
them, and upon their boat; only that I kept myself and one more out of sight
for reasons of state.
Our next work was to repair the boat, and think of seizing the ship: and as for
the captain, now he had leisure to parley with them, he expostulated with them
upon the villainy of their practices with him, and upon the further wickedness
of their design, and how certainly it must bring them to misery and distress in
the end, and perhaps to the gallows. They all appeared very penitent, and
begged hard for their lives. As for that, he told them they were not his
prisoners, but the commander’s of the island; that they thought they had
set him on shore in a barren, uninhabited island; but it had pleased God so to
direct them that it was inhabited, and that the governor was an Englishman;
that he might hang them all there, if he pleased; but as he had given them all
quarter, he supposed he would send them to England, to be dealt with there as
justice required, except Atkins, whom he was commanded by the governor to
advise to prepare for death, for that he would be hanged in the morning.
Though this was all but a fiction of his own, yet it had its desired effect;
Atkins fell upon his knees to beg the captain to intercede with the governor
for his life; and all the rest begged of him, for God’s sake, that they
might not be sent to England.
It now occurred to me that the time of our deliverance was come, and that it
would be a most easy thing to bring these fellows in to be hearty in getting
possession of the ship; so I retired in the dark from them, that they might not
see what kind of a governor they had, and called the captain to me; when I
called, at a good distance, one of the men was ordered to speak again, and say
to the captain, “Captain, the commander calls for you;” and
presently the captain replied, “Tell his excellency I am just
coming.” This more perfectly amazed them, and they all believed that the
commander was just by, with his fifty men. Upon the captain coming to me, I
told him my project for seizing the ship, which he liked wonderfully well, and
resolved to put it in execution the next morning. But, in order to execute it
with more art, and to be secure of success, I told him we must divide the
prisoners, and that he should go and take Atkins, and two more of the worst of
them, and send them pinioned to the cave where the others lay. This was
committed to Friday and the two men who came on shore with the captain. They
conveyed them to the cave as to a prison: and it was, indeed, a dismal place,
especially to men in their condition. The others I ordered to my bower, as I
called it, of which I have given a full description: and as it was fenced in,
and they pinioned, the place was secure enough, considering they were upon
their behaviour.
To these in the morning I sent the captain, who was to enter into a parley with
them; in a word, to try them, and tell me whether he thought they might be
trusted or not to go on board and surprise the ship. He talked to them of the
injury done him, of the condition they were brought to, and that though the
governor had given them quarter for their lives as to the present action, yet
that if they were sent to England they would all be hanged in chains; but that
if they would join in so just an attempt as to recover the ship, he would have
the governor’s engagement for their pardon.
Any one may guess how readily such a proposal would be accepted by men in their
condition; they fell down on their knees to the captain, and promised, with the
deepest imprecations, that they would be faithful to him to the last drop, and
that they should owe their lives to him, and would go with him all over the
world; that they would own him as a father to them as long as they lived.
“Well,” says the captain, “I must go and tell the governor
what you say, and see what I can do to bring him to consent to it.” So he
brought me an account of the temper he found them in, and that he verily
believed they would be faithful. However, that we might be very secure, I told
him he should go back again and choose out those five, and tell them, that they
might see he did not want men, that he would take out those five to be his
assistants, and that the governor would keep the other two, and the three that
were sent prisoners to the castle (my cave), as hostages for the fidelity of
those five; and that if they proved unfaithful in the execution, the five
hostages should be hanged in chains alive on the shore. This looked severe, and
convinced them that the governor was in earnest; however, they had no way left
them but to accept it; and it was now the business of the prisoners, as much as
of the captain, to persuade the other five to do their duty.
Our strength was now thus ordered for the expedition: first, the captain, his
mate, and passenger; second, the two prisoners of the first gang, to whom,
having their character from the captain, I had given their liberty, and trusted
them with arms; third, the other two that I had kept till now in my bower,
pinioned, but on the captain’s motion had now released; fourth, these
five released at last; so that there were twelve in all, besides five we kept
prisoners in the cave for hostages.
I asked the captain if he was willing to venture with these hands on board the
ship; but as for me and my man Friday, I did not think it was proper for us to
stir, having seven men left behind; and it was employment enough for us to keep
them asunder, and supply them with victuals. As to the five in the cave, I
resolved to keep them fast, but Friday went in twice a day to them, to supply
them with necessaries; and I made the other two carry provisions to a certain
distance, where Friday was to take them.
When I showed myself to the two hostages, it was with the captain, who told
them I was the person the governor had ordered to look after them; and that it
was the governor’s pleasure they should not stir anywhere but by my
direction; that if they did, they would be fetched into the castle, and be laid
in irons: so that as we never suffered them to see me as governor, I now
appeared as another person, and spoke of the governor, the garrison, the
castle, and the like, upon all occasions.
The captain now had no difficulty before him, but to furnish his two boats,
stop the breach of one, and man them. He made his passenger captain of one,
with four of the men; and himself, his mate, and five more, went in the other;
and they contrived their business very well, for they came up to the ship about
midnight. As soon as they came within call of the ship, he made Robinson hail
them, and tell them they had brought off the men and the boat, but that it was
a long time before they had found them, and the like, holding them in a chat
till they came to the ship’s side; when the captain and the mate entering
first with their arms, immediately knocked down the second mate and carpenter
with the butt-end of their muskets, being very faithfully seconded by their
men; they secured all the rest that were upon the main and quarter decks, and
began to fasten the hatches, to keep them down that were below; when the other
boat and their men, entering at the forechains, secured the forecastle of the
ship, and the scuttle which went down into the cook-room, making three men they
found there prisoners. When this was done, and all safe upon deck, the captain
ordered the mate, with three men, to break into the round-house, where the new
rebel captain lay, who, having taken the alarm, had got up, and with two men
and a boy had got firearms in their hands; and when the mate, with a crow,
split open the door, the new captain and his men fired boldly among them, and
wounded the mate with a musket ball, which broke his arm, and wounded two more
of the men, but killed nobody. The mate, calling for help, rushed, however,
into the round-house, wounded as he was, and, with his pistol, shot the new
captain through the head, the bullet entering at his mouth, and came out again
behind one of his ears, so that he never spoke a word more: upon which the rest
yielded, and the ship was taken effectually, without any more lives lost.
As soon as the ship was thus secured, the captain ordered seven guns to be
fired, which was the signal agreed upon with me to give me notice of his
success, which, you may be sure, I was very glad to hear, having sat watching
upon the shore for it till near two o’clock in the morning. Having thus
heard the signal plainly, I laid me down; and it having been a day of great
fatigue to me, I slept very sound, till I was surprised with the noise of a
gun; and presently starting up, I heard a man call me by the name of
“Governor! Governor!” and presently I knew the captain’s
voice; when, climbing up to the top of the hill, there he stood, and, pointing
to the ship, he embraced me in his arms, “My dear friend and
deliverer,” says he, “there’s your ship; for she is all
yours, and so are we, and all that belong to her.” I cast my eyes to the
ship, and there she rode, within little more than half a mile of the shore; for
they had weighed her anchor as soon as they were masters of her, and, the
weather being fair, had brought her to an anchor just against the mouth of the
little creek; and the tide being up, the captain had brought the pinnace in
near the place where I had first landed my rafts, and so landed just at my
door. I was at first ready to sink down with the surprise; for I saw my
deliverance, indeed, visibly put into my hands, all things easy, and a large
ship just ready to carry me away whither I pleased to go. At first, for some
time, I was not able to answer him one word; but as he had taken me in his arms
I held fast by him, or I should have fallen to the ground. He perceived the
surprise, and immediately pulled a bottle out of his pocket and gave me a dram
of cordial, which he had brought on purpose for me. After I had drunk it, I sat
down upon the ground; and though it brought me to myself, yet it was a good
while before I could speak a word to him. All this time the poor man was in as
great an ecstasy as I, only not under any surprise as I was; and he said a
thousand kind and tender things to me, to compose and bring me to myself; but
such was the flood of joy in my breast, that it put all my spirits into
confusion: at last it broke out into tears, and in a little while after I
recovered my speech; I then took my turn, and embraced him as my deliverer, and
we rejoiced together. I told him I looked upon him as a man sent by Heaven to
deliver me, and that the whole transaction seemed to be a chain of wonders;
that such things as these were the testimonies we had of a secret hand of
Providence governing the world, and an evidence that the eye of an infinite
Power could search into the remotest corner of the world, and send help to the
miserable whenever He pleased. I forgot not to lift up my heart in thankfulness
to Heaven; and what heart could forbear to bless Him, who had not only in a
miraculous manner provided for me in such a wilderness, and in such a desolate
condition, but from whom every deliverance must always be acknowledged to
proceed.
When we had talked a while, the captain told me he had brought me some little
refreshment, such as the ship afforded, and such as the wretches that had been
so long his masters had not plundered him of. Upon this, he called aloud to the
boat, and bade his men bring the things ashore that were for the governor; and,
indeed, it was a present as if I had been one that was not to be carried away
with them, but as if I had been to dwell upon the island still. First, he had
brought me a case of bottles full of excellent cordial waters, six large
bottles of Madeira wine (the bottles held two quarts each), two pounds of
excellent good tobacco, twelve good pieces of the ship’s beef, and six
pieces of pork, with a bag of peas, and about a hundred-weight of biscuit; he
also brought me a box of sugar, a box of flour, a bag full of lemons, and two
bottles of lime-juice, and abundance of other things. But besides these, and
what was a thousand times more useful to me, he brought me six new clean
shirts, six very good neckcloths, two pair of gloves, one pair of shoes, a hat,
and one pair of stockings, with a very good suit of clothes of his own, which
had been worn but very little: in a word, he clothed me from head to foot. It
was a very kind and agreeable present, as any one may imagine, to one in my
circumstances, but never was anything in the world of that kind so unpleasant,
awkward, and uneasy as it was to me to wear such clothes at first.
After these ceremonies were past, and after all his good things were brought
into my little apartment, we began to consult what was to be done with the
prisoners we had; for it was worth considering whether we might venture to take
them with us or no, especially two of them, whom he knew to be incorrigible and
refractory to the last degree; and the captain said he knew they were such
rogues that there was no obliging them, and if he did carry them away, it must
be in irons, as malefactors, to be delivered over to justice at the first
English colony he could come to; and I found that the captain himself was very
anxious about it. Upon this, I told him that, if he desired it, I would
undertake to bring the two men he spoke of to make it their own request that he
should leave them upon the island. “I should be very glad of that,”
says the captain, “with all my heart.” “Well,” says I,
“I will send for them up and talk with them for you.” So I caused
Friday and the two hostages, for they were now discharged, their comrades
having performed their promise; I say, I caused them to go to the cave, and
bring up the five men, pinioned as they were, to the bower, and keep them there
till I came. After some time, I came thither dressed in my new habit; and now I
was called governor again. Being all met, and the captain with me, I caused the
men to be brought before me, and I told them I had got a full account of their
villainous behaviour to the captain, and how they had run away with the ship,
and were preparing to commit further robberies, but that Providence had
ensnared them in their own ways, and that they were fallen into the pit which
they had dug for others. I let them know that by my direction the ship had been
seized; that she lay now in the road; and they might see by-and-by that their
new captain had received the reward of his villainy, and that they would see
him hanging at the yard-arm; that, as to them, I wanted to know what they had
to say why I should not execute them as pirates taken in the fact, as by my
commission they could not doubt but I had authority so to do.
One of them answered in the name of the rest, that they had nothing to say but
this, that when they were taken the captain promised them their lives, and they
humbly implored my mercy. But I told them I knew not what mercy to show them;
for as for myself, I had resolved to quit the island with all my men, and had
taken passage with the captain to go to England; and as for the captain, he
could not carry them to England other than as prisoners in irons, to be tried
for mutiny and running away with the ship; the consequence of which, they must
needs know, would be the gallows; so that I could not tell what was best for
them, unless they had a mind to take their fate in the island. If they desired
that, as I had liberty to leave the island, I had some inclination to give them
their lives, if they thought they could shift on shore. They seemed very
thankful for it, and said they would much rather venture to stay there than be
carried to England to be hanged. So I left it on that issue.
However, the captain seemed to make some difficulty of it, as if he durst not
leave them there. Upon this I seemed a little angry with the captain, and told
him that they were my prisoners, not his; and that seeing I had offered them so
much favour, I would be as good as my word; and that if he did not think fit to
consent to it I would set them at liberty, as I found them: and if he did not
like it he might take them again if he could catch them. Upon this they
appeared very thankful, and I accordingly set them at liberty, and bade them
retire into the woods, to the place whence they came, and I would leave them
some firearms, some ammunition, and some directions how they should live very
well if they thought fit. Upon this I prepared to go on board the ship; but
told the captain I would stay that night to prepare my things, and desired him
to go on board in the meantime, and keep all right in the ship, and send the
boat on shore next day for me; ordering him, at all events, to cause the new
captain, who was killed, to be hanged at the yard-arm, that these men might see
him.
When the captain was gone I sent for the men up to me to my apartment, and
entered seriously into discourse with them on their circumstances. I told them
I thought they had made a right choice; that if the captain had carried them
away they would certainly be hanged. I showed them the new captain hanging at
the yard-arm of the ship, and told them they had nothing less to expect.
When they had all declared their willingness to stay, I then told them I would
let them into the story of my living there, and put them into the way of making
it easy to them. Accordingly, I gave them the whole history of the place, and
of my coming to it; showed them my fortifications, the way I made my bread,
planted my corn, cured my grapes; and, in a word, all that was necessary to
make them easy. I told them the story also of the seventeen Spaniards that were
to be expected, for whom I left a letter, and made them promise to treat them
in common with themselves. Here it may be noted that the captain, who had ink
on board, was greatly surprised that I never hit upon a way of making ink of
charcoal and water, or of something else, as I had done things much more
difficult.
I left them my firearms—viz. five muskets, three fowling-pieces, and
three swords. I had above a barrel and a half of powder left; for after the
first year or two I used but little, and wasted none. I gave them a description
of the way I managed the goats, and directions to milk and fatten them, and to
make both butter and cheese. In a word, I gave them every part of my own story;
and told them I should prevail with the captain to leave them two barrels of
gunpowder more, and some garden-seeds, which I told them I would have been very
glad of. Also, I gave them the bag of peas which the captain had brought me to
eat, and bade them be sure to sow and increase them.
CHAPTER XIX.
RETURN TO ENGLAND
Having done all this I left them the next day, and went on board the ship. We
prepared immediately to sail, but did not weigh that night. The next morning
early, two of the five men came swimming to the ship’s side, and making
the most lamentable complaint of the other three, begged to be taken into the
ship for God’s sake, for they should be murdered, and begged the captain
to take them on board, though he hanged them immediately. Upon this the captain
pretended to have no power without me; but after some difficulty, and after
their solemn promises of amendment, they were taken on board, and were, some
time after, soundly whipped and pickled; after which they proved very honest
and quiet fellows.
Some time after this, the boat was ordered on shore, the tide being up, with
the things promised to the men; to which the captain, at my intercession,
caused their chests and clothes to be added, which they took, and were very
thankful for. I also encouraged them, by telling them that if it lay in my
power to send any vessel to take them in, I would not forget them.
When I took leave of this island, I carried on board, for relics, the great
goat-skin cap I had made, my umbrella, and one of my parrots; also, I forgot
not to take the money I formerly mentioned, which had lain by me so long
useless that it was grown rusty or tarnished, and could hardly pass for silver
till it had been a little rubbed and handled, as also the money I found in the
wreck of the Spanish ship. And thus I left the island, the 19th of December, as
I found by the ship’s account, in the year 1686, after I had been upon it
eight-and-twenty years, two months, and nineteen days; being delivered from
this second captivity the same day of the month that I first made my escape in
the long-boat from among the Moors of Sallee. In this vessel, after a long
voyage, I arrived in England the 11th of June, in the year 1687, having been
thirty-five years absent.
When I came to England I was as perfect a stranger to all the world as if I had
never been known there. My benefactor and faithful steward, whom I had left my
money in trust with, was alive, but had had great misfortunes in the world; was
become a widow the second time, and very low in the world. I made her very easy
as to what she owed me, assuring her I would give her no trouble; but, on the
contrary, in gratitude for her former care and faithfulness to me, I relieved
her as my little stock would afford; which at that time would, indeed, allow me
to do but little for her; but I assured her I would never forget her former
kindness to me; nor did I forget her when I had sufficient to help her, as
shall be observed in its proper place. I went down afterwards into Yorkshire;
but my father was dead, and my mother and all the family extinct, except that I
found two sisters, and two of the children of one of my brothers; and as I had
been long ago given over for dead, there had been no provision made for me; so
that, in a word, I found nothing to relieve or assist me; and that the little
money I had would not do much for me as to settling in the world.
I met with one piece of gratitude indeed, which I did not expect; and this was,
that the master of the ship, whom I had so happily delivered, and by the same
means saved the ship and cargo, having given a very handsome account to the
owners of the manner how I had saved the lives of the men and the ship, they
invited me to meet them and some other merchants concerned, and all together
made me a very handsome compliment upon the subject, and a present of almost
£200 sterling.
But after making several reflections upon the circumstances of my life, and how
little way this would go towards settling me in the world, I resolved to go to
Lisbon, and see if I might not come at some information of the state of my
plantation in the Brazils, and of what was become of my partner, who, I had
reason to suppose, had some years past given me over for dead. With this view I
took shipping for Lisbon, where I arrived in April following, my man Friday
accompanying me very honestly in all these ramblings, and proving a most
faithful servant upon all occasions. When I came to Lisbon, I found out, by
inquiry, and to my particular satisfaction, my old friend, the captain of the
ship who first took me up at sea off the shore of Africa. He was now grown old,
and had left off going to sea, having put his son, who was far from a young
man, into his ship, and who still used the Brazil trade. The old man did not
know me, and indeed I hardly knew him. But I soon brought him to my
remembrance, and as soon brought myself to his remembrance, when I told him who
I was.
After some passionate expressions of the old acquaintance between us, I
inquired, you may be sure, after my plantation and my partner. The old man told
me he had not been in the Brazils for about nine years; but that he could
assure me that when he came away my partner was living, but the trustees whom I
had joined with him to take cognisance of my part were both dead: that,
however, he believed I would have a very good account of the improvement of the
plantation; for that, upon the general belief of my being cast away and
drowned, my trustees had given in the account of the produce of my part of the
plantation to the procurator-fiscal, who had appropriated it, in case I never
came to claim it, one-third to the king, and two-thirds to the monastery of St.
Augustine, to be expended for the benefit of the poor, and for the conversion
of the Indians to the Catholic faith: but that, if I appeared, or any one for
me, to claim the inheritance, it would be restored; only that the improvement,
or annual production, being distributed to charitable uses, could not be
restored: but he assured me that the steward of the king’s revenue from
lands, and the providore, or steward of the monastery, had taken great care all
along that the incumbent, that is to say my partner, gave every year a faithful
account of the produce, of which they had duly received my moiety. I asked him
if he knew to what height of improvement he had brought the plantation, and
whether he thought it might be worth looking after; or whether, on my going
thither, I should meet with any obstruction to my possessing my just right in
the moiety. He told me he could not tell exactly to what degree the plantation
was improved; but this he knew, that my partner was grown exceeding rich upon
the enjoying his part of it; and that, to the best of his remembrance, he had
heard that the king’s third of my part, which was, it seems, granted away
to some other monastery or religious house, amounted to above two hundred
moidores a year: that as to my being restored to a quiet possession of it,
there was no question to be made of that, my partner being alive to witness my
title, and my name being also enrolled in the register of the country; also he
told me that the survivors of my two trustees were very fair, honest people,
and very wealthy; and he believed I would not only have their assistance for
putting me in possession, but would find a very considerable sum of money in
their hands for my account, being the produce of the farm while their fathers
held the trust, and before it was given up, as above; which, as he remembered,
was for about twelve years.
I showed myself a little concerned and uneasy at this account, and inquired of
the old captain how it came to pass that the trustees should thus dispose of my
effects, when he knew that I had made my will, and had made him, the Portuguese
captain, my universal heir, &c.
He told me that was true; but that as there was no proof of my being dead, he
could not act as executor until some certain account should come of my death;
and, besides, he was not willing to intermeddle with a thing so remote: that it
was true he had registered my will, and put in his claim; and could he have
given any account of my being dead or alive, he would have acted by
procuration, and taken possession of the ingenio (so they call the
sugar-house), and have given his son, who was now at the Brazils, orders to do
it. “But,” says the old man, “I have one piece of news to
tell you, which perhaps may not be so acceptable to you as the rest; and that
is, believing you were lost, and all the world believing so also, your partner
and trustees did offer to account with me, in your name, for the first six or
eight years’ profits, which I received. There being at that time great
disbursements for increasing the works, building an ingenio, and buying slaves,
it did not amount to near so much as afterwards it produced; however,”
says the old man, “I shall give you a true account of what I have
received in all, and how I have disposed of it.”
After a few days’ further conference with this ancient friend, he brought
me an account of the first six years’ income of my plantation, signed by
my partner and the merchant-trustees, being always delivered in goods, viz.
tobacco in roll, and sugar in chests, besides rum, molasses, &c., which is
the consequence of a sugar-work; and I found by this account, that every year
the income considerably increased; but, as above, the disbursements being
large, the sum at first was small: however, the old man let me see that he was
debtor to me four hundred and seventy moidores of gold, besides sixty chests of
sugar and fifteen double rolls of tobacco, which were lost in his ship; he
having been shipwrecked coming home to Lisbon, about eleven years after my
having the place. The good man then began to complain of his misfortunes, and
how he had been obliged to make use of my money to recover his losses, and buy
him a share in a new ship. “However, my old friend,” says he,
“you shall not want a supply in your necessity; and as soon as my son
returns you shall be fully satisfied.” Upon this he pulls out an old
pouch, and gives me one hundred and sixty Portugal moidores in gold; and giving
the writings of his title to the ship, which his son was gone to the Brazils
in, of which he was quarter-part owner, and his son another, he puts them both
into my hands for security of the rest.
I was too much moved with the honesty and kindness of the poor man to be able
to bear this; and remembering what he had done for me, how he had taken me up
at sea, and how generously he had used me on all occasions, and particularly
how sincere a friend he was now to me, I could hardly refrain weeping at what
he had said to me; therefore I asked him if his circumstances admitted him to
spare so much money at that time, and if it would not straiten him? He told me
he could not say but it might straiten him a little; but, however, it was my
money, and I might want it more than he.
Everything the good man said was full of affection, and I could hardly refrain
from tears while he spoke; in short, I took one hundred of the moidores, and
called for a pen and ink to give him a receipt for them: then I returned him
the rest, and told him if ever I had possession of the plantation I would
return the other to him also (as, indeed, I afterwards did); and that as to the
bill of sale of his part in his son’s ship, I would not take it by any
means; but that if I wanted the money, I found he was honest enough to pay me;
and if I did not, but came to receive what he gave me reason to expect, I would
never have a penny more from him.
When this was past, the old man asked me if he should put me into a method to
make my claim to my plantation. I told him I thought to go over to it myself.
He said I might do so if I pleased, but that if I did not, there were ways
enough to secure my right, and immediately to appropriate the profits to my
use: and as there were ships in the river of Lisbon just ready to go away to
Brazil, he made me enter my name in a public register, with his affidavit,
affirming, upon oath, that I was alive, and that I was the same person who took
up the land for the planting the said plantation at first. This being regularly
attested by a notary, and a procuration affixed, he directed me to send it,
with a letter of his writing, to a merchant of his acquaintance at the place;
and then proposed my staying with him till an account came of the return.
Never was anything more honourable than the proceedings upon this procuration;
for in less than seven months I received a large packet from the survivors of
my trustees, the merchants, for whose account I went to sea, in which were the
following, particular letters and papers enclosed:—
First, there was the account-current of the produce of my farm or plantation,
from the year when their fathers had balanced with my old Portugal captain,
being for six years; the balance appeared to be one thousand one hundred and
seventy-four moidores in my favour.
Secondly, there was the account of four years more, while they kept the effects
in their hands, before the government claimed the administration, as being the
effects of a person not to be found, which they called civil death; and the
balance of this, the value of the plantation increasing, amounted to nineteen
thousand four hundred and forty-six crusadoes, being about three thousand two
hundred and forty moidores.
Thirdly, there was the Prior of St. Augustine’s account, who had received
the profits for above fourteen years; but not being able to account for what
was disposed of by the hospital, very honestly declared he had eight hundred
and seventy-two moidores not distributed, which he acknowledged to my account:
as to the king’s part, that refunded nothing.
There was a letter of my partner’s, congratulating me very affectionately
upon my being alive, giving me an account how the estate was improved, and what
it produced a year; with the particulars of the number of squares, or acres
that it contained, how planted, how many slaves there were upon it: and making
two-and-twenty crosses for blessings, told me he had said so many to thank the Blessed Virgin that I was alive; inviting me very
passionately to come over and take possession of my own, and in the meantime to
give him orders to whom he should deliver my effects if I did not come myself;
concluding with a hearty tender of his friendship, and that of his family; and
sent me as a present seven fine leopards’ skins, which he had, it seems,
received from Africa, by some other ship that he had sent thither, and which,
it seems, had made a better voyage than I. He sent me also five chests of
excellent sweetmeats, and a hundred pieces of gold uncoined, not quite so large
as moidores. By the same fleet my two merchant-trustees shipped me one thousand
two hundred chests of sugar, eight hundred rolls of tobacco, and the rest of
the whole account in gold.
I might well say now, indeed, that the latter end of Job was better than the
beginning. It is impossible to express the flutterings of my very heart when I
found all my wealth about me; for as the Brazil ships come all in fleets, the
same ships which brought my letters brought my goods: and the effects were safe
in the river before the letters came to my hand. In a word, I turned pale, and
grew sick; and, had not the old man run and fetched me a cordial, I believe the
sudden surprise of joy had overset nature, and I had died upon the spot: nay,
after that I continued very ill, and was so some hours, till a physician being
sent for, and something of the real cause of my illness being known, he ordered
me to be let blood; after which I had relief, and grew well: but I verily
believe, if I had not been eased by a vent given in that manner to the spirits,
I should have died.
I was now master, all on a sudden, of above five thousand pounds sterling in
money, and had an estate, as I might well call it, in the Brazils, of above a
thousand pounds a year, as sure as an estate of lands in England: and, in a
word, I was in a condition which I scarce knew how to understand, or how to
compose myself for the enjoyment of it. The first thing I did was to recompense
my original benefactor, my good old captain, who had been first charitable to
me in my distress, kind to me in my beginning, and honest to me at the end. I
showed him all that was sent to me; I told him that, next to the providence of
Heaven, which disposed all things, it was owing to him; and that it now lay on
me to reward him, which I would do a hundred-fold: so I first returned to him
the hundred moidores I had received of him; then I sent for a notary, and
caused him to draw up a general release or discharge from the four hundred and
seventy moidores, which he had acknowledged he owed me, in the fullest and
firmest manner possible. After which I caused a procuration to be drawn,
empowering him to be the receiver of the annual profits of my plantation: and
appointing my partner to account with him, and make the returns, by the usual
fleets, to him in my name; and by a clause in the end, made a grant of one
hundred moidores a year to him during his life, out of the effects, and fifty
moidores a year to his son after him, for his life: and thus I requited my old
man.
I had now to consider which way to steer my course next, and what to do with
the estate that Providence had thus put into my hands; and, indeed, I had more
care upon my head now than I had in my state of life in the island where I
wanted nothing but what I had, and had nothing but what I wanted; whereas I had
now a great charge upon me, and my business was how to secure it. I had not a
cave now to hide my money in, or a place where it might lie without lock or
key, till it grew mouldy and tarnished before anybody would meddle with it; on
the contrary, I knew not where to put it, or whom to trust with it. My old
patron, the captain, indeed, was honest, and that was the only refuge I had. In
the next place, my interest in the Brazils seemed to summon me thither; but now
I could not tell how to think of going thither till I had settled my affairs,
and left my effects in some safe hands behind me. At first I thought of my old
friend the widow, who I knew was honest, and would be just to me; but then she
was in years, and but poor, and, for aught I knew, might be in debt: so that,
in a word, I had no way but to go back to England myself and take my effects
with me.
It was some months, however, before I resolved upon this; and, therefore, as I
had rewarded the old captain fully, and to his satisfaction, who had been my
former benefactor, so I began to think of the poor widow, whose husband had
been my first benefactor, and she, while it was in her power, my faithful
steward and instructor. So, the first thing I did, I got a merchant in Lisbon
to write to his correspondent in London, not only to pay a bill, but to go find
her out, and carry her, in money, a hundred pounds from me, and to talk with
her, and comfort her in her poverty, by telling her she should, if I lived,
have a further supply: at the same time I sent my two sisters in the country a
hundred pounds each, they being, though not in want, yet not in very good
circumstances; one having been married and left a widow; and the other having a
husband not so kind to her as he should be. But among all my relations or
acquaintances I could not yet pitch upon one to whom I durst commit the gross
of my stock, that I might go away to the Brazils, and leave things safe behind
me; and this greatly perplexed me.
I had once a mind to have gone to the Brazils and have settled myself there,
for I was, as it were, naturalised to the place; but I had some little scruple
in my mind about religion, which insensibly drew me back. However, it was not
religion that kept me from going there for the present; and as I had made no
scruple of being openly of the religion of the country all the while I was
among them, so neither did I yet; only that, now and then, having of late
thought more of it than formerly, when I began to think of living and dying
among them, I began to regret having professed myself a Papist, and thought it
might not be the best religion to die with.
But, as I have said, this was not the main thing that kept me from going to the
Brazils, but that really I did not know with whom to leave my effects behind
me; so I resolved at last to go to England, where, if I arrived, I concluded
that I should make some acquaintance, or find some relations, that would be
faithful to me; and, accordingly, I prepared to go to England with all my
wealth.
In order to prepare things for my going home, I first (the Brazil fleet being
just going away) resolved to give answers suitable to the just and faithful
account of things I had from thence; and, first, to the Prior of St. Augustine
I wrote a letter full of thanks for his just dealings, and the offer of the
eight hundred and seventy-two moidores which were undisposed of, which I
desired might be given, five hundred to the monastery, and three hundred and
seventy-two to the poor, as the prior should direct; desiring the good
padre’s prayers for me, and the like. I wrote next a letter of thanks to
my two trustees, with all the acknowledgment that so much justice and honesty
called for: as for sending them any present, they were far above having any
occasion of it. Lastly, I wrote to my partner, acknowledging his industry in
the improving the plantation, and his integrity in increasing the stock of the
works; giving him instructions for his future government of my part, according
to the powers I had left with my old patron, to whom I desired him to send
whatever became due to me, till he should hear from me more particularly;
assuring him that it was my intention not only to come to him, but to settle
myself there for the remainder of my life. To this I added a very handsome
present of some Italian silks for his wife and two daughters, for such the
captain’s son informed me he had; with two pieces of fine English
broadcloth, the best I could get in Lisbon, five pieces of black baize, and
some Flanders lace of a good value.
Having thus settled my affairs, sold my cargo, and turned all my effects into
good bills of exchange, my next difficulty was which way to go to England: I
had been accustomed enough to the sea, and yet I had a strange aversion to go
to England by the sea at that time, and yet I could give no reason for it, yet
the difficulty increased upon me so much, that though I had once shipped my
baggage in order to go, yet I altered my mind, and that not once but two or
three times.
It is true I had been very unfortunate by sea, and this might be one of the
reasons; but let no man slight the strong impulses of his own thoughts in cases
of such moment: two of the ships which I had singled out to go in, I mean more
particularly singled out than any other, having put my things on board one of
them, and in the other having agreed with the captain; I say two of these ships
miscarried. One was taken by the Algerines, and the other was lost on the
Start, near Torbay, and all the people drowned except three; so that in either
of those vessels I had been made miserable.
Having been thus harassed in my thoughts, my old pilot, to whom I communicated
everything, pressed me earnestly not to go by sea, but either to go by land to
the Groyne, and cross over the Bay of Biscay to Rochelle, from whence it was
but an easy and safe journey by land to Paris, and so to Calais and Dover; or
to go up to Madrid, and so all the way by land through France. In a word, I was
so prepossessed against my going by sea at all, except from Calais to Dover,
that I resolved to travel all the way by land; which, as I was not in haste,
and did not value the charge, was by much the pleasanter way: and to make it
more so, my old captain brought an English gentleman, the son of a merchant in
Lisbon, who was willing to travel with me; after which we picked up two more
English merchants also, and two young Portuguese gentlemen, the last going to
Paris only; so that in all there were six of us and five servants; the two
merchants and the two Portuguese, contenting themselves with one servant
between two, to save the charge; and as for me, I got an English sailor to
travel with me as a servant, besides my man Friday, who was too much a stranger
to be capable of supplying the place of a servant on the road.
In this manner I set out from Lisbon; and our company being very well mounted
and armed, we made a little troop, whereof they did me the honour to call me
captain, as well because I was the oldest man, as because I had two servants,
and, indeed, was the origin of the whole journey.
As I have troubled you with none of my sea journals, so I shall trouble you now
with none of my land journals; but some adventures that happened to us in this
tedious and difficult journey I must not omit.
When we came to Madrid, we, being all of us strangers to Spain, were willing to
stay some time to see the court of Spain, and what was worth observing; but it
being the latter part of the summer, we hastened away, and set out from Madrid
about the middle of October; but when we came to the edge of Navarre, we were
alarmed, at several towns on the way, with an account that so much snow was
falling on the French side of the mountains, that several travellers were
obliged to come back to Pampeluna, after having attempted at an extreme hazard
to pass on.
When we came to Pampeluna itself, we found it so indeed; and to me, that had
been always used to a hot climate, and to countries where I could scarce bear
any clothes on, the cold was insufferable; nor, indeed, was it more painful
than surprising to come but ten days before out of Old Castile, where the
weather was not only warm but very hot, and immediately to feel a wind from the
Pyrenean Mountains so very keen, so severely cold, as to be intolerable and to
endanger benumbing and perishing of our fingers and toes.
Poor Friday was really frightened when he saw the mountains all covered with
snow, and felt cold weather, which he had never seen or felt before in his
life. To mend the matter, when we came to Pampeluna it continued snowing with
so much violence and so long, that the people said winter was come before its
time; and the roads, which were difficult before, were now quite impassable;
for, in a word, the snow lay in some places too thick for us to travel, and
being not hard frozen, as is the case in the northern countries, there was no
going without being in danger of being buried alive every step. We stayed no
less than twenty days at Pampeluna; when (seeing the winter coming on, and no
likelihood of its being better, for it was the severest winter all over Europe
that had been known in the memory of man) I proposed that we should go away to
Fontarabia, and there take shipping for Bordeaux, which was a very little
voyage. But, while I was considering this, there came in four French gentlemen,
who, having been stopped on the French side of the passes, as we were on the
Spanish, had found out a guide, who, traversing the country near the head of
Languedoc, had brought them over the mountains by such ways that they were not
much incommoded with the snow; for where they met with snow in any quantity,
they said it was frozen hard enough to bear them and their horses. We sent for
this guide, who told us he would undertake to carry us the same way, with no
hazard from the snow, provided we were armed sufficiently to protect ourselves
from wild beasts; for, he said, in these great snows it was frequent for some
wolves to show themselves at the foot of the mountains, being made ravenous for
want of food, the ground being covered with snow. We told him we were well
enough prepared for such creatures as they were, if he would insure us from a
kind of two-legged wolves, which we were told we were in most danger from,
especially on the French side of the mountains. He satisfied us that there was
no danger of that kind in the way that we were to go; so we readily agreed to
follow him, as did also twelve other gentlemen with their servants, some
French, some Spanish, who, as I said, had attempted to go, and were obliged to
come back again.
Accordingly, we set out from Pampeluna with our guide on the 15th of November;
and indeed I was surprised when, instead of going forward, he came directly
back with us on the same road that we came from Madrid, about twenty miles;
when, having passed two rivers, and come into the plain country, we found
ourselves in a warm climate again, where the country was pleasant, and no snow
to be seen; but, on a sudden, turning to his left, he approached the mountains
another way; and though it is true the hills and precipices looked dreadful,
yet he made so many tours, such meanders, and led us by such winding ways, that
we insensibly passed the height of the mountains without being much encumbered
with the snow; and all on a sudden he showed us the pleasant and fruitful
provinces of Languedoc and Gascony, all green and flourishing, though at a
great distance, and we had some rough way to pass still.
We were a little uneasy, however, when we found it snowed one whole day and a
night so fast that we could not travel; but he bid us be easy; we should soon
be past it all: we found, indeed, that we began to descend every day, and to
come more north than before; and so, depending upon our guide, we went on.
It was about two hours before night when, our guide being something before us,
and not just in sight, out rushed three monstrous wolves, and after them a
bear, from a hollow way adjoining to a thick wood; two of the wolves made at
the guide, and had he been far before us, he would have been devoured before we
could have helped him; one of them fastened upon his horse, and the other
attacked the man with such violence, that he had not time, or presence of mind
enough, to draw his pistol, but hallooed and cried out to us most lustily. My
man Friday being next me, I bade him ride up and see what was the matter. As
soon as Friday came in sight of the man, he hallooed out as loud as the other,
“O master! O master!” but like a bold fellow, rode directly up to
the poor man, and with his pistol shot the wolf in the head that attacked him.
It was happy for the poor man that it was my man Friday; for, having been used
to such creatures in his country, he had no fear upon him, but went close up to
him and shot him; whereas, any other of us would have fired at a farther
distance, and have perhaps either missed the wolf or endangered shooting the
man.
But it was enough to have terrified a bolder man than I; and, indeed, it
alarmed all our company, when, with the noise of Friday’s pistol, we
heard on both sides the most dismal howling of wolves; and the noise, redoubled
by the echo of the mountains, appeared to us as if there had been a prodigious
number of them; and perhaps there was not such a few as that we had no cause of
apprehension: however, as Friday had killed this wolf, the other that had
fastened upon the horse left him immediately, and fled, without doing him any
damage, having happily fastened upon his head, where the bosses of the bridle
had stuck in his teeth. But the man was most hurt; for the raging creature had
bit him twice, once in the arm, and the other time a little above his knee; and
though he had made some defence, he was just tumbling down by the disorder of
his horse, when Friday came up and shot the wolf.
It is easy to suppose that at the noise of Friday’s pistol we all mended
our pace, and rode up as fast as the way, which was very difficult, would give
us leave, to see what was the matter. As soon as we came clear of the trees,
which blinded us before, we saw clearly what had been the case, and how Friday
had disengaged the poor guide, though we did not presently discern what kind of
creature it was he had killed.
CHAPTER XX.
FIGHT BETWEEN FRIDAY AND A BEAR
But never was a fight managed so hardily, and in such a surprising manner as
that which followed between Friday and the bear, which gave us all, though at
first we were surprised and afraid for him, the greatest diversion imaginable.
As the bear is a heavy, clumsy creature, and does not gallop as the wolf does,
who is swift and light, so he has two particular qualities, which generally are
the rule of his actions; first, as to men, who are not his proper prey (he does
not usually attempt them, except they first attack him, unless he be
excessively hungry, which it is probable might now be the case, the ground
being covered with snow), if you do not meddle with him, he will not meddle
with you; but then you must take care to be very civil to him, and give him the
road, for he is a very nice gentleman; he will not go a step out of his way for
a prince; nay, if you are really afraid, your best way is to look another way
and keep going on; for sometimes if you stop, and stand still, and look
steadfastly at him, he takes it for an affront; but if you throw or toss
anything at him, though it were but a bit of stick as big as your finger, he
thinks himself abused, and sets all other business aside to pursue his revenge,
and will have satisfaction in point of honour—that is his first quality:
the next is, if he be once affronted, he will never leave you, night or day,
till he has his revenge, but follows at a good round rate till he overtakes
you.
My man Friday had delivered our guide, and when we came up to him he was
helping him off his horse, for the man was both hurt and frightened, when on a
sudden we espied the bear come out of the wood; and a monstrous one it was, the
biggest by far that ever I saw. We were all a little surprised when we saw him;
but when Friday saw him, it was easy to see joy and courage in the
fellow’s countenance. “O! O! O!” says Friday, three times,
pointing to him; “O master, you give me te leave, me shakee te hand with
him; me makee you good laugh.”
I was surprised to see the fellow so well pleased. “You fool,” says
I, “he will eat you up.”—“Eatee me up! eatee me
up!” says Friday, twice over again; “me eatee him up; me makee you
good laugh; you all stay here, me show you good laugh.” So down he sits,
and gets off his boots in a moment, and puts on a pair of pumps (as we call the
flat shoes they wear, and which he had in his pocket), gives my other servant
his horse, and with his gun away he flew, swift like the wind.
The bear was walking softly on, and offered to meddle with nobody, till Friday
coming pretty near, calls to him, as if the bear could understand him.
“Hark ye, hark ye,” says Friday, “me speakee with you.”
We followed at a distance, for now being down on the Gascony side of the
mountains, we were entered a vast forest, where the country was plain and
pretty open, though it had many trees in it scattered here and there. Friday,
who had, as we say, the heels of the bear, came up with him quickly, and took
up a great stone, and threw it at him, and hit him just on the head, but did
him no more harm than if he had thrown it against a wall; but it answered
Friday’s end, for the rogue was so void of fear that he did it purely to
make the bear follow him, and show us some laugh as he called it. As soon as
the bear felt the blow, and saw him, he turns about and comes after him, taking
very long strides, and shuffling on at a strange rate, so as would have put a
horse to a middling gallop; away runs Friday, and takes his course as if he
ran towards us for help; so we all resolved to fire at once upon the bear, and
deliver my man; though I was angry at him for bringing the bear back upon us,
when he was going about his own business another way; and especially I was
angry that he had turned the bear upon us, and then ran away; and I called out,
“You dog! is this your making us laugh? Come away, and take your horse,
that we may shoot the creature.” He heard me, and cried out, “No
shoot, no shoot; stand still, and you get much laugh:” and as the nimble
creature ran two feet for the bear’s one, he turned on a sudden on one
side of us, and seeing a great oak-tree fit for his purpose, he beckoned to us
to follow; and doubling his pace, he got nimbly up the tree, laying his gun
down upon the ground, at about five or six yards from the bottom of the tree.
The bear soon came to the tree, and we followed at a distance: the first thing
he did he stopped at the gun, smelt at it, but let it lie, and up he scrambles
into the tree, climbing like a cat, though so monstrous heavy. I was amazed at
the folly, as I thought it, of my man, and could not for my life see anything
to laugh at, till seeing the bear get up the tree, we all rode near to him.
When we came to the tree, there was Friday got out to the small end of a large
branch, and the bear got about half-way to him. As soon as the bear got out to
that part where the limb of the tree was weaker, “Ha!” says he to
us, “now you see me teachee the bear dance:” so he began jumping
and shaking the bough, at which the bear began to totter, but stood still, and
began to look behind him, to see how he should get back; then, indeed, we did
laugh heartily. But Friday had not done with him by a great deal; when seeing
him stand still, he called out to him again, as if he had supposed the bear
could speak English, “What, you come no farther? pray you come
farther;” so he left jumping and shaking the tree; and the bear, just as
if he understood what he said, did come a little farther; then he began jumping
again, and the bear stopped again. We thought now was a good time to knock him
in the head, and called to Friday to stand still and we should shoot the bear:
but he cried out earnestly, “Oh, pray! Oh, pray! no shoot, me shoot by
and then:” he would have said by-and-by. However, to shorten the story,
Friday danced so much, and the bear stood so ticklish, that we had laughing
enough, but still could not imagine what the fellow would do: for first we
thought he depended upon shaking the bear off; and we found the bear was too
cunning for that too; for he would not go out far enough to be thrown down, but
clung fast with his great broad claws and feet, so that we could not imagine
what would be the end of it, and what the jest would be at last. But Friday put
us out of doubt quickly: for seeing the bear cling fast to the bough, and that
he would not be persuaded to come any farther, “Well, well,” says
Friday, “you no come farther, me go; you no come to me, me come to
you;” and upon this he went out to the smaller end, where it would bend
with his weight, and gently let himself down by it, sliding down the bough till
he came near enough to jump down on his feet, and away he ran to his gun, took
it up, and stood still. “Well,” said I to him, “Friday, what
will you do now? Why don’t you shoot him?” “No shoot,”
says Friday, “no yet; me shoot now, me no kill; me stay, give you one
more laugh:” and, indeed, so he did; for when the bear saw his enemy
gone, he came back from the bough, where he stood, but did it very cautiously,
looking behind him every step, and coming backward till he got into the body of
the tree, then, with the same hinder end foremost, he came down the tree,
grasping it with his claws, and moving one foot at a time, very leisurely. At
this juncture, and just before he could set his hind foot on the ground, Friday
stepped up close to him, clapped the muzzle of his piece into his ear, and shot
him dead. Then the rogue turned about to see if we did not laugh; and when he
saw we were pleased by our looks, he began to laugh very loud. “So we
kill bear in my country,” says Friday. “So you kill them?”
says I; “why, you have no guns.”—“No,” says he,
“no gun, but shoot great much long arrow.” This was a good
diversion to us; but we were still in a wild place, and our guide very much
hurt, and what to do we hardly knew; the howling of wolves ran much in my head;
and, indeed, except the noise I once heard on the shore of Africa, of which I
have said something already, I never heard anything that filled me with so much
horror.
These things, and the approach of night, called us off, or else, as Friday
would have had us, we should certainly have taken the skin of this monstrous
creature off, which was worth saving; but we had near three leagues to go, and
our guide hastened us; so we left him, and went forward on our journey.
The ground was still covered with snow, though not so deep and dangerous as on
the mountains; and the ravenous creatures, as we heard afterwards, were come
down into the forest and plain country, pressed by hunger, to seek for food,
and had done a great deal of mischief in the villages, where they surprised the
country people, killed a great many of their sheep and horses, and some people
too.
We had one dangerous place to pass, and our guide told us if there were more wolves in the country we should find them there; and this was a small plain, surrounded with woods on every side, and a long, narrow defile, or lane, which we were to pass to get through the wood, and then we should come to the village where we were to lodge.
It was within half-an-hour of sunset when we entered the wood, and a little
after sunset when we came into the plain: we met with nothing in the first
wood, except that in a little plain within the wood, which was not above two
furlongs over, we saw five great wolves cross the road, full speed, one after
another, as if they had been in chase of some prey, and had it in view; they
took no notice of us, and were gone out of sight in a few moments. Upon this,
our guide, who, by the way, was but a fainthearted fellow, bid us keep in a
ready posture, for he believed there were more wolves a-coming. We kept our
arms ready, and our eyes about us; but we saw no more wolves till we came
through that wood, which was near half a league, and entered the plain. As soon
as we came into the plain, we had occasion enough to look about us. The first
object we met with was a dead horse; that is to say, a poor horse which the
wolves had killed, and at least a dozen of them at work, we could not say
eating him, but picking his bones rather; for they had eaten up all the flesh
before. We did not think fit to disturb them at their feast, neither did they
take much notice of us. Friday would have let fly at them, but I would not
suffer him by any means; for I found we were like to have more business upon
our hands than we were aware of. We had not gone half over the plain when we
began to hear the wolves howl in the wood on our left in a frightful manner,
and presently after we saw about a hundred coming on directly towards us, all
in a body, and most of them in a line, as regularly as an army drawn up by
experienced officers. I scarce knew in what manner to receive them, but found
to draw ourselves in a close line was the only way; so we formed in a moment;
but that we might not have too much interval, I ordered that only every other
man should fire, and that the others, who had not fired, should stand ready to
give them a second volley immediately, if they continued to advance upon us;
and then that those that had fired at first should not pretend to load their
fusees again, but stand ready, every one with a pistol, for we were all armed
with a fusee and a pair of pistols each man; so we were, by this method, able
to fire six volleys, half of us at a time; however, at present we had no
necessity; for upon firing the first volley, the enemy made a full stop, being
terrified as well with the noise as with the fire. Four of them being shot in
the head, dropped; several others were wounded, and went bleeding off, as we
could see by the snow. I found they stopped, but did not immediately retreat;
whereupon, remembering that I had been told that the fiercest creatures were
terrified at the voice of a man, I caused all the company to halloo as loud as
they could; and I found the notion not altogether mistaken; for upon our shout
they began to retire and turn about. I then ordered a second volley to be fired
in their rear, which put them to the gallop, and away they went to the woods.
This gave us leisure to charge our pieces again; and that we might lose no
time, we kept going; but we had but little more than loaded our fusees, and put
ourselves in readiness, when we heard a terrible noise in the same wood on our
left, only that it was farther onward, the same way we were to go.
The night was coming on, and the light began to be dusky, which made it worse
on our side; but the noise increasing, we could easily perceive that it was the
howling and yelling of those hellish creatures; and on a sudden we perceived
three troops of wolves, one on our left, one behind us, and one in our front,
so that we seemed to be surrounded with them: however, as they did not fall
upon us, we kept our way forward, as fast as we could make our horses go,
which, the way being very rough, was only a good hard trot. In this manner, we
came in view of the entrance of a wood, through which we were to pass, at the
farther side of the plain; but we were greatly surprised, when coming nearer
the lane or pass, we saw a confused number of wolves standing just at the
entrance. On a sudden, at another opening of the wood, we heard the noise of a
gun, and looking that way, out rushed a horse, with a saddle and a bridle on
him, flying like the wind, and sixteen or seventeen wolves after him, full
speed: the horse had the advantage of them; but as we supposed that he could
not hold it at that rate, we doubted not but they would get up with him at
last: no question but they did.
But here we had a most horrible sight; for riding up to the entrance where the
horse came out, we found the carcasses of another horse and of two men,
devoured by the ravenous creatures; and one of the men was no doubt the same
whom we heard fire the gun, for there lay a gun just by him fired off; but as
to the man, his head and the upper part of his body was eaten up. This filled
us with horror, and we knew not what course to take; but the creatures resolved
us soon, for they gathered about us presently, in hopes of prey; and I verily
believe there were three hundred of them. It happened, very much to our
advantage, that at the entrance into the wood, but a little way from it, there
lay some large timber-trees, which had been cut down the summer before, and I
suppose lay there for carriage. I drew my little troop in among those trees,
and placing ourselves in a line behind one long tree, I advised them all to
alight, and keeping that tree before us for a breastwork, to stand in a
triangle, or three fronts, enclosing our horses in the centre. We did so, and
it was well we did; for never was a more furious charge than the creatures made
upon us in this place. They came on with a growling kind of noise, and mounted
the piece of timber, which, as I said, was our breastwork, as if they were only
rushing upon their prey; and this fury of theirs, it seems, was principally
occasioned by their seeing our horses behind us. I ordered our men to fire as
before, every other man; and they took their aim so sure that they killed
several of the wolves at the first volley; but there was a necessity to keep a
continual firing, for they came on like devils, those behind pushing on those
before.
When we had fired a second volley of our fusees, we thought they stopped a
little, and I hoped they would have gone off, but it was but a moment, for
others came forward again; so we fired two volleys of our pistols; and I
believe in these four firings we had killed seventeen or eighteen of them, and
lamed twice as many, yet they came on again. I was loth to spend our shot too
hastily; so I called my servant, not my man Friday, for he was better employed,
for, with the greatest dexterity imaginable, he had charged my fusee and his
own while we were engaged—but, as I said, I called my other man, and
giving him a horn of powder, I had him lay a train all along the piece of
timber, and let it be a large train. He did so, and had but just time to get
away, when the wolves came up to it, and some got upon it, when I, snapping an
uncharged pistol close to the powder, set it on fire; those that were upon the
timber were scorched with it, and six or seven of them fell; or rather jumped
in among us with the force and fright of the fire; we despatched these in an
instant, and the rest were so frightened with the light, which the
night—for it was now very near dark—made more terrible that they
drew back a little; upon which I ordered our last pistols to be fired off in
one volley, and after that we gave a shout; upon this the wolves turned tail,
and we sallied immediately upon near twenty lame ones that we found struggling
on the ground, and fell to cutting them with our swords, which answered our
expectation, for the crying and howling they made was better understood by
their fellows; so that they all fled and left us.
We had, first and last, killed about threescore of them, and had it been
daylight we had killed many more. The field of battle being thus cleared, we
made forward again, for we had still near a league to go. We heard the ravenous
creatures howl and yell in the woods as we went several times, and sometimes we
fancied we saw some of them; but the snow dazzling our eyes, we were not
certain. In about an hour more we came to the town where we were to lodge,
which we found in a terrible fright and all in arms; for, it seems, the night
before the wolves and some bears had broken into the village, and put them in
such terror that they were obliged to keep guard night and day, but especially
in the night, to preserve their cattle, and indeed their people.
The next morning our guide was so ill, and his limbs swelled so much with the
rankling of his two wounds, that he could go no farther; so we were obliged to
take a new guide here, and go to Toulouse, where we found a warm climate, a
fruitful, pleasant country, and no snow, no wolves, nor anything like them; but
when we told our story at Toulouse, they told us it was nothing but what was
ordinary in the great forest at the foot of the mountains, especially when the
snow lay on the ground; but they inquired much what kind of guide we had got
who would venture to bring us that way in such a severe season, and told us it
was surprising we were not all devoured. When we told them how we placed
ourselves and the horses in the middle, they blamed us exceedingly, and told us
it was fifty to one but we had been all destroyed, for it was the sight of the
horses which made the wolves so furious, seeing their prey, and that at other
times they are really afraid of a gun; but being excessively hungry, and raging
on that account, the eagerness to come at the horses had made them senseless of
danger, and that if we had not by the continual fire, and at last by the
stratagem of the train of powder, mastered them, it had been great odds but
that we had been torn to pieces; whereas, had we been content to have sat still
on horseback, and fired as horsemen, they would not have taken the horses so
much for their own, when men were on their backs, as otherwise; and withal,
they told us that at last, if we had stood altogether, and left our horses,
they would have been so eager to have devoured them, that we might have come
off safe, especially having our firearms in our hands, being so many in number.
For my part, I was never so sensible of danger in my life; for, seeing above
three hundred devils come roaring and open-mouthed to devour us, and having
nothing to shelter us or retreat to, I gave myself over for lost; and, as it
was, I believe I shall never care to cross those mountains again: I think I
would much rather go a thousand leagues by sea, though I was sure to meet with
a storm once a-week.
I have nothing uncommon to take notice of in my passage through
France—nothing but what other travellers have given an account of with
much more advantage than I can. I travelled from Toulouse to Paris, and without
any considerable stay came to Calais, and landed safe at Dover the 14th of
January, after having had a severe cold season to travel in.
I was now come to the centre of my travels, and had in a little time all my
new-discovered estate safe about me, the bills of exchange which I brought with
me having been currently paid.
My principal guide and privy-counsellor was my good ancient widow, who, in
gratitude for the money I had sent her, thought no pains too much nor care too
great to employ for me; and I trusted her so entirely that I was perfectly easy
as to the security of my effects; and, indeed, I was very happy from the
beginning, and now to the end, in the unspotted integrity of this good
gentlewoman.
And now, having resolved to dispose of my plantation in the Brazils, I wrote to
my old friend at Lisbon, who, having offered it to the two merchants, the
survivors of my trustees, who lived in the Brazils, they accepted the offer,
and remitted thirty-three thousand pieces of eight to a correspondent of theirs
at Lisbon to pay for it.
In return, I signed the instrument of sale in the form which they sent from
Lisbon, and sent it to my old man, who sent me the bills of exchange for
thirty-two thousand eight hundred pieces of eight for the estate, reserving the
payment of one hundred moidores a year to him (the old man) during his life,
and fifty moidores afterwards to his son for his life, which I had promised
them, and which the plantation was to make good as a rent-charge. And thus I
have given the first part of a life of fortune and adventure—a life of
Providence’s chequer-work, and of a variety which the world will seldom
be able to show the like of; beginning foolishly, but closing much more happily
than any part of it ever gave me leave so much as to hope for.
Any one would think that in this state of complicated good fortune I was past
running any more hazards—and so, indeed, I had been, if other
circumstances had concurred; but I was inured to a wandering life, had no
family, nor many relations; nor, however rich, had I contracted fresh
acquaintance; and though I had sold my estate in the Brazils, yet I could not
keep that country out of my head, and had a great mind to be upon the wing
again; especially I could not resist the strong inclination I had to see my
island, and to know if the poor Spaniards were in being there. My true friend,
the widow, earnestly dissuaded me from it, and so far prevailed with me, that
for almost seven years she prevented my running abroad, during which time I
took my two nephews, the children of one of my brothers, into my care; the
eldest, having something of his own, I bred up as a gentleman, and gave him a
settlement of some addition to his estate after my decease. The other I placed
with the captain of a ship; and after five years, finding him a sensible, bold,
enterprising young fellow, I put him into a good ship, and sent him to sea; and
this young fellow afterwards drew me in, as old as I was, to further adventures
myself.
In the meantime, I in part settled myself here; for, first of all, I married,
and that not either to my disadvantage or dissatisfaction, and had three
children, two sons and one daughter; but my wife dying, and my nephew coming
home with good success from a voyage to Spain, my inclination to go abroad, and
his importunity, prevailed, and engaged me to go in his ship as a private
trader to the East Indies; this was in the year 1694.
In this voyage I visited my new colony in the island, saw my successors the
Spaniards, had the old story of their lives and of the villains I left there;
how at first they insulted the poor Spaniards, how they afterwards agreed,
disagreed, united, separated, and how at last the Spaniards were obliged to use
violence with them; how they were subjected to the Spaniards, how honestly the
Spaniards used them—a history, if it were entered into, as full of
variety and wonderful accidents as my own part—particularly, also, as to
their battles with the Caribbeans, who landed several times upon the island,
and as to the improvement they made upon the island itself, and how five of
them made an attempt upon the mainland, and brought away eleven men and five
women prisoners, by which, at my coming, I found about twenty young children on
the island.
Here I stayed about twenty days, left them supplies of all necessary things,
and particularly of arms, powder, shot, clothes, tools, and two workmen, which
I had brought from England with me, viz. a carpenter and a smith.
Besides this, I shared the lands into parts with them, reserved to myself the
property of the whole, but gave them such parts respectively as they agreed on;
and having settled all things with them, and engaged them not to leave the
place, I left them there.
From thence I touched at the Brazils, from whence I sent a bark, which I bought
there, with more people to the island; and in it, besides other supplies, I
sent seven women, being such as I found proper for service, or for wives to
such as would take them. As to the Englishmen, I promised to send them some
women from England, with a good cargo of necessaries, if they would apply
themselves to planting—which I afterwards could not perform. The fellows
proved very honest and diligent after they were mastered and had their
properties set apart for them. I sent them, also, from the Brazils, five cows,
three of them being big with calf, some sheep, and some hogs, which when I came
again were considerably increased.
But all these things, with an account how three hundred Caribbees came and
invaded them, and ruined their plantations, and how they fought with that whole
number twice, and were at first defeated, and one of them killed; but at last,
a storm destroying their enemies’ canoes, they famished or destroyed
almost all the rest, and renewed and recovered the possession of their
plantation, and still lived upon the island.
All these things, with some very surprising incidents in some new adventures of
my own, for ten years more, I shall give a farther account of in the Second
Part of my Story.
THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK